Skip to main content

Full text of "1914 The Touchstone Of The Watchtower"

See other formats


© Max Hatton 1965 


MAX HATTON’S PERSONAL TESTIMONY 


The story begins fifty years ago when | was the Shire Clerk in the lovely town of Denmark, 
Western Australia. It was necessary that the Council appoint an Assistant Shire Clerk. A 
young man by the name of Ray' was appointed and he and his wife Ivy? and my wife Merle 
and | soon became close friends. 


One evening they were at our home for the evening meal and in our conversation | 
mentioned that in a couple of weeks we were going over to Collie where our son Rodney 
would be christened in the Methodist Church. It would be a sort of dual christening for a 
daughter of my sister Joyce and her husband John would also be christened. Ray asked us 
why we were having Rodney Christened? This stunned us quite a bit so we simply 
responded along the lines that this is the thing to do. It seemed to us that this is what 
everyone did in those days. | was then asked did | have a Bible for Ray would like to show 
us that there is nothing in the Bible requiring the christening or baptizing of infants. People 
are encouraged there to make their own decision when they arrive at an age where they are 
sufficiently mature to make such an important decision. 


We were far from being religious people but eventually found a Bible in an old tin trunk. We 
were shown that Jesus was about thirty years of age before He was baptised. We were also 
shown sufficient other items to convince us that baptism of infants was a tradition not based 
upon the Word of God. We decided that we would not go ahead with the intended 
christening and this caused quite a disturbance in my family. 


The insight we had received concerning baptism caused us to agree to study other matters 
with Ray and Ivy who revealed to us that they had about a year before become Jehovah’s 
Witnesses. We were shown the sections of Scripture that reveal that Jesus is to return to this 
Earth in the near future. We discovered that the Immortal Soul and Hellfire concepts were 
also without foundation in the Bible but had come into the early Christian Church from 
Paganism. We had never heard of such things before and it seemed to us that other things 
Jehovah's Witnesses stand for were also in harmony with Scripture (we always had our 
doubts about their stand on Blood-transfusion). Eventually, we accepted the Watch Tower 
teachings hook, line, and sinker so we decided to become baptised ourselves. We were 
baptised at a Convention in Bunbury, West Australia on November 14, 1959. 


An appeal was made by the Head of the Watch Tower Society in Australia for many 
Jehovah's Witnesses in Western Australia to move to places shown on a map in the Eastern 
States for the purpose of serving where the need was great. Merle and | and Ray and Ivy all 
decided that we should go. We had become very dedicated to the cause and because we 
had three children chose to move to Melbourne rather than to a country town because of the 
greater prospect of gaining suitable work in the city. 


Regulations required that | give a month’s notice of my resignation from the Council and 
during that time we sold our furniture and most other possessions. Not long before we left | 
met a very earnest Seventh-day Adventist named Geoff Rogerson. He gave me a quite 
small paper “An Appeal to Jehovah’s Witnesses’ written by Pastor Arthur Patrick, also a 
Seventh-day Adventist. | explained to Geoff that | was far too busy just then to study the 
paper, but | promised to write to him about it after settling in Melbourne. The paper 
challenged the Watch Tower teaching on their chronology leading to the year A.D. 1914, the 
vital year in Watch Tower history. 


Shortly after arriving in Melbourne | wrote to Geoff re the paper. This began a protracted 
study of the subject on the part of both of us for we really didn’t know very much on the 


' This is not his real name. 


? This is not her real name. 


Max Hatton’s Personal Testimony 


subject at that time. Geoff turned out to be a very intelligent and capable Bible student and 
quite voluminous correspondence was sent back and forth and this went on for a couple of 
years until Geoff became convinced that what he had provided me should have been 
sufficient. However, he could not read my mind. | had staunchly defended the Watch Tower 
position but by now | was becoming quite concerned. However, | was nowhere near ready to 
capitulate, | needed to do more study yet. Geoff refused to continue the discussion. For my 
part | continued studying and wrote to several Scholars who were competent to be of help on 
matters related to their field of speciality. | found that there were several Scholars in the 
Seventh-day Adventist Church who were leaders in the field of Biblical chronology, both 
Siegfried Horn and Edwin R. Thiele offered helpful information. 


| also wrote to the Watch Tower headquarters in Brooklyn, New York, on several occasions 
but received no help whatsoever. On one occasion | was informed that they were too busy to 
spend the time that would be necessary to study for answers to my questions. This response 
obviously shocked me for | had been convinced that they were the real experts and were 
completely conversant with the subject of chronology. On another occasion they just 
counselled me to give less attention to chronology and rely on the signs they said confirmed 
their 1914 date. 


My confidence in the Watch Tower Society being God’s Channel of Communication was 
greatly shaken to say the least. Some of my friends and associates tried to assure me that if 
the Society didn’t have the answers to my questions now, they would one day be revealed in 
Jehovah's due time. It was evident to me that if you accept this delusive reasoning, which 
was fostered by the Society, it could never be wrong - Jehovah will sort it out for you one 
day. 


In those days | was interested in the Australian Institute of Archaeology, their headquarters 
was situated in Collins Street, Melbourne. | learned of the Annual Lecture Series for 1964 
and was tempted to attend. It is quite out of order for a Jehovah’s Witness to attend such 
meetings and particularly for me, because the meetings were on Tuesday evenings and | 
was conducting a book study for the local Congregation on those evenings, | managed to 
stay away, well, at least until the night of the final lecture when | felt compelled to attend. As | 
look back now | am quite sure it was providential that | should be at the meeting for the 
lecturer highlighted chronological information for the Neo-Babylonian Empire supplied on a 
Stele by the Lady Adda-guppi the mother of Nabonidus, the last King of Babylon. This Stele 
provides the names of the Kings of the Neo-Babylonian Empire and provides the length of 
reign for each king. This evidence corresponds exactly with all of the various other items that 
construct a chronology for the period. The evidence is so inextricably woven together that it 
cannot possibly be in error. | was absolutely amazed and now deeply impressed with the fact 
that | had been misled, and deliberately so, by the Watch Tower Society. 


| had accepted that the Watch Tower was God’s Channel of Truth and had supported its 
claim that there had to be seventy complete years of desolation of the land of Judah, that it 
had to be completely empty for seventy years of both man and beast. The evidence they 
provide had become much more than shaky according to my investigations and this last 
piece of contrary evidence was just too much for me. It was the last straw, so to speak, and | 
wended my way home that evening now completely convinced that | had been following a 
false prophet rather than God’s Channel of truth. A false prophet that deliberately kept its 
mind controlled adherents in darkness by deliberately denying evidence and lying to them. | 
prepared a letter of resignation from Jehovah’s Witnesses on August 16, 1964 and delivered 
it to the local Congregational leader. 


From then on we were completely ostracised by the Jehovah’s Witnesses, they didn’t want 
to speak to us or have anything to do with us. The bottom had dropped out of our world so 
we decided to return home to Western Australia. We concluded that we had been wrong, it 
was not God who was wrong nor the Bible. We would start again and find out without any 


Max Hatton’s Personal Testimony 


mind control from the Watch Tower people or from anyone else what God really wants us to 
believe and to do. 


A little later, after being re-established in Western Australia | decided to put all my findings 
about JW chronology and their 1914 down on paper and send it to my former friends in 
Melbourne. Many of them must have been puzzled why we left the Watch Tower. Some, we 
thought, may not even have known that we had left. 


Shortly after | distributed my paper, “1914, THE TOUCHSTONE OF THE WATCHTOWER?” 
one of the senior Jehovah’s Witnesses was sent from Sydney to interview me and ask me to 
attend a meeting of the local Congregation in order to consider my actions. My response 
was that | had resigned nine months earlier and had no intentions of attending any 
inquisition the Watch Tower might like to set up. A few days later | received a letter advising 
that both Merle and | had been disfellowshiped. Disfellowshiping is used by the Watch Tower 
as a device to shut up those who are able to expose their errors. Now no Jehovah’s Witness 
will have anything to do with us in any way or else they could be disfellowshiped. My own 
parents had become Jehovah’s Witnesses due to my influence but were disfellowshiped for 
having spiritual association with me, their son, a disfellowshiped person. By this time they 
didn’t mind for | had been able to show them the deliberate errors propagated by the Watch 
Tower Society. 


A few years ago, about forty years after | resigned from Jehovah’s Witnesses, we discovered 
that Ray and Ivy were living in Western Australia. We picked up their phone number from the 
Directory and | decided to ring them to see if they had changed their stance at all. Ray 
answered the phone and when he discovered it was me calling he said he couldn’t talk to me 
and hung up the phone. Ray had once been my best friend but he is still obviously 
mesmerised by the Watch Tower Society. We were extremely sad about this. 


The Watch Tower wheel of deception rolls on - it captivates new innocent people and 
maintains its spell over its adherents. It used to teach that the generation that saw the signs 
begin in 1914 would still be alive when Jesus comes back at Armageddon. Recently, that 
claim looked ridiculous so it was quietly dropped. It doesn’t take long for all the twists and 
turns of the Society to be left in the background and forgotten and newer people are never 
informed of all the meanderings of the Society in the past. 


Merle and | have no respect whatever for the Watch Tower Society and its leaders. We are 
sorry for and respect the ordinary Jehovah’s Witness who allow themselves to be mind- 
controlled by the Watch Tower Society. 


Max Hatton 
Sydney 
September 2009 


iil 


1914-THE TOUCHSTONE oF THE WATCHTOWER 


The Summary of an Investigation by Max Hatton 
© Max Hatton, 1965 


Max Hatton completed this Study in 1965. I owe Max a great debt for his research, since his 
work enabled me to respond to Jehovah’s Witnesses who were calling at my door at the time. 
This work, along with that produced by Geoff Rogerson, launched my ongoing interest. 


Few people have access to Max’s original document. Indeed it is possible that he and I own the 
only original copies. 


Max’s work needs to be read today, for his information remains relevant. As well as exposing 
the errors of the Watchtower Bible and Tract Society (WTS), the existence of Max’s Study 
shows that the WTS has long been aware of the failings of its false neo-Babylonian chronology, 
which it is compelled to hold on to. Should they admit that their dates for the period are in 
error, then the WTS loses its claim to being the sole voice on earth of God’s heavenly 
government. 


The facilities provided by Word Processors enabled me to reformat his original document. 
Given the frailties of OCR scanning and my limitations, it is possible that the transcription 


process has resulted in a few errors creeping in. I take full responsibility for these unintended 
changes. I anticipate they are minimal, and I am certain they do not impact on the thrust of 
Max’s Study. Please address comments about any such needed corrections to me, not to Max. 


Since Max refers to WTS publications written in 1963, I provide scans of the pages that Max 
refers to from the WTS books All Scripture Is Inspired of God and Beneficial and “Babylon 
The Great Has Fallen!” God’s Kingdom Rules. 


I also provide copies of related correspondence with the WTS at the time that Max was 
conducting his research. 


I shall be pleased to forward comments about the Study on to Max. 
It has been a pleasure to be able to transfer this Study onto the modern media for him. 
Doug Mason 


doug_mason1940 @yahoo.com.au 


Contents 


INOAU CHO: xi. dcacater. as ted eis soci § fata trad aceiaa debe behets oe A destecntved eed che ood deg dea che dew net aes ch ectten siceernta het 1 
Chapter one. Pastor: Russell’s: 1914s c.veccs sears canta vented eee eee eee id os nage ae Mecaead Ses vaaag Shae Lees 3 
Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 2.0.0.0... scsesesesesesereeeeeenneeneeneenenneennneeaeaees 6 
WRG ZOO YCars e555 cade vase he che vat eie a een Piee De eae cube ae aaeg GaN da oe ia Ved Ude a Saeang va Peg daeeay Puees eaten va ba aes ceeds | 
The:536BC 10537 BE Jug gles ccetcsei he eatancaeteacig deere pede barge cg eheauiaden ead dc aetuacs dedecuiagevnen de aeoradiaderaaaaeest 8 
The: Watchtower and:53.7) BC ccc. ccoriasesgeiica tee eaa elas diate cca das ee ag NT 11 
Prospects for: 536: BC. sececnesitiea tinetdeniins wes hades hed enleai eastern Wee 13 
Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? ............ cc eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeenenenenenen 16 
587 BC or 586 BC? That is Another Question .............ccccccccssescece eee ceee ce ee cece cee eeeeaeeeeeeesaaaeeeasan sees 16 
The Subjection of Judah by Babylon... ic sesesenenenenenenenencnenenenencneneneaaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaaaeaeaeaeea 17 
The Society’s Objection to the Record of Daniel 1:1, 2.00... ceeeccceccceceaeeeeeeeeeeeaeaaeneeeteeeeeeaea 19 
The Society’s Objection to the Record of Daniel Chapter 2.0.00... .cccccccccccceeeeeeceeceaeaaeeeeeneeeeeeaea 23 
More Society objections to Daniel 121 oo. ce eeeesenenenenenenenencneneneeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaaaeea 25 
Summary of the Last Years of Judah 2.0.0... seseseseseseeececeeeeeeeaeaeeeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaaaaaaaaauaeaaaaaeaeaeea 26 
Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 0.0.0.0... eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeee 28 
Jeremy 252 Vs 1D ae sts hiss sxe Saath oh a ole beste sion weg wean Wind anes Go aiiees Wah abeakisod Gabeas Sanh va Goa ebeabasd cones taed 28 
Jeremial 25 21.2 3 sos sede tone eed ete oaeiesdua eh aiveaeele aieeed nevi eve eee ae ee a eee 30 
What: of Jeremiah: 29210? vi csi.c.cessectadetsachoun sins doughs dade suanauddded dad eadeatergeliets foibiee cd eyes sectateledioness 30 
The Desolation of Judah from 605 BC Continual and Increasing ......... ee eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeenenenee es 32 
Daniel 9 2a rosvenadecateetnea tae aeede cee dewubede desi c adnan at enwncsale Cen exaiogea Sag wad eve ses a Paden ad weed aaeeeuau aden Neaad ae 33 
2 Chronicles 36:21 scxs.wsiecd Gendetchvets eed Weald hoa tece lita eek ioe cp eectee nica ata a ate tneetaee oboaueuabt te eatie 36 
Altérnative 70, Viears: .cccgceonsansictndeeawene leceemeeeet ania cnet ein detnon en yee ieee 43 
Chapter five. Characteristic ObjeCtiONns ............ sc seseseseseeeseneeeeeeeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaaaaaaaeaeaaaaanaaaeaeea 45 
Chapter -six: The Sven Tames :ci.cccec5tacedecshecedend hceedd ixcnec oi ltced ed stdeaddatetagdebd deduct el esdd see dasd db sicesegaedees 53 
Lake: 20524 ten cist ruts oh Pena tcheceaninadecagsaeaguneubee ode. edegusvawctalesyeayu sien quedades Prag asaaeeees.predara es 54 
Doar] Ae sects cca iveata cs hentia hab nacacetaety ee dban deca aactat chal nakenshbatecg caaten chal codatalaatseceeecaecdeboabetehatseeesieate ots 55 
Prophetic: Tame iscccccuicticcathhadote i ateGed yekceeaby si dens Phat Godt bake cried eeatita Geos Mate eea Wheat thi Geos ete Gebietes 56 
Chapter seven. 6000 Years from Adam’s Creation? ............ccceccceccccceaeeeeeececececeaaeaeeeeeeeeeeceaauaeeteeeees 60 
Chapter eight. Signs of What? .......... ccc ccccecccecececneaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaaaeaeaaaeaeaaaeaeaaaeaeaaaaaeaeenes 63 
ParOusias aiiyeivetecssadeetasve Vien Geeedecouubede Rca ceetanwal vag acade dd dueus exanlsating aa eav lost gan wad een caeceuanvaedeavandiee 64 
Christs’ Return Visible and Personal ............c.scsescseseseseeececeeeeeeeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaaaaaaaaaeaeaaaeaeaeaeea 67 
A Glance at the History and Peculiarities of this Doctrine ......... ccc eeeseseneneneneneneneneneneneneeennneanaees 69 
Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice ....... cc ceeeeeececeeneeeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeeeaeaeaeaaaeaaaeaaaaaaaaaeaeaaaeaeaaaee 71 
World Wear Li .celiyticeteccsiteual cute ssooset eh heen eli iG Gee LG Ui aes eee 73 
POO: SHOrta B68: Fossets genredenadecttehg.cacdeesttegt deageceaet gedaan devanandd hentia segtertent gata cg derantetheensned cabectioretonehe 74 
Earthquakes: ccs gensievchensd hirer ett setonee hetad Aaeest ea beso acta neee ght danish cent cetaeetadeve seed haa a oan 75 


Darkened: Sun:and: MO On i3s:..i.ce cic: cicecege ene deed enced on tidecc adda cndacd tteae daunted gjhawndeed reneddamecnsceesitasaesttees 78 
GME LACIOM £205 «see ccteti deemed sedecter acta dacdetantoebbeannte dageede Mhvenaatbeamedesapecgaet Gada cave eente dagecnaabeabactifovendieiy 78 
Faithful and'Discréet:S avec. icc icac.ccdseecteriehetededeetene dacdngecbehtted edavacteah otiawi adted eneve ca sah saa teeedestadeeee 80 
COMGIUS 10M ic aaiea ssc Seater ate ack ea ase cee ra eee eae ad Seren Meee ad Soe ee ca 82 
Appendix A: The Tishri Calendar ........... 0c cececesesesecenenenenenenenenenenenanenanenenanancecscscscecseeeseeeseseseseseees 86 
Wher Gezer Calendar. 60: tccsacate tothe ficed adi laesd date ta gd gs Citeed adn ahead A dned sides daha de bend ok teed be tnalgieuelad ibaa ss 87 
The Tishri Calendar in Solomon’s Day ou... icceeesessseneneneneneneneaeneaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaaaeea 87 
The Tishri Calendar in Josiah’s Day .0....... ccc csssssseseneneneneneneneneeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaeaaaaea 88 
The Tishri Calendar in Nehemiah’s Day 0.0.0.0... ceceseseeeneneeeneneneneeeneeeneceseneneneneneaeneeseneeeneeenenenes 88 
‘The: Blephantine: Papyrt ssi: ccezeteveecernezacagetts ce custie cashes od hceeth ca cuaged detceay edbaeste vgcuscen debcentaleecutheldeceseutys 89 
Appendix.B:: Ptolemy's‘ Canon <3. 2-sccisoccna testi eee alain Ai eee A Genie does 91 
Appendix-C2 Absolute: Dates sci scaeis deena ede tnaes doteaedg de egeda cea cnad ace etna ddawen dy egeduadi seveeadeaetnelderetiaaes 94 
Cuneéitorm: Tablets: faciaz.i cisrochete be tracdace ded avecteet ot teiaverte ht tede ula abertir aetei ee o ree eee 96 
Berosus sce sssass tice tea ciecsaas ieee cid sgeeaute sieve chs Cav evaas Wiese cette th unsiedg sdaee chtsaavs otbasonetoclunscudeadig diversi euetauuates 99 
The: Adda= sup pi Stélae ssi: ccsz.cciescetne pactactey canes tide daghen gcttes chee tage dauteee ed bda sak egcteset cabtentacegestaeecttant 100 
Astronomical BViden 6 :sccsccics ceatcne chceenatedatedecdetea dhcteecdyedeth he dteiad soeeenh (ak eau ded eet oeae ote 101 
The Astronomical Text Dated to Nebuchadnezzar’s 37th Year ..........cccceeessseseeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeeneeenees 103 
Appendix D: A Brief Chronological Outline of the 70 Years ...........:::cseseseseseeeeeseneeeeeeeeeeeenennneeaeea 109 
Appendix E: Selected pages from the book “All Scripture Inspired of God” (1963 edition)............ 110 
Appendix F: Selected pages from the book “Babylon the Great Has fallen!” (1963 edition) ........... 126 
Appendix G: Correspondence with the Watchtower Society ...........:::seseseseseseseseneneneneenenennenneaeaees 171 


All Scriptures quoted, unless otherwise indicated, are quoted from The New World Translation 
published by the Watchtower Bible and Tract Society of New York Inc., in 1961. 


Abbreviations 


AV_ The King James or Authorised Version 
ASV The American Standard Version 
RSV_ The Revised Standard Version 
The Society The Watchtower Bible and Tract Society 
BF “Babylon The Great Has Fallen!” Gods Kingdom Rules 
SI “All Scripture Is Inspired of God and Beneficial” 
NS “Let Your Name Be Sanctified” 
YW “Your Will Be Done On Earth” 
CCK Chronicles of Chaldean Kings (626-556 BC) in the British Museum, by D J 
Wiseman 
BASOR Bulletin of the American Schools of Oriental Research 


vi 


INTRODUCTION 
Max Hatton, 1965 


Several years ago I became an adherent of the Watchtower Bible and Tract Society and consequently 
I assumed the name assumed by all other members of the Society since 1931, I called myself a 
“Jehovah’s Witness”. 


After becoming associated with the Society I did about all I could to spread its teachings because I 
was certain that it taught the truth. Yet at all times I recognized my personal responsibility to “Make 
sure of all things hold fast to what is fine”. (1 Thessalonians 5:21) 


About four years ago, I commenced a study of the Society’s doctrines connected with the Society’s 
teachings on 1914, for the year 1914 is of prime importance to the Society today. It is this year that, 
according to the Society, the Times of the Gentiles, or the time of uninterrupted Gentile domination of 
the Earth, ended and Christ began his second presence as King of the promised Kingdom of God. A 
very short while ago I completed this study completely convinced that the Society has no genuine 
foundation whatever for its 1914 platform and consequently for a large portion of its teachings which 
have developed from this. The 1914 of the Watchtower is a forgery. 


Being absolutely sure that this doctrine and all that goes with it is falsehood, there were only two 
alternatives available to me. I could close my eyes to all the evidence and remain stubborn like the 
criminal who said, “That’s my story and I’m sticking to it!” or I could remain firm in my devotion to 
the truth and refuse to continue to spread this falsehood. I chose the latter and resigned my position as 
a Servant in the Organization. 


To illustrate what has transpired since then I will borrow two passages from the book of “Job”. A few 
Witnesses, no doubt in a sincere desire to help me, have called and appealed to such things as the love 
in the organization and have not been prepared to solve my problems which involve Chronology and 
Prophecy. This is only avoiding the issue and although I appreciate their efforts to help me, the 
problems still remain. Job put it this way, “How then comfort ye me in vain, seeing in your answers 
there remaineth falsehood?” (Job 21:34 AV.) While the falsehood remains, there can be no comfort. 


Many do not know why I have stopped walking with the Society; indeed many friends do not know 
that I have done so. For many reasons, I am setting the whole problem down on paper, asking, “really 
now, who will make me out a liar. Or reduce my word to nothing?” (Job 24:25 AV.) 


It has been suggested and no doubt will be suggested again that the knowledge I have gained has gone 
to my head. Let it be noted therefore right from the beginning, that I claim no special credit for any 
information contained in this consideration. I have made no new discoveries, I am raising no new 
problem for the Society. For example, The Watchtower magazine carried many articles attempting to 
justify the Society’s Chronology during the year 1922. The following are a few quotations of interest: 


May 1, 1922, page 131 “About a year ago there began some agitation concerning chronology, the crux 
of the argument being that Brother Russell was wrong concerning chronology and particularly in error 
with reference to the gentile times.” 


Page 132 “Agitation concerning the error in chronology has continued to increase throughout the 


29 


year”. 


Page 139 complains that if the Society’s chronology was changed it “would put out of joint all our 
chronology, and destroy the value of the dates 1874, 1878, 1881, 1910, 1914, and 1918.” 


May 15, 1922 “We have no doubt whatever in regard to the chronology relating to the dates of 1874, 
1914, 1918, and 1925.” The Society has more doubts today than it obviously had in 1922 concerning 
the dates 1874 and 1925, for it no longer accepts these dates as having any special significance. 


Introduction 


Other articles published throughout the year in an effort to shield the Society’s chronology and 
discredit anyone or anything that might tend to prove it wrong were as follows:- 


June 1, 1922, “SEVENTY YEAR’S DESOLATION (PART I)” 

June 15, 1922. “SEVENTY YEARS’ DESOLATION (PART II)” 

July 1, 1922. “END OF THE SEVENTY YEARS’ DESOLATION” 

July 15, 1922. “THE STRONG CABLE OF CHRONOLOGY” 

November 15, 1922. “DIVINELY-GIVEN CHRONOLOGICAL PARALLELISMS (PART 1)” 


Numerous facts have come to light since 1922 which prove that the objections raised against the 
Society’s chronology back there were correct. On the other hand, the arguments the Society put 
forward have been refuted beyond a doubt. The course that the Society follows therefore on these 
matters today is one of silence. They avoid these problems. You can prove this for yourself if you care 
to by asking them selected questions raised at the conclusion of this consideration. 


CHAPTER ONE. PASTOR RUSSELL’S 1914 


The most recent publication setting out the Society’s Chronology etc. leading to 1914 AD is “Babylon 
The Great Has Fallen!”” God’s Kingdom Rules, published in 1963. However, to fully appreciate the 
truth as it relates to this doctrine, we have to go right back to Pastor Russell, the founder of the Watch 
Tower Society. Russell wrote a series of volumes which later became known as Studies In The 
Scriptures. Volume 2 of this series bears the title “The Time Is At Hand”, and it contains the alleged 
proof that the Gentile Times would expire in 1914 AD. In Study IV on pages 76 and 77 Russell wrote, 


In this chapter we present the Bible evidence proving that the full end 
of the times of the Gentiles i.e., the full end of their lease of dominion 
will be reached in AD 1914; and that that date will be the farthest 
limit of the rule of imperfect men. (underlining supplied). 


On page 77 Russell advised that, “if this is shown to be a fact firmly established by the Scriptures it 
will prove:-” He then set out 7 items which were briefly as follows: 


1. The Kingdom of God would be set up in 1914. 


2. Christ would be present in 1914, “but it will also prove that he will be present for a 
considerable period before that date.” 


3. That some time before the end of 1914 all of the Church of Christ would be glorified, 
“because every member is to reign with Christ, being a joint-heir with him of the Kingdom, 
and it cannot be fully ‘set up’ without every member.” 


4. At the end of the Gentile Times (1914 AD) Jerusalem would rise to a position of honor. 
5. By 1914 Israel’s blindness would be turned away. (Romans 11:25.) 


6. That the great time of trouble “such as never was since there was a nation” would reach its 
culmination. 


7. “before that date God’s Kingdom, organized in power, will be in the earth and then smite and 
crush the Gentile image (Dan 2:34) - and fully consume the power of these kings.” (The 
reference here should obviously have been Daniel 2:44.) 


It will be readily recognized by those conversant with the doctrines of the Society today that of these 
7 claims, only the 1st is maintained today. 


On page 79 we are told, 


The Bible evidence is clear and strong that the “Times of the Gentiles’ 
is a period of 2520 years from the year 606 BC up to and including 
AD 1914. This lease of universal dominion to Gentile governments, 
as we have already seen, began with Nebuchadnezzar — not when his 
reign began, but when the typical kingdom of the Lord passed away, 
and the dominion of the whole world was left in the hands of the 
Gentiles. The date for the beginning of the Gentile Times. is, 
therefore, definitely marked as at the time of the removal of the crown 
of God’s typical kingdom, from Zedekiah, their last king. ... With 
these facts before us, we readily find the date for the beginning of the 
Gentile Times of dominion, for the first year of the reign of Cyrus is a 
very clearly fixed date — both secular and religious histories with 
marked unanimity agreeing with Ptolemy’s Canon, which places it 
BC 536. And if BC 536 was the year in which the seventy years of 
Jerusalem’s desolation ended and the restoration of the Jews began, it 
follows that their kingdom was over-thrown just seventy years before 
BC 536, i.e., 536 plus 70, or BC 606. This gives us the date of the 
beginning of the Times of the Gentiles — BC 606. 


Chapter one. Pastor Russell’s 1914 


I will continue to quote from Russell’s work and as points requiring examination appear, I will 
number them for later consideration, points here are : 


1. Ist year of: Cyrus 536 BC? 


2. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


On page 87 we are counselled to 


“bear in mind the date already found for the beginning of these 
Gentile Times — viz., BC 606 — while we proceed to examine the 
evidence proving their length to be 2520 years, ending AD 1914.” 


Then the punishment mentioned in Leviticus is referred to at page 88, 


“Then I will punish you seven times more (further) for your sins.” — 
Lev. 26:17, 18, 24, 28. These seven times therefore refer to the length 
of time during which the Gentiles should rule over them. And to this 
period of ‘seven times’ our Lord undoubtedly referred when speaking 
of ‘the Times of the Gentiles.’” (Luke 21:24.) 


Pages 92 and 93 claim that “The world is witness to the fact that Israel’s punishment under the 
dominion of the Gentiles has been continuous since BC 606, that it still continues, and that there is no 
reason to expect their national re-organization sooner than AD 1914, the limit of their ‘seven times’ — 
2520 years.” 


Concerning the 7 times, we are advised on page 93, under the heading, “Another Line of Testimony” 
that, 


Another view of the Gentile Times is presented by Daniel Chapter 4. 


If we read Daniel 4, we find that the King of Babylon, Nebuchadnezzar, suffered a period of madness 
and lived with the Beasts of the field for a period of seven times. On page 96 Russell claims, 


The degradation of Nebuchadnezzar was typical of human 
degradation under beastly governments during seven symbolic times 
or years — a year for a day, 2520 years — from his day onward. And be 
it observed that this corresponds exactly with the seven times foretold 
upon Israel, which as we have just seen, end AD 1914. 


Consideration 3 then, should be. The seven times, Are they a period of punishment upon Israel and at 
the same time a period of domination by Gentile Governments? If so, is it legitimate to claim that this 


period extends over 2520 years? 


A few more quotations from Russell and then we can proceed to examine the basis for the Society’s 
1914 teaching and observe how it evolved. 


page 245. “the forty years of the Gospel age harvest will end October 1914, and that likewise the 
overthrow of ‘Christendom’, so-called, must be expected to immediately follow.” 


page 242. “The ‘Gentile Times’ prove that the present governments must all be overturned about the 
close of AD 1914.” 


page 170. “In the preceding chapter we presented evidence showing that the “Times of the Gentiles’, 
or their lease of domination, will run fully out with the year AD 1914, and that at that time they will 
all be overturned and Christ’s Kingdom fully established.” 


page 99. “In view of this strong Bible evidence concerning the Times of the Gentiles, we consider it 
an established truth that the final end of the kingdoms of this world, and the full establishment of the 
Kingdom of God, will be accomplished near the end of AD 1915” 


page 101. “the ‘battle of the great day of God Almighty’ (Rev. 16:14), which will end in AD 1915, 
with the complete overthrow of earth’s present rulership, is already commenced.” 


Chapter one. Pastor Russell’s 1914 


This gives us a brief outline of what the Society expected and it is not necessary to comment on these 
quotations. The Watchtower of 1907 page 295, summed up the Society’s attitude to the Chronology 
by asking, 


But let us suppose a case far from our expectations: suppose that AD 
1915 should pass with the world’s affairs all serene and with evidence 
that the ‘very elect’ had not all been ‘changed’ and without the 
restoration of natural Israel to favour under the New Covenant (Rom. 
11:12, 15). What then? Would not that prove our chronology wrong? 
Yes, surely! (This article was reprinted in The Watchtower, I5th 
December 1913, pages 374 and 375.) 


Of course 1915 AD did pass without all these events taking place, so did not that prove the 
Chronology wrong? Yes, surely! When the War started in 1914, it would be reasonable for Russell 
and his followers to consider this to be the great trouble that they were expecting, however it was 
NOT, and the expectations of Russell have now been virtually all dropped. BUT 1914 has been 
maintained and the prophecies of the Bible have been maintained, but they have been re-arranged to 
fit in with the history of the Society and events since that date. 


By no stretch of the imagination can the Ist World War and the trouble Russell was expecting to wind 
everything up in 1914 or 1915 be construed as being the same event. And yet it was in 1914 not 
evidently different, as is so obvious today. So we cannot blame Russell and Co. too much for the 
Straw that they grasped at. Nevertheless it was mere coincidence that this insignificant little group 
arrived at 1914 for the end of the “Gentile Times”, the same year as the World War. Don’t take my 
word for this, for the following chapters will prove this beyond a shadow of a doubt. 


Before passing from our review of Pastor Russell’s 1914, we note the interesting comment on the War 
which appears on page 327, The Watchtower, November 1, 1914. (After the War had commenced.) 


This leads us to expect that the remaining prophetic periods will have 
a similar fulfilment, and that September 20 of this year, 1914, 
probably marked the end of the Gentile Times. If so, what we are 
witnessing now amongst the nations is a conflict to their finish. This 
is exactly what we should expect. Evidently the Lord is behind the 
matter; the Lord’s Kingdom will manifest itself more and more. ... we 
might expect the transition to run on a good many years. We might 
expect it to be five, ten or twenty years. But there is something on the 
other hand that leads us to anticipate that it will not be very long. The 
Lord has told us that He will make a short work of it. ... It was in the 
year following the expiration of forty years of the Jewish Harvest that 
the end of the Jewish polity came — at the destruction of their city. 


And so the parallels would lead us to suppose that one year from the 
present time would finish this short parallel period, this great work of 
disaster upon the world, the overthrow of the nations and usher in 
Messiah’s Kingdom. 


Evidently at this time 1915 still retained its same place. 


CHAPTER TWO. 536 BC OR NOT 536 BC? THAT IS THE QUESTION 


Russell demonstrated again his dependence upon Ptolemy’s Canon on page 51 of Vol. 2, Studies in 
the Scriptures, 


The period from the time of the restoration of the Jews from Babylon, 
at the close of the seventy years desolation of their land, in the first 
year of Cyrus, down to the date known as AD 1, is not covered by 
Bible history. But, as before stated, it is well established by secular 
history as a period of 536 years. Ptolemy, a learned Greek-Egyptian, a 
geometer and astronomer, has well established these figures. They are 
generally accepted by scholars and known as Ptolemy’s Canon. 


The unfortunate part about all this is that Ptolemy’s Canon does NOT give 536 BC as the Ist year of 
Cyrus. (See the “Appendix B: Ptolemy’s Canon” which shows Cyrus’ year | to have been 538 BC). 
Now, if Russell had commenced his 2520 years from 538 BC he obviously would not have arrived at 
1914 AD. Why did Russell say that the year was 536 BC? I am sure that what follows provides the 
solution. 


On page 67 of the same Volume of Russell’s writings, he mentions “Dr. Hales’ work on chronology.” 
Dr. Hales’ work is entitled A New Analysis of Chronology and Geography, History and Prophecy. 
The second edition of 4 volumes was published in 1830. Hales gives considerable information on the 
Canon of Ptolemy and on page 168 he comments, “the Canon dates the accession of Cyrus ... 538 
BC.” On pages 166 and 167 he discussed an adjustment made by Historians to Ptolemy’s Canon to 
make Cyrus’ first year 536 BC. This was performed out of respect for the Scriptures, but Hales 
explains this, so I quote from his page 166: 


It must, however, be acknowledged that accurate as authentic copies 
of the Canon unquestionably are everywhere else in this single 
period: a small correction is necessary to accommodate it to 
Scripture; for, according to the Canon, from the first of Nabokolassar 
or Nebuchadnezzar, BC 604, to the first of Cyrus, BC 538, is an 
interval of only 66 years; and therefore, if the Captivity began, in the 
end of the third, or or commencement of the fourth year of Jehoiakim, 
BC 605, Dan, 1:1; 2 Kings XXIV:1; Jer XX V:1; from thence, to the 
accession of Cyrus, was only 67 years complete, or 68 current. 


On page 167 he says, 


Chronologers Scalinger, Petavius, Usher, Prideaux, Jackson &c. have 
adopted this interpolation as indispensably necessary to reconcile the 
Canon to Holy Writ, which is effectually done thereby; for from the 
commencement of the Captivity, BC 605, to the corrected first of 
Cyrus, BC 536 is 69 years complete, or 70 years current. 


The interesting point here is that Cyrus’ Ist year was changed to 536 BC to make it 70 years current 
from 605 BC, which was regarded as the beginning of the 70 years. A perusal of Dan. 1:1; 2 Kings 
24:1 and Jer. 25:1 as cited by Hales makes it obvious that the 70 years were regarded by these 
Chronologists as commencing at the beginning of Nebuchadnezzar’s reign and not in his 19th year as 
insisted on by Russell and the Society today. The ironical part is that Russell utilized the date 536 BC, 
which was calculated from the date 605 BC which Russell positively would not accept. He counted 70 
years back from 536 BC to 606 BC which he then claimed was Nebuchadnezzar’s 19th year, and then 
2520 years forward to 1914. 


The plain unadulterated truth is that Russell made a definite error here. Although he arrived at 1914 
AD, surely the Society is not justified in making the point that its publications had pointed to that date 
years before 1914, e.g. NS page 305, 


As far back as 1877 the book Three Worlds and The Harvest of This 
World, of which C. T. Russell was the co-publisher said ... “Hence, it 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


was in BC 606, that God’s kingdom ended, the diadem was removed, 
and all the earth given up to the Gentiles. 2520 years from BC 606, 
will end in AD 1914, or forty years from 1874. ... Besides repeated 
reference to AD 1914 in the Watch Tower magazine, the book The 
Time is at Hand, published in 1889, dealt with the subject at length, in 
its Study IV, entitled ‘The Times of the Gentiles.’ 


If Russell had commenced with 538 BC as the Ist year of Cyrus, he would have counted back 70 
years to 608 BC, and then 2520 years forward to 1912 AD. But this is not the only blunder that 
Charles Taze Russell made. He was wrong on several other points related to this same doctrine, two 
of them have been discussed by the Society and their comments on them are, to say the least, very 
revealing. 


The Zero Year 


The Watchtower of May Ist, 1952, comments on page 271, 


At this point some will enquire why Charles T Russell in 1877 used 
the date 606 BC for the fall of Jerusalem whereas The Watchtower of 
late years has been using 607 BC This is because, in the light of 
modern scholarship, two slight errors were discovered to have been 
made which cancel each other out and make for the same result, 
namely 1914. Concerning the first error, Russell and _ others 
considered 1 BC to AD 1 as being two years whereas in fact this is 
only one year because, as has been said above, there is no ‘zero’ year 
in the BC-AD system for counting years. 


This statement is definitely misleading because Russell was aware that he may not be correct in 
counting the zero but he suggested no alteration to 606 BC. If the zero year was not counted, he 
suggested that it would push the concluding date of his 2520 years forward to 1915. (Not the 
commencing date back to 607 BC). The following is a quotation from The Watchtower 1st December, 
1912. 


Coming now to a very critical examination of the date 536 BC, there 
is an open question: Shall we call it 536 full years to AD or 535 full 
years? The difference in time between October 1st and January Ist 
would be the fourth of a year; hence our query is respecting 536% or 
535% years BC. What is the proper method of calculation, is in 
dispute. If we count the first year BC as 0, then the date 53614 BC is 
the proper one for the end of the seventy years of captivity. But if we 
begin to reckon it by counting the first year before the Christian era as 
BC 1, then evidently the desolation ended 535% years BC. 


As to the methods of counting, Encyclopaedia Britannica says, 
“Astronomers denote the year which preceded the first of our era as 0 
and the year previous to that as BC —l, the previous year BC -2, and 
so on.” 


Whichever of these ways we undertake to calculate the matter the 
difference between the results is one year. The seventy years of 
Jewish captivity ended October, 536 BC, and if there were 5364 
years BC, then to complete the 2,520 years’ cycle of the Times of the 
Gentiles would require 1913%4 years of AD, or to October, 1914. But 
if the other way of reckoning were used, then there were but 5354 
years of the period BC and the remainder of the 2,520 years would 


reach_to AD 1914%4 years, otherwise October, 1915. (Emphasis 
supplied.) 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


A little further on in this article it was stated, 


Many of our readers will recall our reference to this subject in a 
sermon preached at Allegheny, PA, January 11, 1904, and published 
in the Pittsburgh Gazette. We make an extract from that sermon as 
follows: 


We find, then, that the Seven Times of Israel’s punishment and the 
Seven Times of Gentile dominion are the same; and that they began 
with the captivity of Zedekiah, and as will be seen from the Chart, 
they terminate with the year 1915. According to the best obtainable 
evidences on the subject, synchronized with the Scriptural testimony, 
Zedekiah’s captivity took place in October, 6054 years before AD 1. 
If we will add to this 1914%4 years, we will have the year October 
1915 as the date for the end of Gentile supremacy in the world ... 


There surely is room for slight differences of opinion on this subject 
and it behoves us to grant each other the widest latitude. The lease of 
power to the Gentiles may end in October 1914 or in October 1915. 
And the period of intense strife and anarchy ‘such as never was since 
there was a nation’ may be the final ending of the Gentile Times or 
the beginning of Messiah’s reign. 


Russell knew about the zero year alright but was not as concerned to preserve 1914 as the Society is. 
As we shall continue to see, the Society is prepared to move Heaven and Earth, but it will not move 
from 1914. 


When the Society makes the misleading statement that “Russell and others considered 1 BC to AD 1 
as being two years”, it does not tell us who the others were. Doubtless there were others but it cannot 
be considered for a moment that ALL others made such an error. Russell had at least access to Hales’ 
work and he could have found on page 57 of Vol.1, advice that no zero year should have been 
counted. 


We have conclusive proof that the Society’s attributing an error to Russell concerning the zero year is 
not true. The Society is only using this as an excuse to justify its adjustment of 536 BC to 537 BC It 
knew that something would have to be done to get over the zero year problem. It could either alter the 
terminal date 1914 to 1915 as Russell suggested, or push 536 back to 537. This would not interfere 
with 1914 and so this was what was done. It was not “because, in the light of modern scholarship, two 
slight errors were discovered to have been made which cancel each other out and make for the same 
result, namely 1914.” 


Just while we are on this point, Russell makes further reference to Hales on page 67 of Vol. 2 of 
Studies in the Scriptures. He refers to Hales as giving the true date of Nehemiah’s commission as 454 
BC. (See also BF page 387.) Now the Society used to count the 69 weeks of Daniel 9:25 from 454 BC 
and arrive at AD 29 as the year of the appearance of the Messiah. (See BF page 388.) 


When the Society decided it must no longer count the zero year, it also had to amend the count of the 
69 weeks. The overall situation was that it could make 1914, 1915 and AD 29, AD 30, or as an 
alternative it could shift 606 BC back to 607 BC and consequently 536 BC back to 537 BC, and also 
454 BC back to 455 BC. Then AD 1914 and AD 29 would be maintained. BF page 387 bears witness 
to the fact that 454 BC was changed to 455 BC, and as far as I have been able to ascertain no excuse 
has ever been offered in order to justify this change. The reason is obvious, it was the Zero Year. 


The 536 BC to 537 BC Juggle 


We recall that The Watchtower of Ist May 1952, page 271, claimed that “in the light of modern 
scholarship, two slight errors were discovered to have been made which cancel each other out and 
make for the same result, namely 1914.” We found that “modern scholarship” wasn’t necessary to 
bring to the light facts on the zero year, for Hales work was written about 50 years prior to those of 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


Russell. And besides Russell was aware of the problem apparently as far back as 1904. The 
Watchtower continued, 


The second error had to do with not beginning the count of the 2,520 
years at the right point in view of historic facts and circumstances. 


This claimed error is explained in more precise terms on page 94 of The Watchtower, February Ist, 
1955. 


Jehovah’s witness from 1877 up to and including the publishing of 
‘The Truth Shall Make You Free’ of 1943 considered 536 BC as the 
year for the return of the Jews to Palestine, basing their calculations 
for the fall of Babylon on secular histories that were inaccurate, not 
up to date on archaeological evidences. This meant that Jeremiah’s 
seventy years of desolation for Jerusalem ran back from 536 BC, to 
606 BC, instead of more correctly as now known from 537 BC, to 
607 BC 


The Truth Shall Make You Free, contends on page 151 that 


It is well established that two years after the overthrow of Babylon in 
538 BC, by Darius the Mede and his nephew, Cyrus the Persian, the 
first year of Cyrus’ exclusive rule began, which year was 536 BC 


During the following year, the book The Kingdom Is At Hand was published (1944). This stated on 
page 195, 


According to the most accurate histories, Darius the Mede and Cyrus 
the Persian, his nephew, jointly took the capital of the Babylonian 
empire in 539 BC After Darius’ brief rule there, Cyrus came to power 
in 537 BC. 


It is now considered by the Society that Cyrus came to power late in the year 538 BC (see BF page 
366). As will be shown later, the Society makes many contradictory statements on the matter. It 
should be noted that Babylonian Chronology 626 BC-AD 45 by Parker and Dubberstein was first 
published in 1942 and this was no doubt the source from which the Society suddenly discovered the 
correct date 539 BC for the fall of Babylon. (See “Appendix C: Absolute Dates.”’) 


Page 239 of The Truth Shall Make You Free does not contain much truth but it does provide some 
very interesting reading. First of all I will quote the section concerned and then we can analyse tt. 


In Nebuchadnezzar’s time, the year began counting from the fall of 
the year, or about October | our time. Since he destroyed Jerusalem 
in the summer of 606 BC, that year had its beginning in the fall of 
607 BC, and its ending in the fall of 606 BC 


Inasmuch as the count of the Gentile, ‘seven times’ began its first 
year at the fall of 607 BC, it is simple to calculate when they end. 
From the fall of 607 BC to the fall of BC is exactly 606 years. From 
the fall of BC 1 to the fall of AD 1 is one year, do not forget. Hence 
from the fall of BC 1 to the fall of AD 1914 is 1,914 years. Add now 
606 years and 1,914 years, and the sum total is 2,520 years, ending in 
the fall of AD 1914. 


I said the quotation was interesting and in case the significance of my statement has not become 
apparent to you, I will summarise my reasons for saying so. 


1. Note the comment that, “In Nebuchadnezzar’s time the year began counting from the fall of 
the year.” This statement is not strictly correct, for in Babylon the year began in Spring 
(Nisan). However in Judah two methods of observing the year were practiced. One 
calculation beginning in Nisan (similar to Babylon) and the other commencing in Tishri 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


(Fall). I will later call attention to the Society’s recognition of the Tishri Calendar (see 
“Appendix A: The Tishri Calendar”). 


2. The fact that from 1 BC to 1 AD is only 1 year was acknowledged. However, 536 BC and 606 
BC were still maintained. The slight error (zero year) was cancelled out in another way. At 
this stage the compensation juggle of 536 to 537 had not been made. 


3. Instead of counting the 2520 years from what the Society claims to have been the desolation 
of Judah, Tishri in 606 BC (which as Russell pointed out would conclude the Gentile Times 
in AD 1915), it was claimed “that year had its beginning in the fall of 607 BC” and the 2520 
years were counted from the beginning of the year in which Jerusalem was destroyed. (For 
today’s commencing date at the destruction, see SI page 284). This is a further clear case of 
juggling in order to maintain that year. 


4. We have a sample of the Society’s recognition of the system commonly referred to as 
“Inclusive Reckoning.” The period of Gentile domination on the above basis would have been 
only 2519 years plus 2 months. (See later for further comments on “Inclusive Reckoning” and 
the Society’s recognition of this system of reckoning.) 


5. It should be evident why the Society had to say a Tishri calendar was used (see point 1). If the 
Society said that a Nisan calendar had been used, it would have been impossible to throw the 
commencement of the year from 606 BC back into 607 BC, for Nisan began in approx. April 
and therefore the beginning of the year in which the month Tishri was situated in 606 BC if 
the calendar beginning in Nisan was used, was Nisan 606 BC. 


N.B. If the count began when the Society says the land became desolate (as it does today), it would 
not have been possible to throw the beginning date back into 607 BC either, for Tishri was the 
commencing month of the New Year under the fall-to-fall calendar. (See BF page 166.) 


It cannot be disputed that much juggling was necessary, but at least as far as the Society was 
concerned, 1914 was saved. All this though was obviously a most unsatisfactory set-up, so in the 
following year (1944) when The Kingdom Is At Hand was published the compensating slight error 
was discovered and 536 BC was made 537 BC. This allowed 606 BC to become 607 BC with less 
difficulty. 

How legitimate was this switch? Is it actually true that the Jews returned to Judah in 537 BC and not 
in 536 BC? The plain truth is that it is not known with any certainty which is the correct year. Some 
give the year as 538 BC, some 537 BC, and some 536 BC. Professor Joseph P Free, Professor of Bible 
and Archaeology at Wheaton College., Illinois, U.S.A, commences chapter 21 of his book 
Archaeology and Bible History (1962 Edition), “The Return From Exile, 536-458 BC” on page 237, 
“the actual return must have gotten under way at least by 537 or 536 BC”. 


The Catholic Biblical Encyclopedia (1956) says on page 232, “536 Edict of Cyrus and end of 
Babylonian Exile”. 


These statements would indicate that it was NOT necessary to switch 536 to 537 BC, except to 
compensate for the zero year which was no longer counted. 


After an intense study of this period of Jewish and Babylonian History, I was unable to locate any 
record of recent archaeological discoveries that would tend to support the switch of dates. Remember 
that the Society said that 536 BC was based on “secular histories that were inaccurate, not up to date 
on archaeological evidences.” 


I wondered at this statement at the time because the Society has shown no inclination to alter any of 
its other dates because of “archaeological evidences” and yet it seemed anxious to amend 536 BC. So 
I wrote, querying what the new evidence was? To my surprise, I received advice that it was the 
“Nabonidus Chronicle”. The letter dated October 19, 1964 advises that “Years ago this information 
was not available and so up until 1943 Jehovah’s servants considered 536 BC as the year of the return 
of the Jews to Palestine’’. It is certainly true that years ago “this information was not available”, but it 


10 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


was available long before 1943 when the Society suddenly discovered the error that they claim 
compensates the zero year. 


SI page 282 reports, 


A prominent event recorded both in the Bible and in pagan secular 
history is the overthrow of the city of Babylon by the Medes and 
Persians under Cyrus. The Bible records this event at Daniel 5:30. 
The pagan record was made by King Nabonidus, and it has been 
dated by him in what is known as the Nabonidus Chronicle, 
discovered in 1879 and now preserved in the British Museum, 
London. (See also SI page 335.) 


John C Whitcomb Jr. advised on page 20 of his book Darius The Mede, “the Nabonidus Chronicle 
was first published by Theophilus G Pinches in TSBA, VII (1882).” 


It is true that the year for the fall of Babylon used to be given as 536 BC and later as 538 BC, but as 
has been demonstrated above, the Society gained the year 536 BC for the return to Judah by an error 
in calculating the first year of Cyrus. The “Nabonidus Chronicle” has not changed the first year of 
Cyrus and there is no valid reason to shift from 536 BC. If it were not for the fact that the removal of 
the zero year needed to be compensated, the Society would still assert that the return took place in 536 
BC 


Before what I have quoted from Hales work becomes too stale in your mind, notice that he and all the 
other Chronologists that he mentions were prepared to amend the years of the reign of Cyrus, but they 
did not interfere with those of Nebuchadnezzar. On the other hand, Russell intended to maintain 
Cyrus’ reign but relocate that of Nebuchadnezzar. 


This raises a very interesting question. In the light of the knowledge we now have of this period of 
Ancient History, is the reign of Cyrus positively fixed and that of Nebuchadnezzar uncertain? (The 
Society obviously would have us believe this for it maintains the location of Cyrus’ reign and 
unhesitatingly shifts that of Nebuchadnezzar.) The answer is No! Both reigns are quite positively 
fixed but there is more evidence to support the dates of Nebuchadnezzar’s reign. (See “Appendix C: 
Absolute Dates.’’) 


We have noted the shift by the Society of 536 BC to 537 BC for the year of the return to Judah by the 
Jews. Therefore we have yet the interesting task of examining the Society’s evidence for 537 BC and 
the prospects for 536 BC. 


The Watchtower and 537 BC 


2 Chronicles 36:22, 23 and Ezra 1:1-4 contain the decree of Cyrus permitting the Jews to return to 
their native land, which is dated the 1st year of Cyrus. 


BE page 364 commences a discussion of this historic event and on page 366 we are confronted with a 
very confusing section concerning the Ist year of Cyrus and the Ist year of Darius the Mede. We are 
informed that the Society is prepared to “‘accept from secular historians the year 539 BC as a fixed 
date marking the downfall of Babylon.” SI page 282 provides the date, which was October 11-12, 539 
BC 


BE page 366 continues, 


But the Bible introduces immediately after the fall of Babylon in that 
year of 539 BC, the reign at Babylon of Darius the Mede (Daniel 
5:30, 31). The prophet Daniel, who was there at Babylon, speaks of 
the “first year of Darius the son of Ahasuerus of the seed of the 
Medes, who had been made king over the kingdom of the Chaldeans” 
(Daniel 9:1; 11:1; 6: 1, 6, 9, 25, 28). In harmony with the Bible, we 
must accept at least one year, with possibly part of a second year for 
King Darius the Mede. Hence, at the earliest the first year of King 


11 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


Cyrus the Persian may not have begun till late in the year 538 BC, to 
extend over into the following year of 537 BC. 


We read in SI: 


When a king succeeded to the throne, the intervening months until the 
next spring month of Nisan were referred to as his Accession year, 
during which he filled out the regnal term of rulership for his 
predecessor. However, his own official regnal term was counted as 
beginning on the next Nisan 1. (SI page 283.) 


In view of this statement, the period from Oct. 11-12, 539 BC to Nisan Ist 538 BC would be Darius’ 
“accession year.” From Nisan 538 BC to Nisan 537 BC would be his Ist “regnal year”. If he reigned 
part of a 2nd year this would extend from Nisan 537 BC to Nisan 536 BC If Cyrus acceeded to the 
throne during this year, the period to Nisan 536 BC would be his “accession year” and then to Nisan 
535 BC would be his first regnal year. 


Compare this analysis with the statement on page 366 of BF: 


Hence, at the earliest, the first year of King Cyrus the Persian may not 
have begun till late in the year 538 BC to extend over into the 
following year of 537 BC. 


Even if Darius reigned during just a part of one ‘“regnal year”, we could shift Cyrus’ Ist regnal year 
not further back than one year (from Nisan 537 BC to Nisan 536 BC). Obviously there is something 
inconsistent with the Society’s statements. 


SI page 8 adds to the confusion by advising that “in the following year beginning in March 538, Cyrus 
began his first complete regnal year.” (March 24th, 538 BC was Nisan Ist.) Page 335 insists that 
“secular history definitely establishes that Cyrus was a key figure in the conquest of Babylon and that 
thereafter ruled there as king.” This AGAIN contradicts BF. (See also The Watchtower Ist February 
1964, page 80 and The Watchtower Ist May 1952, page 271.) 


On page 364 of BF, several authorities are quoted as giving the year 537 BC as the year of the return. 
Without doubt all of these authorities would utilise the cuneiform inscriptions in their calculations. BF 
page 367 suggests that these contradict the Bible by saying, “if we proceed according to the cuneiform 
inscriptions rather than the Bible, we have to take the position that Darius the Mede and Cyrus the 
Persian reigned concurrently for a time.” BF suggests that Darius ruled prior to Cyrus yet it uses those 
who would not agree with this to support their date. YW says on page 119, “Cyrus the Great who 
reigned jointly for a time with his uncle Darius the Mede.” 


One feels entitled to enquire how these amendments can be made without the date 537 BC being 
affected? 


The view that Darius the Mede was an uncle of Cyrus is an old one and is based largely upon the 
statements of the ancient Greek Historian Xenophon in his Cyropaedia. This identification makes 
Cyaxares II, the uncle of Cyrus, Darius the Mede. There are several strong objections to all of the 
suggested identifications of Darius and this one is no exception, but it cannot be discarded from the 
list of possibles. 


Whatever the identity of Darius the Mede may really have been, it is possible that Daniel and Ezra, or 
even the Jews in general, reckoned the reigns of Darius and Cyrus to have been successive, even 
though the Babylonian Documents recognise only Cyrus. Daniel 6:28 can be taken to support 
successive reigns and Daniel 9:1 mentioning the Ist year of Darius and Daniel 1:21 referring to the Ist 
year of Cyrus, can be interpreted as applying to different years. 


As has been adequately demonstrated, if the reigns were successive, the Society’s Chronology cannot 
stand. It would now appear that the Society favours a different identification for Darius the Mede, for 
it now asks, 


Who was this Darius? There is yet some difficulty in proving this in 
the uninspired pagan cuneiform inscriptions and other historical 


12 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


writings. But the argument is strong that he was the same as Cyrus’ 
governor named Gubaru. (BF page 239, where the footnote refers to 
chapter 7 of Darius the Mede by John C. Whitcomb, Jr.) 


If Darius was Cyrus’ Governor, why shouldn’t we take the position that Darius and Cyrus reigned 
concurrently for a time? If Darius was Cyrus’ Governor, we have Cyrus who was the Sovereign of the 
Persian Empire and Darius who was made by Cyrus ruler over the kingdom of Belshazzar. (Daniel 5: 
30-31; 9:1.) 


Because Daniel dated some events in Cyrus’ reign and some in that of Darius does not necessarily 
require successive rulerships. We have something of an analogy in the case of Belshazzar and 
Nabonidus who were co-regents. It should be noted however that Daniel dated events only in the 
name of Belshazaar. Daniel 6: 28 does not necessarily suggest that there was not a dual reign. There 
are no legitimate reasons for dogmatically refusing to accept that Cyrus and Darius reigned 
concurrently, for this is also a possibility. Of course Darius would have been subordinate to Cyrus and 
so the cuneiform inscriptions would date business transactions in the years of Cyrus’ reign, and they 
do. 


There is no difficulty in ascertaining how the authorities that the Society quotes arrive at 537 BC. 
According to the cuneiform inscriptions, Cyrus’ accession year extended to Nisan 538 BC, when his 
Ist regnal year commenced. Seeing that according to Ezra 1:1-4, the decree by Cyrus permitting the 
Jews to return to their homeland was issued in his Ist year, the return on the basis of this arrangement 
must have been possible some time in the period Nisan 538 BC — Nisan 537 BC. It is assumed that the 
journey was made in Spring of 537 BC (See BF page 367), so that when the 7th Jewish Month Tishri 
began, the people had resettled in Judah (BE page 371). The Society wants to squeeze a lone reign by 
Darius the Mede into all this but it still wants to maintain these dates. All this is according to the 
reconstructed Babylonian Calendar, which dated the years of a King from Nisan-to-Nisan. 


Prospects for 536 BC 


Another question that the Society has failed to deal with is “Who said that Ezra used the Babylonian 
(or Persian) Calendar?” There is no evidence to prove that Ezra used the Nisan Calendar, but there is 
evidence to suggest that he more likely used the Jewish Calendar that extended from the 7th Month 
Tishri-to-Tishri. Here I must digress for a while to offer reasons for this statement. 


The Society accepts that Ezra wrote both books of Chronicles (SI page 75) and of course the book of 
“Ezra”.So it was he who in fact tells us of the decree in Cyrus’ Ist year. It accepts that Nehemiah 
wrote the book now bearing his name, but on page 88 of SI we have the interesting comment, 


Originally, the books of Ezra and Nehemiah were one book, called 
“Ezra”. Later, the Jews divided the book into First and Second Ezra, 
and later still Second Ezra became known as Nehemiah. 


But what has this to do with Ezra using a Tishri Calendar? Simply this. BF page 386 states quite 
unequivocally that 


According to Nehemiah’s reckoning of the lunar year, the year began 
with the month Tishri (which Jews today recognize as the beginning 
of their civil year) and ended with the month Elul as the twelfth 
month. 


On this use of the Tishri-to-Tishri Calendar by Bible writers, see “Appendix A: The Tishri Calendar.” 


As Nehemiah definitely used the Jewish calendar beginning in Tishri, is it not just as likely that Ezra 
his contemporary also used this calendar? As was the case with Nehemiah, Ezra wrote for the benefit 
of Jews in Judah. So he surely would not restrict himself to the Calendar of the Babylonians. 


The above-mentioned “Appendix” article indicates that papyri found at Elephantine in Egypt suggests 
the use of a calendar commencing in Tishri in Ezra’s time. The nationalistic spirit existing in the 
recently re-established state of Judah would surely have inspired Ezra to utilise its Calendar system in 
lieu of that of the Persian Empire or Babylon. 


13 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


Can you imagine yourself going to Jerusalem today and trying to converse with everyone in English 
when you knew the native tongue? If not, then can you imagine Ezra writing for Jews in Judah using 
the Babylonian and Persian Calendar when the natives of Judah used a different Calendar? If your 
answer is No! then you will also agree that the evidence is in favour of Ezra using a Tishri-to-Tishri 
Calendar. 


Viewing the reign of Cyrus then, and noting that his reign over Babylon could commence only after 
he conquered it in Tishri of 539 BC, Ezra could have counted the period to Tishri 538 BC as his 
“accession year”. His first year on this basis would extend to Tishri 537 BC. 


Ezra doesn’t tell us exactly when Cyrus gave his decree, he merely confines it to his Ist year. 
Therefore, the decree could have been issued just prior to Tishri, about Autumn of 537 BC. 


I suggested a moment ago, doing some imagining. Could I suggest again that you now imagine 
yourself as one of the Jews in Babylon. Of course, only a portion of the Jews chose to return. Daniel 
for instance, even though he had prayed for the restoration (Daniel 9:1-19) chose to remain in 
Babylon. However, you are a Jew who wishes to return, perhaps you are one who became one of the 
leaders such as Shesh-bazzar (Ezra 1:11) or Zerubbabel (Ezra 2:2). 


You have a long and dangerous journey ahead of you. BF page 296: “Measured by travel routes and 
travel time away back in those days, that city was far away, say a land journey of four or five 
months.” Ezra tells us that it took him 4 months to make the trip (Ezra 7:8, 9). 


What would you do? There are thousands of people to get together, there are preparations to be made. 
You’re going back to a ruined land which will afford little shelter for the people until repairs have 
been carried out. There are no crops, so food will present a problem. And what about the Winter, only 
weeks away? The obvious thing for you to do would be to make preparations during the Winter. Yes! 
be all ready by Spring. This will allow you ample time for your 4 or 5 month journey and to get 
accommodation settled for all those people when you get there. Crops of course are of prime 
importance so you will also make sure that they are in and all this before the Autumn rains. 


You will have to agree that all of this is the only reasonable arrangement if the decree was issued late 
in Cyrus’ 1st year on the basis of the Tishri Calendar and if his accession year was reckoned by Ezra 
to have commenced in 539 BC. As no one can say that it wasn’t, this arrangement must be regarded as 
a definite possibility. 


As will be realised later on when the 70 years is discussed, 536 BC is almost certainly the correct 
year, for from 605 BC to 536 BC is 70 years according to the system commonly called “Inclusive 
Reckoning” which was so often employed by the Jews. 


The dates would then be: 
Decree Cyrus’ Ist year 538 —537 BC 
Return in Spring (about Nisan 536 BC) 537 — 536 BC 


Having set out in Nisan of 536 BC, you would arrive in Jerusalem during, say Ab, the 5th Month. You 
would then have time to repair dwellings and prepare fields and plant crops before the Autumn rains. 


Ezra 3:1 proves that the Jews arrived before the 7th Month (Tishri) began and gathered to Jerusalem 
before the 7th Month began for, as can be seen by the Chart on SI page 280, this was the first Month 
containing Festival dates since they arrived home. And what a Month. In many respects this was the 
most sacred Month of the Year. Notice that of the eight Festivals listed in SI page 280, four were held 
in Tishri. 

Just two points of explanation before concluding this section. 


1. It might be argued that the 7th Month of Ezra 3:1 refers to the 7th Month of Cyrus’ Ist year, 
whereas according to the arrangement disclosed above it would be the 7th Month in the Year 
of the return. I just want to say that the Scripture in its context refers to the 7th Month and 
obviously relates to the year of the return. If the year of the return was not the Ist of Cyrus, 
then neither was the 7th Month. As the Cambridge Bible for Schools and Colleges (1907) 


14 


Chapter two. 536 BC or not 536 BC? That is the Question 


says, when discussing this verse, “Probably the 7th month in the first year of the Return, since 
the next recorded date (ver. 8) is the 2nd month ‘in the second year of their coming unto the 
house of God’.” 


2. Edwin R. Thiele states on page 31 of The Mysterious Numbers of the Hebrew Kings, 
In the Hebrew scriptures, the months are numbered from Nisan, 
regardless of whether the reckoning of the year was from the spring 
or fall. 
Therefore Tishri was still called the 7th Month in Ezra 3:1 even though it was still called the 
beginning of the New Year. (See also D. N. Freedman, The Bible and the Ancient Near East, 
page 31.) 
Taking all of the Society’s statements into consideration, we cannot escape the conclusion that if 


Cyrus and Darius the Mede did reign during separate periods, the return took place in the year 536 
BC. No matter what the circumstances were, 536 BC is stamped as the possible and probable year. 


15 


CHAPTER THREE. OVERTHROW OF KINGDOM 70 YEARS BEFORE 
RESTORATION? 


In Russell’s day the overthrow of the Kingdom of Judah was dated by the Society as taking place in 
606 BC, and the return was said to have been an event of 536 BC. Today it is 607 BC and 537 BC. 


I have already quoted Dr. Hales as saying “chronologers, Scalinger, Petavius, Usher, Prideaux, 
Jackson &c” made an adjustment to Ptolemy’s Canon “to reconcile the Canon to Holy Writ, which is 
effectually done thereby; for from the commencement of the Captivity, BC 605 to the corrected first 
of Cyrus BC 536 is 69 year complete, or 70 years Current”. 


There can be no doubt then that these men were quite satisfied that the dates 605 BC and 536 BC 
were fully in harmony with the Scriptures. Russell did not accept this arrangement, in fact it may be 
assumed that he didn’t even know what they had done, for it is evident that he did not absorb other 
information provided by Hales and he may have only selected a few dates from his work. 


606 BC is not much different to 605 BC, and at first glance it may seem that there is only one year 
between the two dates. We can see, however, that there is approx 20 years difference when we again 
refer to Russell’s writings. Studies in the Scriptures Vol 2 again and on page 52 Russell said: 


Usher dates the seventy years desolation eighteen years earlier than 
shown above Le. before the dethronement of Zedekiah, Judah’s last 
king — because the king of Babylon took many of the people captive 
at that time (2 Chron 36:9, 10, 17, 21; 2 King 24:8-16). He evidently 
made the not uncommon mistake of regarding those seventy years as 
the period of captivity, whereas the Lord expressly declares them to 
be seventy years of desolation of the land, that the land should lie 
“desolate without an inhabitant’. Such was not the case prior to 
Zedekiah’s dethronement. 


587 BC or 586 BC? That is Another Question 


Before proceeding further, I will clear up the point mentioned concerning Usher commencing the 70 
years 18 years prior to the dethronement of Zedekiah. I will have to be excused for speculating here, 
but Usher apparently considered that the destruction of Jerusalem took place in the 18th year of 
Nebuchadnezzar, at least 18 years from the Battle of Carchemish (Jer 46:2). My purpose in explaining 
this is to enlighten those who may wonder why some historians date the destruction of Jerusalem in 
587 BC and some in 586 BC. 


The problem is very briefly this. Jeremiah 52:28, 29 date a captivity in the 7th year of Nebuchad- 
nezzar and again in his 18th year. 2 Kings 24:12 refers to a captivity in his 8th year while 2 Kings 
25:8 dates a captivity in Nebuchadnezzar’s 19th year. 


Some seek to explain that the captivity of the 7th and 8th years were the same, as were those referred 
to as the 18th and 19th years (e.g., the Society, see BF page 137.) Some historians say that the 
destruction really took place in 587 BC, in Nebuchadnezzar’s 18th year. 


As Nebuchadnezzar was leading the Babylonian army while his father was apparently ill, a year 
before he actually became King, he was recognised by some as King a year earlier, therefore his 19th 
was really 18th. Others say that the 19th year is counted without an “accession year.” Yet others say 
that the Captivities of the 7th and 18th years were minor captivities. This seems very likely to be the 
solution, because when we compare the captives taken according to Jeremiah 52:28 with 2 Kings 
24:14-16 and the captives of Jeremiah 52:29 with 2 Kings 25:11, we find a vast discrepancy. Surely, 
the captivities mentioned by Jeremiah cannot be the major events recorded in 2 Kings! 


It is agreed by all Historians that the question must remain unsettled until further evidence such as 
“Babylonian Chronicles” (same as the Nabonidus Chronicle) which cover the periods are discovered. 
The use of a Nisan Calendar would suggest 587 BC, whereas a Tishri Calendar would recommend a 
date in 586 BC, but all this is really outside the field of our discussion. It is really an unsolved 
problem similar to 537 BC or 536 BC. Which? 


16 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


Back to Russell’s charge concerning Usher: 


He evidently made the not uncommon mistake of regarding those 
seventy years as the period of captivity, whereas the Lord expressly 
declares them to be seventy years of desolation of the land, that the 
land should lie “desolate without an inhabitant”. Such was not the 
case prior to Zedekiah’s enthronement. 


Hales said the 70 years began in 605 BC, which is approx 18 or 19 years before Nebuchadnezzar 
dethroned Zedekiah, and if it was not uncommon to calculate in this manner in Russell’s day, it is just 
as common today. 


On the other hand, the Society still follows Russell in this matter and considers all others to be in 
error. BF page 372: 


Since we have determined the year and the month in which the 
desolation ended, it is simple mathematics calculate when the 
desolation began upon the land of Judah. All we have to do is 
measure back seventy years, forasmuch as the desolation was foretold 
to last seventy years and it actually lasted seventy years. Seventy 
years back from the seventh month (Tishri) of the year 537 BC brings 
us to the month Tishri of the year 607 BC. 


Inspection of “Appendix C: Absolute Dates” leaves us in no doubt as to the correct location of 
Nebuchadnezzar’s reign. The reign of Cyrus has nowhere near the incontestable evidence that is 
available to locate Nebuchadnezzar’s reign. 


Therefore the question immediately comes up, “If we have to have seventy years of Complete 
Desolation of Judah, would it not be more reasonable to accept the better attested dates and date the 
70 years from 586 BC to 516 BC?” I have written to the Society on several occasions on the subject 
of Chronology, submitting this question along with others, but they were just brushed aside. 


The Watchtower June 1, 1922, when discussing the Seventy Years’ Desolation, mentions that if one 
considers that he has found error in the Society’s teaching, he should “communicate with the Society, 
which could help”. In the absence of assistance in my case, I can only consider that the Society was 
bluffing then or has changed its policy since. I have my opinion, for I know that the Society cannot 
answer many questions on this subject. 


Why is it that Historians date the 70 years from 605 BC, when the land was still inhabited? Is it 
Scriptural to do this, or do they just ignore the Scriptures referring to the desolation? 


I will have to first of all review what took place in Judah and Palestine from 605 BC onwards and 
then we can see if the 70 years from 605 BC — 536 BC is in harmony with the Holy Scriptures. 


The Subjection of Judah by Babylon 
Nabopolassar, the father of Nebuchadnezzar died in 605 BC, and consequently after becoming King, 


ra 6 


the remainder of the year was termed Nebuchadnezzar’s “accession year”. 


His first “regnal year” began on Nisan 1st 604 BC. In 1956, D J Wiseman, Assistant Keeper in the 
Department of Egyptian and Assyrian Antiquities at the British Museum, published a translation of 
several newly discovered Babylonian Chronicles, Chronicles of Chaldean Kings in the British 
Museum (hereafter referred to as CCK). 


These Chronicles are of the same type as the “Nabonidus Chronicle”, and were hailed the World 
‘round, for these new Chronicles mention the Battle of Carchemish (Jer. 46:2), the death of 
Nabopolassar, the accession of Nebuchadnezzar, the capture of Jehoiachin, the setting up of Zedekiah 
as a “puppet King”, and many more items of information that illuminate and confirm the Bible record. 
These tablets have been the subject of wide discussion among Scholars, and there have been articles 
on them in numerous Journals throughout the World. The Society however, has not so much as 
mentioned them. 


17 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


It continues to speak in glowing terms of the “famous Nabonidus Chronicle” but it ignores the others. 
Why do you think this would be? The reason is obvious when it is realised that those Chronicles 
provide other “Absolute Dates” which contradict the Society’s arrangement. Those who know only 
what the Society teaches them still think that there is only one “Absolute Date” for the period. SI on 
page 282 continues to give only the 539 BC date for the fall of Babylon under the heading “Absolute 
Date for the Hebrew Scriptures.” 


I cannot describe this action in any other way than to say it is dishonest. Why work back from 539 BC 
when two other “Absolute Dates” in Nebuchadnezzar’s reign are known with absolute certainty? (See 
“Appendix C: Absolute Dates.”) The answer is, of course, because the Society could not then 
maintain its Chronology leading to AD 1914. 


The following is the translation on page 67 of CCK of the tablet identified as BM 21946. 


1. In the twenty-first year, the king of Akkad stayed in his own land, 
Nebuchadnezzar his eldest son, the crown prince 


2. mustered (the Babylonian army) and took command of his troops; he 
marched to Carchemish which is on the bank of the Euphrates, 


3. and crossed the river (to go) against the Egyptian army which lay in 
Carchemish. 


4. ........ fought with each other and the Egyptian army withdrew before 
him. 
5. He accomplished their defeat and to non-existence (beat?) them. As 


for the rest of the Egyptian army 


6. which had escaped from the defeat (so quickly that) no weapon had 
reached them, in the district of Hamath 


7. the Babylonian troops overtook and defeated them so that not a single 
man escaped to his own country. 


8. At that time, Nebuchadnezzar conquered the whole area of the Hatti- 
country. 


9. For twenty-one years Nabopolassar had been king of Babylon. 


10. On the 8th of the month of Ab he died (lit. ‘the fates’); in the month 
of Elul Nebuchadrezzar returned to Babylon 


11. and on the first day of the month of Elul he sat on the royal throne in 
Babylon.” 


The following is also a portion of the same tablet as translated on page 73 CCK: 


11. In the seventh year, the month of Kislev, the king of Akkad mustered 
his troops, marched to the Hatti-land 


12. and encamped against (i.e. besieged) the city of Judah and on the 
second day of the month of Adar he seized the city and captured the 
king. 


13. He appointed there a king of his own choice (lit. heart), received its 
heavy tribute and sent (them) to Babylon. 
(Compare this with 2 Kings 2:10-17.) 


On page 25, Wiseman comments, “the geographical term Hatti including at this period, the whole of 
Syria and Palestine.” Obviously it included Judah for we just read, “marched to the Hatti-land and 
encamped against (i.e. besieged) the city of Judah.” 


18 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


We can determine by reference to “Appendix C: Absolute Dates” that Nebuchadnezzar’s Ist year 
commenced Nisan Ist 604 BC. Therefore it was during the previous year 605 BC that his father 
Nabopolassar died, and just prior to this Nebuchadnezzar had defeated the Egyptians at Carchemish. 


Having this knowledge we are able to determine that Jeremiah 46:2 applies to the year 605 BC, for it 
too mentions the Battle of Carchemish and dates it the 4th year of Jehoiakim. 


In chapter 25 verse 1, Jeremiah equates Jehoiakim’s 4th year with “the first year of Nebuchadrezzar.” 
Some may find a problem here for it is accepted that the Battle of Carchemish was in 


Nebuchadnezzar’s “accession year”. This too was Jehoiakim’s 4th year and yet Jeremiah 25:1 said 
Jehoiakim’s 4th year was the same as Nebuchadnezzar’s Ist year. 


Obviously Carchemish couldn’t have been fought in Nebuchadnezzar’s “accession year” and his “first 
year” at the same time as it did not extend from one year into another. But this problem is more 
apparent than real. I won’t go into a long explanation of it, but as Jack Finegan points out on page 202 
of Handbook of Biblical Chronology (1964) “the phrase in Jer 25:1 probably also means the 
“beginning year’, i.e. the accession year of Nebuchadrezzar.” He points out that the phrase used here 
is not used anywhere else in the Hebrew Scriptures (see also Hayim Tadmor, Journal of Near Eastern 
Studies XV (1956) page 228 and W F Albright Journal of Biblical Literature LI, 1932, page 102). 


I have already referred to the suggestion that Nebuchadnezzar may have been given an extra year by 
the Jews so that his Ist regnal year was counted as 605 BC. E R Thiele suggests on page 24 of 
BASOR 143 that Jeremiah might have counted Nebuchadnezzar’s years according to the Egyptian 
Calendar. (Remember that Judah had been under the heel of Egypt until Nebuchadnezzar defeated 
them at Carchemish and won mastery as the new World Power.) At present there is no conclusive 
answer to this problem although there are several possibilities. 


The Babylonian Chronicle says that, “At that time Nebuchadrezzar conquered the whole area of the 
Hatti-country.” As Judah was included in this term, it is obvious that it too fell to Nebuchadnezzar at 
that time. The Babylonian Historian Berosus (3rd Century BC) mentions prisoners at this time “from 
the Jews, and Phoenicians, and Syrians, and of the nations belonging to Egypt.” (Josephus, Against 
Apion 1:19 and Antiquities 10:11:1). These prisoners would include those mentioned in the Ist 
Chapter of Daniel. 


The Society’s Objection to the Record of Daniel 1:1, 2 


Daniel 1:1, 2 reports what happened while Nebuchadnezzar was on his campaign in the Hatti-land. 


In the third year of the kingship of Jehoiakim the king of Judah, 
Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon came to Jerusalem and 
proceeded to lay siege to it. In time, Jehovah gave into his hand 
Jehoiakim the king of Judah and a part of the utensils of the house of 
the (true) God, so that he brought them to the land of Shinar etc. 


Although it makes the discussion more cumbersome, I think we had better deal with the objections 
that the Society raises as we go along. In doing so, I trust that the continuity of thought will not be 
lost. 


The first point requiring some clarification is the discrepancy of one year between the record of 
Daniel (3rd year of Jehoiakim) and Jeremiah 25:1 and 46:2 (4th year of Jehoiakim). The solution is 
very simple. We have already seen on page 6 that the Society acknowledges the Tishri (fall-to-fall) 
Calendar (see also “Appendix A: The Tishri Calendar’). Of course, the Nisan (spring-to-spring) 
Calendar was also used (SI page 283). 


Edwin R Thiele in BASOR 143 (1956) advises that 


In Dan 1:1 the first conquest of Judah by Nebuchadnezzar, evidently 
during the same campaign of 605 in which Egypt was decisively 
defeated at Carchemish and Hamath, and in which Nebuchadnezzar 
“conquered the whole area of the Hatti-country” — is dated in the third 


19 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


year of Jehoiakim. The third year dating for this campaign on a Tishri 
basis would be the same as the fourth year on a Nisan basis. 


There is no mystery about it. It is as simple as that. Daniel used a Tishri Calendar, while Jeremiah 
used a Nisan Calendar. (These Calendars overlapped by approx. half a year.) 


However BF page 133 says, 


In the ninth month of the fifth year of Jehoiakim’s reign Jeremiah 
36:9, 29 speaks of Babylon’s king as yet to come into the land of 
Judah to ruin it. So, if King Jehoiakim was ‘servant for three years’ to 
the king of Babylon and then rebelled, these must have been the last 
three years of King Jehoiakim’s reign of eleven years. [see 2 Kings 
2:1] In view of this, it must have been toward the end of the eighth 
year of Jehoiakim’s reign at Jerusalem that Nebuchadnezzar came to 
Jerusalem for the first time and made King Jehoiakim his vassal. 


At some time in Jehoiakim’s 4th year (Jer. 36:1), Jeremiah had written on a roll what he had been told 
by Jehovah. In Jehoiakim’s 5th year (Verse 9), Jehoiakim burned the roll, saying 


Why is it that you have written on it, saying: ‘The king of Babylon 
will come without fail and will certainly bring this land to ruin and 
cause man and beast to cease from it’. (Jeremiah 36:29) 


Nebuchadnezzar certainly did not bring Judah, “to ruin and cause man and beast to cease from it” in 
605 BC. But then neither did he do this in Jehoiakim’s 8th year or his 11th year. This passage could 
not be applied to any event prior to Zedekiah’s 11th year (if then). So where is the objection? Will the 
Society argue that Nebuchadnezzar never came to Judah before Zedekiah’s 11th year? 


Judah came under the domination of Babylon in 605 BC, it became a vassal, and no one claims that in 
this year Nebuchadnezzar ruined it and caused man and beast to cease from it. 


Certainly Judah was not in the complete sense desolate, yet it had fallen into Nebuchadnezzar’s hands, 
because Daniel 1:1 says it did. Nevertheless, complete desolation would be the fruitage if the Nation 
continued in its wayward course (Jer. 36:29). What is spoken of in Daniel 1:1 was merely the 
beginning of the process of bringing about the complete punishment spoken of in Jeremiah 36:29. 


The Society explains Daniel 1:1, 


The expression “in the third year of the kingship of Jehoiakim the 
king of Judah” means in the third year of Jehoiakim as a vassal king 
paying tribute to Babylon. Since his vassalage began after he reigned 
eight years in Jerusalem, this third year of his reign as Babylon’s 
vassal would be the eleventh year of his entire reign at Jerusalem. (BF 
page 136.) 


There is no reason to enter into the field of conjecture and guess what “the third year of the kingship 
of Jehoiakim” means. Surely it simply means his 3rd year as King. Remember that the Babylonian 
Chronicle shows that Nebuchadnezzar conquered the whole of Hatti-land at that time. 


The Society’s arrangement on the other hand causes problems with the Scriptures. Notice that BF 
page 134 says 


However, Nebuchadnezzar never did take King Jehoiakim alive. 
Jehoiakim did not make peace with Nebuchadnezzar or surrender to 
him but died inside Jerusalem. 


BF page 135 advises that it was Jehoiachin (the Son of Jehoiakim) who surrendered to 
Nebuchadnezzar at this time. It also reports that “Jehoiachin reigned just three months and ten days.” 
(see 2 Kings 24:8-12, particularly verse 10, which indicates that Jerusalem was besieged during 
Jehoiachin’s reign. 


20 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


Note also BF 287 which reports, 


After being besieged three months at Jerusalem, the young king 
Jehoiachin went out in surrender to Nebuchadnezzar. 


Well then, what about Daniel 1:1, 2? If the 3rd year of Jehoiakim was really his 11th year, how can 
verse 2 be explained which comments concerning then siege, “In time Jehovah gave into his hand 
Jehoiakim the king of Judah?” Interfering with the Scriptures does not solve problems, it causes them. 
The Scriptural records for the events of 605 BC, when Nebuchadnezzar conquered the Hatti-country, 
are rather meagre but evidently Jehoiakim did acknowledge Nebuchadnezzar’s masterhood and 
according to Daniel 1:2, Nebuchadnezzar took “a part of the utensils of the house of the (true) God, so 
that he brought them to the land of Shinar to the house of his god.” 


That these utensils were taken during Jehoiakim’s reign is positively stated in 2 Chronicles 36:7. 
(Note that verses 6 and 8 refer to his reign.) This verse must also then apply to the same events as 
described in Daniel 1:1, 2. A further problem for the Society is obvious, for if Jehoiakim’s 3rd year 
was really his 11th and he was dead before Nebuchadnezzar took Jerusalem after Jehoiachin’s 
surrender, when did he take these utensils? 


The Society’s only escape from this predicament seems to be to try and confuse the taking of part of 
the utensils as described in Daniel 1:2 with the taking of the vessels recorded at 2 Kings 24:13, which 
I quote for comparison. 


Then he brought out from there all the treasures of the house of 
Jehovah and the treasures of the king’s house, and went on to cut to 
pieces all the gold utensils that Solomon the king of Israel had made 
in the temple of Jehovah. 


Removal of the utensils this time was during Jehoiachin’s reign, as is evident from the context. The 
only logical conclusion that does justice to the Scriptures is to accept that Daniel 1:1 applies to the 3rd 
year of Jehoiakim, just as Daniel faithfully recorded it. 


When Jehoiakim rebelled against Nebuchadnezzar and then his son Jehoiachin carried on with this 
opposition, it was natural that Nebuchadnezzar should place a “puppet king” on the throne, and he did 
in the person of Zedekiah. In 605 BC, however, when Judah first became subject to Babylon, 
Nebuchadnezzar had nothing against Jehoiakim and as he apparently submitted with virtually no 
opposition, he was permitted to maintain his position as King, but as a vassal. 


The Babylonian Chronicle for Nebuchadnezzar’s Ist year (regnal) 604 BC, as translated by Wiseman, 
describes his triumphant return to the Hatti-land. “All the kings of the Hatti-land came before him and 
he received their heavy tribute.” Doubtless Jehoiakim, king of the vassal state Judah, was one of these 
kings. 

2 Kings 24:1 has been aligned by the Society with Daniel 1:1, because it mentions 3 years of 
Jehoiakim’s reign, and as the 3rd year of Daniel 1:1 is counted as the last year of his reign, the 3 years 
of 2 Kings 24:1 are considered to be the same, for the record says that after these 3 years, Jehoiakim 
rebelled. 


In his days Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon came up, and so 
Jehoiakim became his servant for three years. However, he turned 
back and rebelled against him. (2 Kings 24:1) 


First of all, let it be noted that although Daniel 1:1 is firmly fixed to the 3rd year of Jehoiakim, 2 
Kings 24:1 is left floating around in the reign of Nebuchadnezzar to a time described as when he 
“came up.” He “came up” in 605 BC, as witnessed to by Daniel, the Babylonian Chronicle and 
Berossus, which could be the occasion referred to. The Babylonian Chronicle also refers to other 
times when he “came up” such as in 604 BC, also in 603 BC, and 602 BC. These visits were designed 
to emphasise his mastery and to collect dues from his tributary states. 


It is probable that 2 Kings 24:1 refers to the years 604 BC, 603 BC, and 602 BC, for it was during 
each of these 3 years that Jehoiakim apparently paid tribute. 


21 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


The Babylonian Chronicle for Nebuchadnezzar, 4th year (601 BC) states: 


In the fourth year the king of Akkad mustered his army and marched 
to the Hatti-land. In the Hatti-land they marched unopposed. 


In the month of Kislev he took the lead of his army and marched to 
Egypt. The King of Egypt heard (it) and mustered his army. 


In open battle they smote the breast (of) each other and inflicted great 
havoc on each other. The king of Akkad and his troops turned back 
and returned to Babylon. 


The record for the 5th year advises that the Babylonian army did not venture from the borders of 
Babylon because of the necessity to reorganise after the heavy losses in the conflict with Egypt. 


In the 6th year, Nebuchadnezzar returned to the Hatti-land but no mention is made of tribute, although 
he probably collected it from some states. 


During the following year, Jerusalem was besieged, Jehoiachin was captured, Zedekiah was placed on 
the throne and the record says of Nebuchadnezzar, he “received its heavy tribute.” (I have already 
quoted the Chronicle for this year.) 


From all this, it is quite reasonable to assume that 3 the years that Jehoiakim served (paid tribute) to 
Babylon were 604 BC, 603 BC, and 602 BC. It is quite unreasonable to assume that Jehoiakim 
became Nebuchadnezzar’s Servant the third year before Jerusalem was captured under Jehoiachin. 


Reviewing what the Babylonian Chronicle says. The 3rd year would correspond with 
Nebuchadnezzar’s 7th, as this was the year according to the Chronicle when Jerusalem was captured. 
The Ist year would on this basis be Nebuchadnezzar’s Sth. 


So that there can be no mistake, I will quote what the Chronicle says: 


In the fifth year, the king of Akkad (Nebuchadnezzar) stayed in his 
own land and gathered together his horses and chariots in great 
numbers. 


After the Babylonians had suffered at the hands of the Egyptians, can you imagine Jehoiakim trotting 
off to Babylon to surrender? He would have had to, for Nebuchadnezzar did not venture from 
Babylon during this year. If you can imagine this you are still wrong, for 2 Kings 24:1 refers to when 
“Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon came up.” It doesn’t say “Jehoiakim came up to Babylon.” The 
Society’s arrangement is contradicted from all angles. 


Because the Babylonians suffered at the hands of Egypt in 601 BC (in what must have been a drawn 
contest), Jehoiakim appears have rebelled against Babylon and to have changed his loyalty to Egypt 
again. (It was Egypt that first placed Jehoiakim on the throne see 2 Kings 24:34 and it was Egypt that 
was looked to for help when Jerusalem was under its final siege by Nebuchadnezzar. Jeremiah 37:7, 
11.) Jehoiakim’s faith in Egypt was not rewarded because Judah was again brought under subjection 
in 597 BC by Babylon. 


It should be obvious from all this that the 3 years that Jehoiakim was “tributary King” to Babylon 
were NOT the last 3 years of his reign, as the Society asserts. There is evidence to prove that whoever 
wrote page 166 of BE has been confused by all the evidence available for the period, for this page 
makes the point that, 


When King Jehoiakim was in open revolt against vassalage to 
Nebuchadnezzar and held out against him in the final three years of 
his reign in Jerusalem, the Jewish nation could not be considered as 
captive to Babylon. 


On page 136 BF, we are told that the 3 years of vassalage were the last of Jehoiakim’s reign, whereas 
on page 166 we are told they were not. I wrote to the Society asking for clarification of the statement 
on page 136 and the reply quite clearly supported the claim that Jehoiakim’s revolt was during his last 
3 years. I noted with interest that the reference to the final 3 years was dropped when an article on this 


22 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


section of BF appeared on pages 734 and 735 of The Watchtower 1st December 1964. The 
contradiction must have been noticed. 


The Society has always been perplexed with statements of Daniel 1:1. The interesting quotation that 
follows is extracted from The Watchtower May 15 1922: 


At the end of the three years Jehoiakim rebelled, Nebuchadnezzar 
took the city, Jehoiakim died, and Nebuchadnezzar left Jehoiachin, a 
son of Jehoiakim, on the throne. He ruled only three months and was 
carried captive to Babylon. 


Those who accept what the Bible says find that Daniel 1:1, 2 fits perfectly into the 3rd year of 
Jehoiakim. It is true that critics who do not accept Daniel as being a true historical record written in 
the 6th Century BC do not have sufficient confidence in Daniel 1:1 to support it. (They consider it to 
have been written in the 2nd Century BC.) 


Joseph P Free 5 on page 224 of Archaeology and Bible History states: 


Bible Scholars in the past have usually held that there were three 
deportations of the people of Judah, who were taken from Palestine to 
Babylonia by Nebuchadnezzar in 606-605, 597 and 586 BC Some 
liberals have doubted the fact of a deportation in 606-605 BC. 


I could list quite a string of Conservative Bible Scholars who find no difficulty in accepting the clear 
historical record of Daniel 1:1, unfortunately the Society would have to be listed with the Liberals. 


There are other objections that the Society has to what Daniel records at Daniel 1:1. There is no need 
to avoid these objections, for when met head on by the truth they soon dissolve. We proceed then, 
examining further objections raised by the Society in the light of the facts. 


The Society’s Objection to the Record of Daniel Chapter 2 


Nebuchadnezzar came to the throne in 605 BC, his 2nd “regnal year” was therefore 603 BC. Daniel 
Chapter 2 is dated to Nebuchadnezzar’s 2nd year (verse 1). Verses 37 and 38 show quite definitely 
that in his 2nd year, Nebuchadnezzar held a position of World Domination as head of the Gentile 
Image. 


The Society cannot have the Gentile Image coming into being before the 19th year of 
Nebuchadnezzar , neither does it want the Babylonian domination over Judah to commence in 605 
BC, for 70 years by “Inclusive Reckoning” from that date brings the concluding date of this 
dominance over Judah to 536 BC, the year the Jews returned from Exile. 


We have examined the Society’s attempt to dispose of Daniel 1:1, and BF page 172 provides the 
Society’s solution to the problem of Daniel 2:1 which, as we shall see, does NOT hold water either. 


The following is quoted from BF page 172. 


Hebrew scholars propose that the Hebrew text of Daniel 2 should be 
“twelfth year” instead of “second year”. (Footnote on Daniel 2:1 in 
Biblia Hebraica, by Rudolf Kittel, ninth edition of 1954. Also see the 
footnote in the Cross-Reference Bible, Variorum Edition, by Harold E 
Monser B.A. edition of 1910.) However, the most reasonable and 
fitting suggestion is that this refers to the “second year” from a 
marked event, namely from Nebuchadnezaar’s destruction of 
Jerusalem in 607 BC. That is when the king of Babylon came to be 
the first one to hold world domination by God’s permission. 


In opposing both of these suggestions, I feel obliged to ask, ““Are we going to believe two Hebrew 
Scholars, or Daniel?” Daniel quite clearly said it was “the second year”. I will provide references 
from two Old Testament Scholars shortly both of whom accept what Daniel said. For those who 
accept God’s Word, there is no confusion. Once we start guessing, we can arrange almost anything. 


23 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


Flavius Josephus, for example, in Antiquities of the Jews 10:10:3 placed the events of Daniel 2 “two 
years after the destruction of Egypt”. The Expositors Bible on “TheBook of Daniel”, page 143 refers 
to “Rashi”, a Jewish Scholar of the 11th Century AD who said that the meaning was “the second year 
after the destruction of the Temple. This of course is the same as the Society’s guess: the “second 
year” from a marked event, namely from Nebuchadnezzar’s destruction of Jerusalem in 607 BC. 


Is it really true that “That is when the king of Babylon came to be the first one to hold World 
Domination by God’s permission?” That Babylon was the “World Power” long before Jerusalem was 
destroyed is certified by the Society on page 84 SI: 


Eliakim, whose name is changed to Jehoiakim and during whose 
reign Judah is subjugated by the new world power, Babylon. 
(emphasis supplied). 


So Babylon was the “World Power” in Jehoiakim’s day! 


Jeremiah 27:5-7 proves that Nebuchadnezzar had received “World Domination” at Jehovah’s hands at 
least in the reign of Zedekiah, for verse 6 says, 


And now I myself have given all these lands into the hands 
Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon, my servant. (Emphasis 
supplied.) 


These verses are further considered in Chapter 4 when Jeremiah 25:11-12 are being reviewed. In the 
meantime, compare them with Daniel 2:38 and Jeremiah 28:14. The similarity of language is striking 
and so is the fact that they all demand that Nebuchadnezzar was holding World Domination by God’s 
permission long before the destruction of Jerusalem. 


Why shouldn’t we accept Daniel’s word that it was in Nebuchadnezzar’s 2nd year, which would have 
been 603/602 BC? 


SI page 139 refers to Daniel chapter 2 as “In the second year of his kingship as world ruler.” As 
Nebuchadnezzar was the ruler of the “world power” in Jehoiakim’s day (SI page 84, quoted above), 
there is no reason that it was not Nebuchadnezzar’s 2nd year. But clearly we have here just another 
mistake on the Society’s part, so we turn to one of the Society’s earlier publications, Equipped for 
Every Good Work (1946), where on pages 226 and 227 we find another objection: 


The time of this dream and its interpretation is stated as the second 
year of Nebuchadnezzar’s reign. Actually, Nebuchadnezzar had been 
reigning over Babylon alone much longer than two years. 


Why, at the time of this dream the young captive Daniel had 
completed his three years of special court training and had been 
introduced to Nebuchadnezzar and had gained quite a reputation for 
wisdom, particularly in dreams and visions. 


The essence of all this is, really, that Daniel and his associates must have completed their 3 years 
training prior to the events of Nebuchadnezzar’s 2nd year. If Daniel and Co. were taken captive in 
Nebuchadnezzar’s “accession year, as I have claimed, how could they squeeze this 3 years training 
prior to the events described as having taken place in his 2nd year? I promised to quote from two Old 


Testament Scholars who do accept Daniel’s word, to match the two who don’t. 
John C Whitcomb, Jr. in Darius the Mede (see BF page 239 footnote) says: 


Daniel’s fame for righteousness and wisdom had been established in 
Babylonia as early as 603/602 BC (Dan. 2:1). Quoted from page 63. 


E J, Young, on page 56 of his The Prophecy of Daniel states: 


It is perfectly possible that the third year of training might fall in the 
second year of the kingship of Neb. A table will make this clear. 


24 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


Years of training 


First year 


Nebuchadnezzar 


Year of Accession 


Second year First Year 


Second year (in which dream 


Third year 
occurred) 


I have already referred to the fact that The Truth Shall Make You Free page 239 makes use of 
“Inclusive Reckoning”. This is also the system employed by Daniel in Chapter 2. This system allowed 
for the first and last units of a group, even if only parts of a whole unit, to be counted as a whole. For 
example the siege of Samaria is described in 2 Kings 18:9 as commencing in the 4th year of 
Hezekiah. Verse 10 says it was captured “at the end of three years” and this was “in the sixth year of 
Hezekiah.” No mistake is possible here because we have a double check by the reign of Hoshea. The 
siege began in his 7th year and ended in his 9th year. 


For numerous other examples see Awake 22nd May 1960, pages 27 and 28. The Society recognises 
this method when it corresponds the 3 years of 2 Kings 24:1, when Jehoiakim became Nebuchad- 
nezzar’s Servant, with the parts of 3 years mentioned in Daniel 1:1. 


Can it deny then that the 3 years of Daniel 2 could also be part of 3 years? There is simply no valid 
reason to shift Daniel Chapter 2 away from Nebuchadnezzar’s 2nd year. Neither can a reason be 
found to shift Daniel 1:1, 2 away from Jehoiakim’s 3rd year. Problems are easily dissolved when we 
view these Scriptures in the light of the methods employed by the Ancient Hebrews. 


More Society objections to Daniel 1:1 


Before moving on from these objections, there are two small problems (raised on page 225 of 
Equipped For Every Good Work) which relate to Daniel 1:1. A brief inspection of these and we will 
have dealt with them all. 


The clear historical record at 2 Kings 24 and 25 shows there were 
only two occasions when conquering Babylon carried captives from 
Jerusalem and Judah. 


These are claimed to have been “at the close of Jehoiachin’s brief reign” and “eleven years later at the 
time of Zedekiah’s fall and Jerusalem’s complete overthrow.” The inference here is, of course, that as 
no mention is made in “Kings” of captives being taken in Jehoiakim’s 3rd (or 4th) year, Daniel must 
have been taken prisoner in one of the groups that are mentioned in “Kings”. This, at first glance, 
seems reasonable. 


But are we to assume that because an historical event is not recorded in “Kings”, it didn’t happen? 2 
Kings 24:1 certainly shows that Nebuchadnezzar “came up” at least on one further occasion and there 
is no evidence to say that this was not in the year recorded by Daniel. 


Because “Kings” does not mention the taking of captives on this occasion does not mean that none 
were taken. Daniel 1:3 indicates that the hostages were only few in number and probably for this 
reason they are not mentioned in “Kings”? Indeed, there is evidence to support this contention for the 
captivities recorded in Jeremiah 52:28-30, in the 7th, 18th, and 23rd years of Nebuchadnezzar are not 
recorded in 2 Kings 24 and 25 either. 


I have already pointed out that the captives of 2 Kings 24:14-16 can hardly be compared with the 
number recorded in Jeremiah 52:29, and 2 Kings 25:11 compared with Jeremiah 52:29 reveals a huge 
discrepancy. 


It must be considered, therefore, that the minor captivities of Jehoiakim’s 3rd (or 4th) year and of 
Nebuchadnezzar’s 7th and 18th years, were not of sufficient significance to be recorded by the 
compiler of Kings. 


25 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


The fact that Daniel 1:2 (supported by 2 Chronicles 36:5-8) insists that Jehoiakim was at least in 
Nebuchadnezzar’s hands during his reign and that Temple Vessels were also taken at this time, proves 
that Daniel 1:1 and the prisoners mentioned therein have nothing to do with events which occurred 
during the reign of either Jehoiachin or Zedekiah. Therefore Daniel 1:1 quite positively is 
Chronologically accurate. 


I have deliberately withheld comments on the captivity which occurred in Nebuchadnezzar’s 23rd 
year (Jeremiah 52:30), to a later portion of this investigation. It should be apparent that this captivity 
cannot be aligned with either of the 2 captivities recorded in 2 Kings 24 or 25. 


The final objection throws the spotlight on the wording of Daniel 1:1. 


In the third year of the kingship of Jehoiakim the king of Judah, 
Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon came to Jerusalem and 
proceeded to lay siege to it. 


“This could not be”, says page 225 of Equipped For Every Good Work “because Nebuchadnezzar was 
not enthroned till the following year.” 


It is perfectly true that in 605 BC, when he conquered the whole of the Hatti-land, Nebuchadnezzar 
was not “the king of Babylon.” Nevertheless, attention has already been drawn to the fact that he was 
fulfilling the roll of King, by leading the Babylonian army, in the absence of his father who was 
apparently ill, Consequently he may have been regarded as King in the Hatti-land a year before he 
was actually crowned. But the solution is probably as Young points out, “the statement is not 
inaccurate, but is used proleptically, ... as we say ‘In the childhood of President Washington.’” The 
Prophecy of Daniel, page 35. Daniel probably recorded these events years after they took place. 
Maybe even after Nebuchadnezzar was dead. It would be no strange thing for him to refer to 
Nebuchadnezzar then as “the King of Babylon,” even if at the time referred to, he was not entitled to 
that status. 


Summary of the Last Years of Judah 


Seeing that the necessity to examine objections has caused our discussion to become somewhat 
disjointed, I will briefly summarise what did happen and then perhaps we can disregard what did NOT 
happen. 


The Babylonian Chronicle discloses that Nebuchadnezzar was on an expedition in 605 BC, and during 
this time he encountered and defeated the Egyptian forces at Carchemish. At the same time he gained 
mastery over the whole area, thus becoming the new “World Power”. 


Judah was besieged and although the events are not given in detail, we know from Daniel 1:1-3 and 2 
Chronicles 36:5-8 that Jehoiakim was somehow taken by Nebuchadnezzar and despite the fact that he 
intended to take him captive he apparently relented and Jehoiakim was permitted to retain his 
kingship, but as a Vassal to Babylon. Some of the Temple Vessels were taken to the Babylonian 
Temple, probably as an offering indicating Nebuchadnezzar’s gratitude for his success. Prisoners, or 
Hostages including Daniel were taken to Babylon and these are mentioned in the fragments of the 
writings of the Ancient Babylonian Historian, Berossus. (Josephus Against Apion, 1:19.) 


After serving Babylon as a tributary king for three years, faithfully paying his annual tribute, 
Jehoiakim was incited to rebellion by the successful show of force by Egypt in 601 BC (2 Kings 
24:1). Jehoiakim finally died in mysterious circumstances and after a short siege during the reign of 
his son Jehoiachin, Jerusalem surrendered to Nebuchadnezzar on the 15/1 6th of March, 597 BC. 


At least as early as the reign of Zedekiah we found that Jehovah had given the World Rule to 
Nebuchadnezzar (Jeremiah 27:5-7), and Daniel 2:1, 37 and 38 show that he had this authority in the 
2nd year of his rule, making it certain that this power was gained when he defeated the Egyptians at 
Carchemish and conquered the whole of the Hatti-country in 605 BC. 


26 


Chapter three. Overthrow of Kingdom 70 years before restoration? 


BE page 137 reports in a footnote: 


After his victory at that place (Carchemish) Nebuchadnezzar had all 
Palestine at his mercy. Telling what followed this, 2 Kings 24:7 says 
‘Never again did the king of Egypt come out from his land for the 
king of Babylon had taken all that happened to belong to the king of 
Egypt from the torrent valley of Egypt up to the river Euphrates.’ 


This is perfectly true and Judah had belonged to Egypt so it was taken by Babylon as a result of the 
Battle of Carchemish and the triumphant sweep through the land by Nebuchadnezzar in 605 BC. This 
is really opposed to the Society’s teaching and is just another of their contradictory statements. 


Before concluding this chapter, it just remains to draw attention to the fact that the evidence maintains 
its harmonious and distinct trend toward situating the 70 years in a Chronological framework (605 
BC-536 BC) which completely puts to rout the arrangement of events which the Society puts forward 
and upon which it shakily sits. 


27 


CHAPTER FOUR. JUDAH 70 YEARS DESOLATE, 
OR 70 YEARS WITHOUT INHABITANTS? 


The crux of the matter here is that the Society confuses the period of servitude to Babylon, which is 
defined as 70 years, with the period of total desolation which is not defined and the length of which is 
not certain. As we have seen and will see, there is no conclusive evidence to prove exactly when the 
land became totally desolate or exactly when it again gained occupants. 


As one searches Babylon the Great has Fallen and All Scripture is Inspired of God and Beneficial it 
becomes evident that there are only 5 Scriptures that the Society uses to teach the complete desolation 


of Judah for 70 years. Each of these does refer to a 70 year period. They are Jeremiah 25:11; 25:12; 
29:10; Daniel 9:2; and 2 Chronicles 36:21. Jeremiah was the Prophet who gave notice of the 70-year 
period; Daniel and the Chronicler merely referred to Jeremiah in their writings years later. Logically 
then, we should review Jeremiah’s predictions first. 


Jeremiah 25:11, 12 
These verses together read, 


“And all this land must become a devastated place, an object of 
astonishment, and these nations will have to serve the king of 
Babylon seventy years. And it must occur that when seventy years 
have been fulfilled I shall call to account against the king of Babylon 
and against that nation,” is the utterance of Jehovah, “their error, even 
against the land of the Chaldeans, and I will make it desolate wastes 
to time indefinite.” 


The setting of these verses is, as verse | testifies, in the 4th year of Jehoiakim. This was of course 605 
BC, the year when Nebuchadnezzar conquered the whole area and took Daniel and Co. to Babylon. 


BF page 127 comments: 


Thus, while the Land of Judah lay uninhabited seventy years, the 
whole nation was to serve the kings of Babylon. 


Why did the land of Judah have to lay uninhabited for the nation to serve the king of Babylon? 
SI page 127, when commenting on Jeremiah 25, says: 


First, Nebuchadnezzar is identified as Jehovah’s servant to devastate 
Judah and the surrounding nations, “and these nations will have to 
serve the king of Babylon seventy years.” Then it will be Babylon’s 
turn, and she will become desolate wastes to time indefinite. 


The two passages quoted are extracted from Jeremiah 25:11 and 12. The question that immediately 
comes to mind is, “Did the other nations have to lie uninhabited for seventy years for the whole of the 
nations to serve the kings of Babylon?” 


When Babylon gained its ascendency under Nebuchadnezzar in 605 BC and became the new “World 
Power’, the other nations were obviously dominated by or serving Babylon. The “Cyrus Cylinder”, 
part of which is quoted in SI page 336, certifies that these captives were released early in Cyrus’ 
reign, as were the Jews, but surely the Society will not insist that they all had to be in Babylon for 70 
years to serve the Kings of Babylon while their lands lay uninhabited. 


There is no need to discuss this further for the Society will have to admit that this was not necessary. 
The same concession must also be allowed for Judah. It was not necessary for the land to be 
uninhabited for the whole nation to serve the kings of Babylon 70 years. This is not mere guesswork, 
it is the clear Scriptural Teaching! 


Daniel 2:37, 38 prove that Nebuchadnezzar was the King of the “World Power” and as such all the 
Nations were his servants. The argument is not dependant on Daniel chapter 2 however, and as the 
Society contests the validity of the date supplied by Daniel, we will pass on to what is other positive 


28 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


evidence anyway, and which proves that Judah was serving Babylon long before Jerusalem was 
destroyed in Zedekiah’s 11th year. These passages are provided by the same writer that spoke of the 
70 years of service to Babylon, namely Jeremiah. 


Jeremiah 27:1 locates a message as being given, “In the beginning of the kingdom of Jehoiakim”’. 
Verse 3 though, refers to events in Zedekiah’s reign and it may be that a copyist has corrupted the 

text, so that it reads “Jehoiakim” instead of “Zedekiah” in Verse 1. (See the New World Translation of 
the Hebrew Scriptures Vol. IV (1953), page 27. Footnote: “e”, which refers to several manuscripts 
which do contain ““Zedekiah” in verse 1.) Whatever the circumstances, it cannot be disputed that the 
time is fixed long before the destruction of Jerusalem. 


It seems that a further revolt against Babylon was being planned and a conference had been held in 
Jerusalem. When the messengers were about to return to their respective masters, Jeremiah was 
inspired to prophesy against further futile opposition to Babylon. Jeremiah gave each of them a 
“yoke” to take home to their “King” (Jeremiah 27:1-4). He also passed on to them a message: 


I myself have made the earth, mankind and the beasts that are upon 
the surface of the earth by my stretched-out arm; and I have given it 
to whom it has proved right in my eyes. And now I myself have given 
all these lands into the hand of Nebuchadnezzar, the king of Babylon 
my servant; and even the wild beasts of the field I have given him to 
serve him. And all the nations must serve even him and his son and 
his grandson until the time even of his own land comes, and many 
nations and great kings must exploit him as a servant. (Jeremiah 27:5- 
7) 


The following verses show that they would continue to serve Babylon, either by consent or by 
compulsion. If by consent, they could stay in their own land (verse 12). Then the land would not 
become desolate in the complete sense (see verse 13). Verse 14 onwards speak of false prophets who 
advised against serving Babylon. They said, “Look! The utensils of the house of Jehovah are being 
brought back from Babylon soon now!” (verse 16). In other words, do not continue to serve 
voluntarily, for the power of Babylon will soon be broken. 


If they really were servants of Jehovah, they should beseech him that the remaining utensils should 
not be taken to Babylon (verse 18). This would stop the progress of God's judgement against them. 
The judgement could have remained comparatively light if they would submit, but it would get 
continually worse if they did not. But more on this progressive judgement as we consider other 
passages. 


The objective of referring to Jeremiah 27 was to emphasise verse 6. 


And now I myself have given all these lands into the hand of 
Nebuchadnezzar. (emphasis mine) 


What Jehovah spoke of here was an accomplished fact, the lands had been given to Nebuchadnezzar 
and they must serve him as He had required through Jeremiah's utterance at Jeremiah 25:11. 


Can it be denied after an honest examination of this chapter that the Land of Judah did NOT have to 
be uninhabited for the nation to serve the king of Babylon? 


There is more that can be said of this “yoke” of servitude to Babylon (Jeremiah 27:2, 12). 


Attention is drawn to Jeremiah 28. Here we have the record of another false prophet Hananiah who 
said: 


This is what Jehovah of armies, the God of Israel, has said, “I will 
break the yoke of the king of Babylon. Within two full years more I 
am bringing back to this place all the utensils of the house of Jehovah 
that Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon took from this place, that he 
might bring them to Babylon.” (Jeremiah 28:2, 3) 


29 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


The true prophet said they would serve 70 years (Jeremiah 25:11). The false prophet said that inside 2 
years, the servitude would end. But it did not end, they were serving Babylon then and they continued 
to do so until the 70 years expired. 


There was to be a change in this servitude though, for in verses 10 and 11 we are informed of 
Hananiah's bold move in breaking the yoke from the neck of Jeremiah and prophesying that Jehovah 
would “break the yoke of Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon within two full years more from off 
the neck of all the nations” (verse 11). 


Jeremiah was instructed to say: 


Yoke bars of wood you have broken, and instead of them you will 
have to make yoke bars of iron. For this is what Jehovah of armies, 
the God of Israel, has said, “A yoke of iron I will put upon the neck of 
all these nations, to serve Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon, and 
they must serve him.” 


Here again we have evidence of the progressive judgement. They could submit voluntarily or suffer 
the iron-like servitude by compulsion, which resulted in the complete desolation of the land. 


At this juncture, I think it fair to say that there is nothing in Jeremiah 25:11 to contradict the 
contention that Judah was serving Babylon from 605 BC. Can't we imagine Jeremiah, shortly after the 
Battle of Carchemish, surveying the situation and saying that Judah would have to remain subject to 
Babylon for 70 years? 


Surely nothing could be clearer than Jeremiah 27:17: 


Serve the king of Babylon and keep on living. Why should this city 
become a devastated place? 


The answer was of course that it did not have to become desolate in the complete sense if they served 
voluntarily. Rebellion would result in serving by compulsion. 


Quite clearly the 70 years of Jeremiah 25:11 commenced in 605 BC, so we move on to examine 
Jeremiah 25:12 


When seventy years have been fulfilled, I shall call to account against 
the king of Babylon. 


That Babylon gained its dominant position in 605 BC has been proven beyond doubt. When the iron 
yoke of enforced servitude was finally brought down upon the Jews, the majority of them were taken 
to Babylon. For the 70 year period of dominance to end, the oppressor itself must be oppressed and in 
accordance with God's purpose, the last shadow of Babylonian dominance was removed from Judah 
when in 536 BC the land was repopulated by God-fearing Jews. That the 70-year period of 
Babylonian dominance began in 605 BC is beyond question. The evidence continues to be clear and 
consistent but we have much more yet. 


What of Jeremiah 29:10? 


About 10 years before Jerusalem was destroyed, Nebuchadnezzar carried a large number of Jews, 
including King Jehoiachin, into exile at Babylon (Jeremiah 29:1). 


Once again difficulty was being experienced with false prophets, but this time at Babylon (verses 8 
and 9). The true prophet Jeremiah wrote a letter to the exiles in Babylon in order to clarify their 
position. Verses from 4 onward contain the text of the letter, which advised them to settle down in 
Babylon, build houses, carry on in the usual way by marrying and having families: 


For this is what Jehovah has said, “In accord with the fulfilling of 
seventy years at Babylon I shall turn my attention to you people, and I 
will establish toward you my good word in bringing you back to this 
place”. (verse 10) 


30 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


The intent of the message was clearly to inform them not to expect early deliverance and so to be 
content to remain in Babylon until Jehovah permitted their release in harmony with his purpose to 
accomplish 70 years at (or for) Babylon. Clearly they were being reminded of the limit of Babylonian 
domination, which was to last for 70 years. This period had already commenced and there was no 
hope of averting it or of cutting it short. These people were in Babylon and must stay there until the 
period expired. 


In a great number of translations the expression “for Babylon” is presented (e.g., ASV), but the New 
World Translation of the Society has “at Babylon.” If “for Babylon” should be accepted then it 
obviously refers to the period of Babylonian domination. If it refers to a period at Babylon then 
obviously the period had started years before the destruction of Jerusalem. 


There had been Captives at Babylon since the deportation of Daniel and his companions in 605 BC, 
but the Scripture doesn’t necessarily say that Captives had to be at Babylon for 70 years. The Society 
obviously translates it “at Babylon” with a view toward suggesting that this took place after the 
destruction and so the land was empty for 70 years while the people were at Babylon. 


BE page 137 puts forward such a claim, and comments concerning the captivity of Jehoiachin and 
various others: 


The vast majority of the people remained, and Jerusalem and the 
other Judean cities remained populated, and the land was by no means 
left an uninhabited desolation. Not all the people of Judah were then 
doing service at Babylon to the king of Babylon. 


This statement was made in an endeavour to prove that the 70 year period had not begun. BUT all of 
the people did not have to be at Babylon in order to serve the king of Babylon. 


The prediction at Jeremiah 25:11 concerned “these nations” who would serve the king of Babylon 70 
years. The truth is that all of the people never did go to Babylon. Many fled to Egypt as Jeremiah 
43:5-7 testifies, and Jeremiah 44:28 provides evidence that some would return to Judah from that 
Country. Therefore, if all the people had to be at Babylon, as the Society insists, before the king of 
Babylon could be served, we must conclude that the prophecy was never fulfilled. 


We need not fret though, for quite clearly the people of Judah served Babylon from 605 BC, and for a 
while at least, in Judah. 


Vetus Testamentum V1:3 (a quarterly published by the International Organization of Old Testament 
Scholars) contains an interesting article by Avigdor Orr, “The Seventy Years Of Babylon.” While I do 
not want to give the impression that I agree with the entire article, I was struck with the similarity 
between what I have written on Jeremiah 25:11, 12 and 29:10 above and what Orr wrote concerning 
these Scriptures on page 305. The following is the section concerned 


We read in Jer. XXIX 10: “After seventy years will be accomplishes 
for Babylon I will visit you”. The sense of the Hebrew original might 
even be rendered thus: “After seventy years of (the rule of) Babylon 
are accomplished etc.” The seventy years counted here evidently refer 
to Babylon and NOT to the Judeans or to their captivity. They mean 
seventy years of Babylonian rule, the end of which will see the 
redemption of the exiles. 


The question may be raised how these seventy years of Babylonian 
tule are to be calculated. The second relevant passage, Jer. XXV 9-12, 
makes this quite clear. According to the date in XX V 1, this passage 
was spoken in the fourth year of Jehoiakim, the first year of 
Nebuchadnezzar, i.e. in 605. Verse 9 speaks of Jahveh’s bringing the 
families of the north and the king of Babylon against ‘this land’ (ie. 
Judah) and against all the nations round about, and predates their 
destruction. 


31 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


According to v.11b, these people shall serve the king of Babylon 
seventy years, while v.12 states that the king of Babylon will be 
punished at the end of seventy years. It follows from v.11b that 
seventy years begin from the imposition of the Babylonian yoke on 
Judah and its neighbours. This took place as a result of the battle of 
Carchemish in 605, and is therefore in accord with the (genuine or 
attributed) date of the prophecy. 


Orr is just one of the numerous Old Testament Scholars who finds no difficulties in commencing the 
70 years while the land was still occupied. But then, unlike the Society, he has no axe to grind. 


The Desolation of Judah from 605 BC Continual and Increasing 


Before passing on to Daniel 9:2, I want to emphasise the very important truth that when Babylon 
commenced its period of ascendancy in 605 BC, the people of Judah could have remained in Judah 
and submitted to Babylon during this period. They need never have been deported to Babylon and 
would not have been, except for their rebellion. This is a conclusion from which there is just no 
escape. 


Perhaps you are thinking to yourself; “What about the prophecy’s saying that the land would become 
completely desolate without man or domestic animals?” Well, what about them? The answer is of 
course that they need never have been fulfilled if the nation had submitted as Jeremiah constantly 
pleaded with them to. My authority for saying this is again Jeremiah. Please read Chapter 18:1-11. 
The following are verses 7 and 8: 


At any moment that I may speak against a nation and against a 
kingdom to uproot (it) and to pull (it) down and to destroy (it), and 
that nation actually turns back from its badness against which I spoke, 
I will also feel regret over the calamity that I had thought to execute 
upon it! 


Jehovah is just and merciful and we have an example of a reversal of promised judgement in the case 
of the people of Ninevah (see Jonah 3:1-10). Jonah 3:10 says: 


And the (true) God got to see their works, that they had turned back 
from their bad way; and so the (true) God felt regret over the calamity 
that he had spoken of causing to them; and he did not cause (it). 


Note the similarity of language between this passage and Jeremiah 18:7 and 8 just quoted. Judah 
could have been saved similarly. 


In the beginning of the reign of Jehoiakim (Jer. 26:1), Jeremiah implored the people of Judah: 


Make your ways and your dealings good, and obey the voice of 
Jehovah your God, and Jehovah will feel regret for the calamity that 
he has spoken against you. (Jer. 26:13) 


Even in the 4th year of Jehoiakim (Jer. 36:1), a similar plea was made. 


Perhaps those of the house of Judah will listen to all the calamity that 
I am thinking of doing to them, to the end that they may return, each 
one from his bad way, and that I may actually forgive their error and 
their sin. 


During this same year, the calamity began to come upon them (Jer. 25:1 and 29 — please read these 
verses). The subjection to Babylon began. 


In the 10th year of Zedekiah (Jer. 32:1), the calamity which was coming upon them was serious 
indeed, for Jerusalem was under its final siege (verse 2). Jeremiah said: 


All the things that you commanded them to do they did not do, so that 
you caused all this calamity to befall them. (Jer. 32:23) 


32 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


The Nation was reaping the fruits of disobedience. Even then, submission to Babylon would have 
lessened the severity of the punishment. 


If you will without fail go out to the princes of the king of Babylon, 
your soul will also certainly keep living and this city itself will not be 
burned with fire, and you, yourself and your household will certainly 
keep living. (Jer. 38:17) 


But Zedekiah did not submit. The city was burned (Jer. 39:8) and a large number of people were taken 
to Babylon (verse 9). However some people remained (verse 10). 


Despite all that had happened, Jehovah was still prepared for Judah to remain inhabited. Compare 
Jeremiah 18:7 and 8 — which I have already quoted — with Jeremiah 42:10: 


If you will without fail keep dwelling in this land I will also build you 
up and I shall not tear (you) down, and I will plant you and I shall not 
uproot (you); for I shall certainly feel regret over the calamity that I 
have caused to you. 


These words were spoken to the small group that remained in the land after the destruction of 
Jerusalem under Zedekiah, and so it was still possible that the land would not become desolate in the 
complete sense. Typically, the people disobeyed and went to Egypt (Jer. 43:7). 


The simple lesson to be learned from all this is that those to whom Jeremiah addressed his letter about 
10 years before Jerusalem was destroyed (Jer. 29:10) did not have to wait in Babylon for 70 years 
after Judah became empty, because after they had been taken into exile, there was still the prospect 
that the land would never be completely emptied. The fact that Prophets including Jeremiah had 
foretold its desolation in the complete sense provides no grounds for argument, because promised 
judgements can be set aside. 


The events of the last years of Judah show that the complete emptying of Judah was a progressive 
affair which was brought about in several stages, but at the same time it could have been halted at any 
time because of Jehovah’s mercy. 


The Society has unfortunately withheld these points from its followers as it has also much other 
relative information. Those who are considering these points for the first time may be beginning to see 
the light. But then light hurts sore eyes, and we can always shut them if the light hurts. 


Daniel 9:2 


In the first year of his reigning I myself, Daniel discerned by the 
books the number of the years concerning which the word of Jehovah 
had occurred to Jeremiah the prophet, for fulfilling the devastations of 
Jerusalem (namely) seventy years. 


This was spoken in 538 BC, Babylon had now fallen and Cyrus was King of the new “World Empire” 
(see Isa 44:28). Perhaps it was this that influenced Daniel to inquire of the prophecy of Jeremiah, just 
how soon release from Babylonish bondage would be possible. 


He said he was able to observe from “books” how long Jehovah had told Jeremiah the devastations of 
Jerusalem would last. What these “books” were is uncertain, but it is reasonable to assume that they 
were at least parts of what today comprises the book of Jeremiah. Seeing that there are only two 
chapters in which Jeremiah mentions the 70 years (chapters 25 and 29), it seems certain Daniel had at 
least one of these. 


It is interesting to note that the word translated “letter” at Jeremiah 29:1 is the same word translated 
“books” at Daniel 9:2. But then at Jeremiah 25:13, Jeremiah calls his prophecy related to the 70 years 
“this book”, the word again being the same. 


So perhaps Daniel had all that Jeremiah had written plus other portions of the writings that comprised 
the Scriptures at that time. It matters not, but it does matter what it was that Daniel “discerned”. He 
said it was “the number of the years.” This would be from either or both Jeremiah 25:11 and 29:10. 


33 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


The number was of course 70 (years). During this time “the devastations of Jerusalem” would be 
fulfilled or the devastated condition would be completed at the end of the 70 years. To ascertain what 
Daniel discerned we have to inquire, what is meant by “the devastations of Jerusalem”? 


The Society uses this Scripture as though it was a description of Jerusalem when it was without man 
and domestic animal. Strong’s Hebrew and Chaldee Dictionary reveals that the word used by Daniel 
is the Hebrew expression CHORBAH, which is translated “decayed place”, “desolate”, “desolation’’, 
“destruction” and “waste”. 


There are several other Hebrew words closely related to this word, which are also translated 
“desolate”. Daniel used CHORB AH in the plural sense, which is usually translated “desolations”. The 
Society translates it “devastations”, or “devastated place”. 


Seeing that this (9:2) is the only occurrence of CHORB AH” in the whole of Daniel’s writings it seems 
very likely that Daniel had just read Jeremiah chapter 25, for there this word is used in relation to 
Jerusalem and the 70 years. Jeremiah 25:11 says: 


And all this land must become a devastated place, an object of 
astonishment, and these nations will have to serve the king of 
Babylon seventy years. 


Our attention is directed here to two facts: 
1. The land would become a devastated place. 
2. The nations would serve Babylon 70 years. 


We have already acknowledged that SI page 127 refers this passage to “Judah and the surrounding 
nations” (see Jeremiah 25:9). When did the land become a “devastated place”, or a “desolation” as 
other translations have it? 


As we cast our eyes a little further in the 25th chapter of Jeremiah, we encounter a symbolic cup in 
verse 15 containing the wine of Jehovah’s rage which Jeremiah was to pass to various nations. Their 
drinking from this cup symbolised their receiving judgement from Jehovah, The cup is handed first of 
all to “Jerusalem and the cities of Judah and her kings, her princes, to make them a devastated place, 
an object of astonishment, something to whistle at and a malediction, just as at this day” (emphasis 
supplied). 


Were Jerusalem and Judah already a devastated place as at that day (in the 4th year of Jehoiakim, 605 
BC, Jeremiah 25:1)? 


Jamieson, Faussett and Brown (Commentary) remark on this verse: 


The accomplishment of the curse had already begun under Jehoiakim. 
This clause may, however, have been inserted by Jeremiah at his 
revision of the prophecies in Egypt. 


(There is nothing in the Bible to suggest that Jeremiah added this clause and the only persons that 
would insist on this would be those who have some particular theory to maintain.) 


The Commentary of Matthew Henry says: 


This part of the prophecy was already begun to be accomplished; this 
is denoted by that melancholy parenthesis (as it is this day), for in the 
fourth year of Jehoiakim things had come into a very bad posture, and 
all the foundations were out of course. 


Earlier in our discussion we found that the desolation of Judah in the complete sense was brought 
about progressively. This is in fact what had happened in the 4th year of Jehoiakim (605 BC), the land 
had commenced to become desolate, Judah had fallen into the hands of Babylon. After other 
devastations at the hands of Nebuchadnezzar and apparently because of other factors, the land finally 
became completely desolate. 


34 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


The Society claims the desolation began after the murder of Gedeliah and the departure of the Jews to 
Egypt. SI page 284 claims that: 


Then only, from about October 1, 607, was the land in the complete 
sense “lying desolated ... to fulfil seventy years.” (emphasis supplied). 


If the Society does not recognise that the land was desolate in an “incomplete sense” prior to the 
events mentioned, why does it qualify desolate by saying “in the complete sense”? How can they deny 
that the land was desolate for a period at least in an incomplete sense? 


If you are not convinced that the land could be “desolate” or “devastated” without being void of 
inhabitants, I suggest that you refer again to the Bible and this time to Ezekiel 33:27, 28, so that all 
doubt will be removed: 


This is what you should say to them, “This is what the Lord Jehovah 
has said: ‘As I am alive, surely the ones who are in the devastated 
places will fall by the sword itself; and the one who is upon the 
surface of the field’ (etc.).” 


The Hebrew word for “devastated” is again CHORBAH, and verse 28 reveals that this “devastated” 
land would be the subject of further “devastation” or “desolation”. There is no alternative but to 
accept that land in CHORBAH condition can still have occupants. That is of course if we accept what 
the Bible says. 


The Interpreters Bible, when commenting on the word CHORBAH at Daniel 9:2, states: 


A word often employed to describe the state of a devastated land after 
the armies of an enemy have passed. 


The only sane conclusion to arrive at then is that Daniel was not referring to a period when the land of 
Judah was empty without man or domestic animal. 


I realise that to Jehovah’s Witnesses in general, the thought of Judah lying desolate but at the same 
time having inhabitants, is a new one. Therefore, a further demonstration of this possibility might 
help. 


You will recall that Jehovah at Jeremiah 25:12 promised to also make Babylon “desolate”. BF around 
page 395 gives evidence of the progressive desolation of Babylon and on page 396 asserts that: 


In spite of these continued activities at and about Babylon, the 
prophetic word of Jehovah God against Babylon had to be fulfilled 
finally to the letter. 


T G Pinches in The Old Testament in the Light of the Historical Records of Assyria and Babylonia 
wrote a chapter, “The Decline of Babylon”. On page 477 we are informed: 


The Babylonians could not have regarded the continual and 
increasing desolation of their city with indifference. 


Page 479 emphasises the point: 


Notwithstanding the desolation of the city, however, a certain number 
of people continued to inhabit the site. 


Further on, reference is made “to those who inhabited Babylon’s desolation.” 


Without doubt, Daniel looked back to the first devastation of Jerusalem at the hands of Nebuchad- 
nezzar in the year when he was taken captive (605 B.C.), then the desolation began and in 538 BC, the 
70 years had almost expired. 


The comment that follows is from The Prophecy of Daniel by Edward J Young, a conservative Old 
Testament Scholar, when commenting on Daniel 9:2 on pages 183 and 184: 


The thought may be paraphrased: “With respect to the desolation of 
Jerusalem, 70 years must be completed.” This desolation began with 


35 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


the captivity of Daniel and the first devastation of Jerusalem in 606 
BC, the third year of Jehoiakim. Hence, in the first year of Darius, the 
period of desolation would be almost expired. This seems to be the 
reckoning in 2 Chr. 36:21-23; Ezra 1:1ff. 


Professor Young finds nothing strange when Daniel is referring to the devastations of Jerusalem 
commencing when the land was occupied. His book was published in 1949, which year was of course 
before the publishing of the new “Babylonian Chronicles”. It could be assumed that the reference to 
606 BC would now be corrected to 605 BC. In any case, this minor matter does not make any 
difference to the conclusions reached above. 


There is no specific statement in the Bible stating when the 70 years began, but the evidence 
continues to be clear and consistent that they began in 605 BC. 


God’s mercy is also a factor to be taken into consideration and in this regard, the comment of Mathew 
Henry in his Commentary is very interesting: 


It is a great doubt when these seventy years commences; some date 
them from the captivity in the fourth year of Jehoiakim and first of 
Nebuchadnezzar, others from the captivity of Jehoiachin eight years 
after. I rather incline to the former, because then these nations began 
to serve the king of Babylon and because usually God has taken the 
earliest time from which to reckon the accomplishment of a promise 
of mercy, as will appear in computing the 400 years servitude in 
Egypt. And if so, eighteen or nineteen years of the seventy had run 
out before Jerusalem and the temple were quite destroyed in the 
eleventh year of Zedekiah. (Comment on Jeremiah 25:11, 12, etc) 


If we read just Exodus 12:40, 41, we would gain the impression that the sons of Israel dwelt in Egypt 
for 430 years. In actual fact they only dwelt there about 215 years. A careful analysis of all the 
information available on the subject shows that Jehovah counted the period from right back in the 
days of Abraham (Genesis 12:4). See SI page 285 for further details of this period. 


This is not direct evidence bearing on the 70 years, but it is worth considering that Jehovah would 
count the 70-year period from the earliest possible moment. All the evidence so far proves 
conclusively that He did. 


2 Chronicles 36:21 


Many years after Jeremiah and Daniel had passed from the scene, there lived another prominent 
Servant of Jehovah in Judah called Ezra. Ezra wrote the final passage that we have to consider among 
those used by the Society to teach their 70-year arrangement. 2 Chronicles 36:21 says: 


To fulfill Jehovah’s word by the mouth of Jeremiah, until the land had 
paid off its sabbaths. All the days of lying desolated it kept sabbath, to 
fulfill seventy years. 


SI page 84 comments: 


The closing verses of 2 Chronicles (36:17-23) give conclusive proof 
of the fulfilling of Jeremiah 25:12 and in addition, show that a full 
seventy years must be counted from the complete desolation of the 
land to the restoration of Jehovah’s worship at Jerusalem in 537 BCE. 
This desolation therefore begins 607 BCE, and not 586 BCE, as some 
Bible chronologies assert. 


If this passage in 2 Chronicles does give “conclusive proof” of what is claimed, then it is manifest that 
it contradicts everything else that we have observed. Before proceeding further, attention is drawn to 
two further peculiarities in the Society’s statement. 


36 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


1. “The complete desolation of the land”, confirming that the Society recognises a degree of 
desolation to be possible. 


2. “607 BCE, and not 586 BCE.” Again we are encouraged to believe that adjustment should be 
made to the commencing date of the 70 years. Why not 516 BCE, and not 537 BCE? 
Unfortunately the Society will not be tempted into providing an answer to this question. 


Before making up our minds whether 2 Chronicles 36:21 does provide conclusive proof of what the 
Society asserts, we should follow the wise course and have a good look at the Scripture. 


Awake of March 8, 1965 page 28 offers some suggestions that should be applied in our investigation. 
Surely the Society will not object to our use of the methods it suggests. I quote the passage for our 
guidance: 


A person can find contradictions in practically any piece of literature 
if statements are taken out of context. So if he is looking for such 
contradictions in the Bible, he will find many examples to satisfy his 
mind. On the other hand, if one considers the writer’s viewpoint, the 
circumstances at the time of writing, and the context in which the 
material is set, he will find the Bible to be wonderfully harmonious 
and accurate. 


From this point of view, we will approach 2 Chronicles 36:21. 


The Society accepts that Ezra wrote both books of Chronicles and stressed the “priestly element” and 
emphasised the “levitical spirit” (SI page 75). While these books contain Chronological details, they 
were never intended to be strict Historical Books (see SI page 75). 


SI page 75 paras 2 and 3 provide further suggestions by the Society on why the books were written. 
These books omit entirely the history of the 10 tribe Kingdom, but the lineage of Judah is recorded. 


He depicted Judah’s greatest kings as engaged in building or restoring 
the temple and zealously leading in the worship of God. He pointed 
out the religious sins that led to the kingdom’s overthrow, while 
emphasizing also God’s promises of restoration. He stressed the 
importance of pure worship by focusing attention on the many details 
pertaining to the temple, its priests, the Levites, the masters of song, 
and so on. (SI page 75). 


The period of captivity is left blank and then Ezra takes up the history of his nation again in the book 
bearing his own name. 


In considering a little further Ezra’s “viewpoint” and “the circumstances at the time of writing”, I 
quote a little more from SI page 75: 


Why was Chronicles written? Consider the setting. The captivity to 
Babylon had ended about seventy-seven years before. The Jews were 
resettled in their land. However, there was a dangerous trend away 
from Jehovah’s worship at the rebuilt temple in Jerusalem. ... In view 
of Jehovah’s prophecies regarding the Kingdom, it was also vital to 
have a clear and dependable record of the lineage of Judah and of 
David. 


If we have in mind the reason for Ezra’s statements, we should not be surprised if we find that his 
statement at 2 Chronicles 36:21 is ambiguous from a Chronological point of view. 


We have to acknowledge that something happened “to fulfil Jehovah’s word by the mouth of 
Jeremiah”, but what was fulfilled as prophesied by Jeremiah? The Society confines it to 2 Chronicles 
36:17-23, “giving conclusive proof of the fulfilling of Jeremiah 25:12” (25:11 is apparently intended 
here). 


37 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


What had been reported in these verses undoubtedly fulfilled what Jehovah said through Jeremiah, 
BUT not in verse 11 (or 12), for events fulfilling this verse began in verse 6 of 2 Chronicles 36. What 
were the events then that the Chronicler referred to? Who can say for sure? If it was Jeremiah 25:11; 
36:29-31; etc., then he commenced his description of it in verse 6. If he was referring to such 
predictions as Jeremiah 38:18, they were fulfilled in 2 Chronicles 36:17-19. 


The next claim is that these verses show “that a full seventy years must be counted from the complete 
desolation of the land to the restoration of Jehovah’s worship at Jerusalem.” Evidently verse 20 is 
being referred to here. This says: 


Furthermore, he carried off those remaining from the sword captive to 
Babylon, and they came to be servants to him and his sons until the 
royalty of Persia began to reign. 


Is this the fulfilment of Jeremiah 25:11 (or 12)? Most Bibles, even the New World Translation, 
provides a marginal cross reference from this verse to Jeremiah 27:7, which we have already 
discussed and found to be in the process of fulfilment in Zedekiah’s day. 


It is noteworthy that in verse 20, the Chronicler speaks of 2 events: 
1. Captives going to Babylon after the destruction. 
2. When the royalty of Persia began to reign. 


These two events are really what the Society was pointing to when it referred to Jeremiah 25:11 (or 
12) and claimed that “in addition, show that a full seventy years must be counted from the complete 
desolation of the land to the restoration of Jehovah’s worship at Jerusalem.” That the Society’s claim 
does not match this Scripture even in the way the Society wants to interpret it should be obvious, for 
the Society does not teach that Judah became desolate immediately at the destruction in Zedekiah’s 
11th year. 


It is true that it used to, but this was also changed, e.g. The Watchtower May 15, 1922, after quoting 2 
Chronicles 36:18-21 commented “the desolation began at the downfall of Zedekiah, 606 B.C.” On this 
basis, their 2520 years would expire in August 1914 AD. 


The Watchtower May 1, 1922 stated on page 139: 


God granted to the gentiles a lease of dominion for a term of 2520 
years, which term or lease ended about August, 1914. 


Today we are told that the 70 years and the 2520 years began in approx. October 1, which is 2 months 
later than the destruction. (See BF page 372) 


When we consider point 2 above, we also find a discrepancy between what is said and what the 
Society would like to have been said. The royalty of Persia began to reign in 539 BC. (The Society 
sometimes says 538 BC), whereas according to the Chronology of the Society, the 70 years ended in 
537 BC. Unfortunately for the Society, 2 Chronicles 36:21 does not fit their picture even in the way 
that they suggest interpreting it. 


How then can it be understood in harmony with all the rest of the Bible evidence, having in mind also 
Ezra’s “viewpoint, the circumstances at the time of writing, and the context in which the material is 
set”? 


Ezra was interested in pure worship and observance of Jehovah’s Laws, which he knew very well 
(Ezra 7:6). Possibly when he wrote of the destruction of Jerusalem, he thought of the later complete 
desolation and he saw in it a fulfilment of Leviticus 26:34. It is rather vague what he intended, though 
from a chronological point of view because he could hardly know that in a few thousand years time 
his utterance would become the basis of a chronological dispute. 


In this regard too, it should be noted that he doesn’t even mention the people who did not go captive 
to Babylon and remained in Judah under Gedeliah, but finally fled into Egypt. 


38 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


So, if he was referring to the period when the land became completely desolate he does not identify 
when this period began. 


It is of more than passing interest too, to observe that although the Chronicler refers to the Sabbath 
rest of the land at the same time as he refers to Jeremiah’s 70 years, Jeremiah gave not the slightest 
indication that the land was to enjoy a Sabbath rest. 


Certainly too, the 70 years of Jeremiah began long before the land became completely desolate. 


After refreshing our minds on what Ezra said about the Sabbath rest, we can consider a probable 
solution to its application. 


All the days of lying desolated it kept sabbath to fulfil seventy years. 
The translation of Isaac Leeser translates it: 


To fulfil the word of the Lord by the mouth of Jeremiah, until the land 
had satisfied its Sabbaths; all the days of its desolation it rested; till 
seventy years were completed. 


An American Translation has it: 


In order that the words of the LORD by the mouth of Jeremiah, might 
be fulfilled, until the land had enjoyed its sabbaths. All the days of the 
desolation it kept sabbath, to complete the seventy years. 


The Douay Version (2 Paralipomenon) corresponds with the thought being obtained 


That the word of the Lord by the mouth of Jeremias might be 
fulfilled, and the land might keep her sabbaths. For all the days of the 
desolation she kept a sabbath, till the seventy years were expired. 


The fact that these versions do not require a 70 year period of complete desolation must be clear to all. 
The Bible doesn’t say anything anywhere else about a 70 year Sabbath rest and there is no need to 
insist upon it here. 


The 70 year period commenced in 605 BC and if the Sabbath rest could not commence until the land 
was completely empty, then it commenced years later and the land rested until the 70 years were 
completed. 


Ezra’s comment was obviously intended to draw attention to the fulfilment of a threat because of the 
nation’s wayward course. He had no thought of providing any information that would assist for 
Chronological discussion. 


The Kingdom is at Hand (1944) states on page 171 in a footnote: 


IMPORTANT: In the book “The Truth Shall Make You Free”, 
published in 1943, the chronology on pages 150, 151 concerning the 
kings of Jerusalem from Solomon’s successor to Zedekiah is based on 
the book of 2 Chronicles, chapters 12 to 36: This appears to show the 
reigns of those kings as successive, end to end. 


Actually, however, this was not so, as is plainly shown in the books 
of 1 and 2 Kings, which books give us a countercheck on the 
successors of Solomon by a comparison of these kings of Judah with 
the neighbor kings of the ten-tribe kingdom of Israel. The 
chronological TABLE OF CONTEMPORARY KINGS AND 
PROPHETS AND RELATED EVENTS on the next four pages 
shows how the books of 1 and 2 Kings give a more accurate check on 
the reigns of the kings of Judah than does 2 Chronicles. 


I think that we could be excused if we take this statement to indicate that the Society does not 
consider that 2 Chronicles was written for Chronological purposes. From this point of view it should 
not surprise us if we find that it is not clear when the Sabbath rest actually began or how long it lasted 


39 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


or for that matter whether the land had to be completely desolate. These chronological aspects were 
unimportant to Ezra, he merely wanted to point out that the Sabbath rest had been enjoyed by the 
land. 


Why should the land have to have a 70 year sabbath rest? There is no way of showing how many 
sabbath years the land was deprived of. That the rest each 7th year permitted the land was observed up 
to the end of the period of the Judges, can surely be taken for granted. God-fearing kings such as 
David, Solomon and Jehoshaphat would surely have observed this law and it is difficult to imagine 
when 70 Sabbaths had not been observed. 


The Society claims on page 372 BEF, 


“Almighty God decreed that the land had to lie unworked, 
uninhabited for seventy years in order to enjoy a relatively perfect 
number of sabbaths, that is to say, ten times seven sabbaths (etc.).” 


This is very interesting and while it suits the Society’s theories, it presents a problem, for God decreed 
no such thing. The only time that a Sabbath rest for the land is referred to as having taken place during 
any phase of the desolation is at 2 Chronicles 36:21, and this cannot by any stretch of the imagination 
be construed as a decree. It was the record of an event recognised years after it occured. We might 
find it ambiguous, but it was evidently understandable to those of the 5th Century BC, for whom it 
was primarily intended. 


As Jeremiah’s prophecy is the crux of the matter, we need have no difficulty in discerning the 
chronological aspect of it for if the 70 years are the same as those referred to by Jeremiah, they 
commenced in 605 BC. 


Before passing on to another possible interpretation of the Chronicler’s statement, I will offer a couple 
of relevant thoughts. If it was Gods purpose (as the Society suggests) for the land to become 
completely empty and enjoy Sabbath rest, why did he invite Vine-dressers to stay in the land after the 
destruction referred to by the Chronicler? (see 2 Kings 25:12 and my page 33) 


If there is similarity between 2 Chronicles 36:21 and Leviticus 26:34, there is also contradiction 
between Leviticus 26:32 and what the Society teaches, for Jehovah said, 


I, for my part, will lay the land desolate, and your enemies who are 
dwelling in it will simply stare in amazement over it. (Leviticus 
26:32, emphasis is mine.) 


In all respects, what Ezra referred to did not fulfil Leviticus 26, although he seems to have seen in 
Judah’s desolation a sabbath rest for the land and such a rest is mentioned in Leviticus 26, so it is 
assumed that he referred to this portion of Moses writings. 


Additionally, it is also of interest to note that the whole land to which Moses was undoubtedly 
referring, never did gain a Sabbath rest, for the area occupied by the 10 tribe kingdom was never 
completely desolated and so never did gain compensation for Sabbaths not kept (see BF page 167). 


Such a conclusion depends of course on the assumption that the land had to be completely empty for 
the Sabbath rest to be observed. But is this a correct assumption? What about Leviticus 26:32 (just 
quoted)? 


This raises another possible understanding for 2 Chronicles 36:21. Perhaps I should first point out that 
the word “desolated” appearing in 2 Chronicles 36:21 is an English translation of the Hebrew word 
SHAMEM. 


The Authorised Version presents Matthew 23:38 as “Behold, your house is left unto you desolate”. 
Here we have a clear reference to Jeremiah 12:7. (The New World Translation has a cross-reference 
to this passage.) Jesus’ words were spoken almost 40 years before Jerusalem was destroyed by the 
Romans in AD 70, and it is evident that Jeremiah chapter 12 applies to a period before Jerusalem was 
destroyed by Nebuchadnezzar, although it is not specifically dated. 


40 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


The Watchtower of April Ist, 1958 refers to these passages as though the land was inhabited at the 
time, and an examination of it shows that it was. Jeremiah 12:7 discloses Jehovah’s abandoning 
Judah: 


I have left my house; I have deserted my inheritance; I have given the 
beloved one of my soul into the palm of her enemies. 


In verse 11, SHAMEM is used in reference to Judah: 


One has made it a desolate waste [shamem]; it has withered away; it 
is desolated [shamem] to me. The whole land has been made desolate 
[shamem], because there is no man that has taken [it] to heart. 


On all the beaten paths through the wilderness the despoilers have 
come. For the sword belonging to Jehovah is devouring from one end 
of the land even to the other end of the land. There is no peace for any 
flesh. 


They have sown wheat, but thorns are what they have reaped. They 
have worked themselves sick; they will be of no benefit. And they 
will certainly be ashamed of the products of you people because of 
the burning anger of Jehovah. (Jer. 12:11-13) 


Evidently all this was brought about by nomadic bands friendly to the Chaldeans (see 2 Kings 24:2). 


A perusal of Jeremiah 12:7-12 would assist in appreciating that the land experienced considerable 
relief from exploitation during the portion of the 70 years when it was occupied. The sieges that 
occurred in the days of Jehoiakim and Jehoiachin would have prevented agricultural pursuits and of 
course before Jerusalem was finally ravished in Zedekiah’s day, there was a siege of almost 2 years 
duration. The shortage of food is emphasised on page 157 BF. 


The conclusion that is possible in view of this evidence is that the Sabbath rest, if it has to be 70 years 
in duration, could have been counted from 605 BC, because of the considerable rest that the land was 
enjoying. SHAMEM does not require that the land be empty. 


SHEMAMAH is a word very closely related to SHAMEM and it used at Ezekiel 29:12: 


And I will make the land of Egypt a desolate waste in the midst of 
desolated lands; and its own cities will become a desolate waste in the 
very midst of devastated cities for forty years; and I will scatter the 
Egyptians among the nations and disperse them among the Lands. 


Events fulfilling this prophecy are unknown either in the Bible or in secular History and there is the 
possibility that a lot of this type of language is figurative. (This is only mentioned as a possibility.) 
Isaiah 1:7 also provides evidence for the use of SHEMAMAH. 


Jehovah’s mercy is again a factor that cannot be overlooked. If we place any confidence in Jehovah’s 
mercy, we will see the possibility of the land enjoying Sabbath rest before the complete desolation. 
(That is, if we insist that it had to be for 70 years.) 


Just as we cannot understand Exodus 12:40 on its own, we need Jeremiah to clarify 2 Chronicles 
36:21. Although the 70 years are clearly located, nothing quite positive can be said of the period when 
the land kept sabbath. 


Two further scriptures that emphasise this difficulty are Jeremiah 52:30 and Ezekiel 33:21. These 
passages indicate that there were people in Judah long after the Society said the land was empty. You 
see, Jerusalem was destroyed in the 19th year of Nebuchadnezzar, whereas Jeremiah 52:30 informs 
that prisoners were taken in Nebuchadnezzar’s 23rd year. BF page 167 says: 


These, however, were not taken off the land of Judah, but were 
captured when Nebuchadnezzar, as Jehovah’s symbolic cup, made 
nations that bordered on the desolated land of Judah drink the bitter 
potion of being violently conquered. 


41 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


The difficulty that the Society faces in making such a statement is that the Bible does not say that 
these prisoners came from other lands. 


There is very little difference in the language of verse 30 and verse 28. The Society claims that the 
prisoners of verse 28 came from Judah (see BF 138 footnote), so why not the prisoners of verse 30? 
Could such reason be suited to a theory? Jeremiah 52:30 requires that there were people in the land 
long after the Society commences the 70 year period of complete desolation. 


Ezekiel 33:21 speaks of the 12th year of the prophet Ezekiel’s’ Exile. This would be according to the 
Society’s Chronology, 606 BC. 


It occurred in the twelfth year, in the tenth [month], on the fifth day of 
the month of our exile, that there came to me the escaped one from 
Jerusalem, saying: ‘The city has been struck down!’ 


Jehovah then began to prophecy through Ezekiel that the land would yet become completely desolate 
(see verses 22-29). When the land actually came into this condition of completely being desolate, we 
cannot say with any degree of certainty. 


The Society’s answer to Ezekiel 33:21 is difficult to understand at the present time. It used to suggest 
that the mention of 12th year was an error and it should be 11th year (Equipped For Every Good 
Work page 223). This arrangement puts Jehovah in the position of saying the land would become 
completely desolate after the Society says this event occurred. All this was hardly satisfactory, so at 
the present time the meaning of this verse is clouded by claiming the 12th year to be “by a certain 
calculation” (see BF page 167). What this “certain calculation” is remains a mystery because the 
Society has not chosen to disclose it. 


I have spent a considerable amount of time on the consideration of 2 Chronicles 36:21, but this is 
considered necessary because it is the verse upon which the Society places greatest emphasis. A little 
more space will therefore be devoted to it and particularly to the possibility of the Sabbath rest to the 
land extending over the whole of the 70 years. 


It might assist if we look at the principle behind the Law requiring rest for the land. By consulting 
Leviticus 25:1-7 we can determine this underlying principle. It is that the land never really belonged 
to the Israelite (Lev. 25:23). It really belonged to God. Nevertheless, He had offered it to them and 
they could live in it, BUT it was not to be exploited. This was not intended to be a land on which 
some got rich and subsequently oppressed the less fortunate. 


On each 7th year the land was to lie fallow. This would keep them in mind of Jehovah’s purpose for 
the land. During the Sabbath year the spontaneous produce of the land could be enjoyed by all 
(Exodus 23:11), but it was not to be harvested (Lev. 25:5). That is, the value from the land on that 
year could not be gathered for profit. The equalising tendency of this year is also emphasised in 
Exodus 21:2-6, which allows freedom to slaves if they desire it and debts too were to be remitted 
(Deut. 15:1-3). 


Here we gain a clearer view of the intent of the law. Although the land itself would have benefited 
from the rest each 7th year, a rest over a period of 70 years would be quite unnecessary. 


As we examine what did take place during the 70 years from 605 BC — 536 BC, it becomes clearly 
evident that the Jews were no longer able to exploit the land. What they were able to gather from the 
land was virtually what grew spontaneously. No doubt they were able to grow some crops but these 
would not allow their greed to be satisfied or allow them to gain excessively from the produce 
gathered. In fact quite the reverse was obviously the case, for there was insufficient for their needs. 


When the Chronicler reviewed the period then, it is quite possible that the point that came to the fore 
in his mind was that when God’s anger started to burn against the nation, when the 70 years was 
running its course, the object of the sabbath law for the land was also the result. The people were no 
longer able to exploit their God-given land. 


42 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


From 605 BC through the 70 years, Jehovah had withdrawn the precious right formerly theirs to 
possess the promised land. It was really no longer theirs, for He said, 


“TI myself have given all these lands into the hand Nebuchadnezzar.” 
(Jeremiah 27:6 and Daniel 2:38). 


Even the promised land had been given to Nebuchadnezzar and during the time he was’ entitled to it, 
it was certainly not exploited by the people of Judah. 


This is a reasonable summary of what Ezra may have had in mind, however we can only consider any 
conclusion reached is at best problematical. As an alternative, we have another possibility which is 
just as reasonable and it is that Ezra might have thought of the land resting completely, because we 
know that the primary meaning of the word “sabbath” is to “desist” or “rest”. The sabbath would then 
be until the 70 years were completed. 


2 Chronicles 36:21 has to be understood both by the Society when it offers its interpretation and by 
others when offering theirs. There is no doubt that it can best be understood in the light of the writings 
of Jeremiah to which this passage specifically refers. 


The Society’s arrangement puts them in the unfortunate position of having to explain away Daniel 
1:1; 2:1; Jeremiah 52:30; Ezekiel 33:21; and many others. We have no idea how it would try and get 
around Jeremiah 25:18; 12:7-12; 18:7, 8; 42:10; etc. It also has the problem of being entirely at 
variance with absolute secular chronology and being without answers to the problems this position 
places them in. The Society has to ignore the problems and try and discredit all those who cannot 
agree with them. 


Russell was wrong in insisting that the land had to be completely desolate for 70 years and the Society 
is wrong in perpetuating that error. The head of the Image (Daniel 2) was unquestionably in existence 
in Nebuchadnezzar’s 2nd year which, according to the Society’s chronology, was about 624 BC, and 
this would bring the end of the “Gentile Times” to about 1897 AD, if reckoned as a period of 2520 
years. 


Daniel chapter 1 contains another point of more than casual interest. The opening and closing verses 
refer to the Historic events that were responsible for the terminal dates of the 70 years. 


Daniel 1:1 is the record of the event which brought about the beginning of the servitude to Babylon 
and verse 21 reports that “Daniel continued on until the first year of Cyrus the king.” The Ist year of 
Cyrus was of course the year in which he made it possible for the Jews to be released from servitude. 
This would almost certainly be the reason for the mention of Cyrus’ year 1 in Daniel 1:21. It would 
not have been to indicate Daniel’s great age or something of that nature, for in chapter 10:1 we have 
reference to Daniel in the 3rd year of Cyrus. Reasonably, the reference refers to an event. 


SI page 139 says of this verse: 


The last verse, which may have been added long after the preceding 
portion was written, indicates that Daniel was still in royal service 
some eighty years after his going into exile, or about 538 BCE. 


While it is no doubt true that Daniel was still in “royal service” in the 1st year of Cyrus, the verse was 
hardly included for that reason. It is more reasonable to assume that this verse (1:21) makes its blunt 
statement to draw attention to the fact that Daniel saw the concluding events of the 70 years as well as 
the event that marked the commencement, which had been alluded to just prior to this statement, 
(compare Ezra 1:1). 


Alternative 70 Years 


There is some merit to the suggestion that the 70 years need not be taken literally. Many authorities 
have adopted this view. They point to the fact that Jeremiah 29:10 was part of a letter written about 10 
years after Jeremiah 25:11 and they consider that there are two or maybe more 70 year periods, or 
they find another interpretation for “seventy years.” 


43 


Chapter four. Judah 70 years desolate, or 70 years without inhabitants? 


They consider that 2 Chronicles 36:21 can refer to another period. Such persons also notice that in 
Jeremiah 27:7, the Babylonian rule is spoken of as though lasting three generations. Jeremiah 25:12 
also provided room for thought, for when the 70 years are taken literally, a problem rears its head, as 
the King of Babylon fell to the Persians in less than 70 years. 


Using the dates compiled by the Society, we have 607 BC as the beginning of the 70 years and 539 
BC as the year when Babylon fell to the Medes and Persians. 


As well as all this there are other references to a period of 70 years. (Zechariah 1:12 and 7:5). These 
also concern Judah. Then there is Isaiah 23:15-18, which has nothing to do with Judah directly. This 
reference concerns a disaster to befall Tyre, but here it refers to 70 years as “the same as the days of 
one king”. 


Other references to 70 which may not be literal are, for example, the 70 members of the household of 
Jacob who went down to Egypt (Genesis 26:27). We also have a period of 70 days when the 
Egyptians wept for Jacob (Gen 50:3). Gideon and Ahab had 70 sons (Judges 9:2; 2 Kings 10:1). 


Some also find indications that 40 is a round number, e.g. Ezekiel 29:12-14. 70 is referred to in Psalm 
90:10 as about the length of a man’s lifetime. 


Some see in the number 70 years reference to an appropriate period of punishment. 


R Borger in The Journal of Near Eastern Studies Vol X VIII page 74 refers to an inscription of the 
Assyrian king Esarhaddon, “in which it is stated that the desolation of Babylon after its destruction by 
Sennacherib should originally have lasted seventy years according to a decision of the god Marduk.” 
This is referred to as indicating that “seventy years was a perfectly proper period for an ancient 
oriental city to lie desolate.” 


On the “Moabite Stone” we find reference to a 40 year period of punishment of Moab by Chemosh. 


If the 70 years are not taken literally, then the problem with Jer. 25:12 is removed and it matters not 
when the 70 years began. Even now the only one vitally concerned with the matter is the Society, for 
it is vitally concerned that it be 607 BC. This date, however, is impossible. 


Is the Society so concerned with say the desolation of Egypt, to which we have already made 
reference (Ezekiel 29:12-14)? BF page 183 refers to the conquest of Egypt, but no desolation is 
mentioned. 


No one else appears to have found any reason to alter the firm Chronology of the period. Even a man 
like Martin Anstey who wrote 2 large Volumes The Romance of Bible Chronology and who altered 
the chronology of the Persian period onward without hesitation in order to suit his theories on 
Prophecy, found no difficulty in accepting the pattern usually accepted for the 70 years. 


Nowhere in the Bible is it even suggested that Judah would be without man and beast for 70 years. It 
was 70 years desolate from 605-536 BC. 


44 


CHAPTER FIVE. CHARACTERISTIC OBJECTIONS 


Shakespeare is credited with the poetic words, “All the world’s a stage and all the men and women 
merely players. They have their exits and their entrances and one man in his time plays many parts.” 


As we view the stage and think of 70 year periods, we realise that there are many in the Society that 
have been playing their part for approx. this long. Although they may not have played many parts in 
the broad sense, they have probably played many parts in the activities of the Society. Some of these, 
such as F W Franz, are unquestionably closely associated with the publications of the Society. As 
Russell and then Rutherford made their exit from the Stage, so have many of their Doctrinal opinions 
and yet all this time the Chronology, although continually interfered with, has remained the focal 
point for Society Doctrine. 


It goes without saying that persons who occupy responsible positions in the organisation and who 
have had long associations therewith, must have spent countless hours in meditating and studying in 
order to present the best possible arguments in favour of their Chronology and also in an endeavour to 
find weaknesses in the normal Chronology. 


The book Babylon the Great Has Fallen! God’s Kingdom Rules must be the culmination of all their 
efforts in this regard. It must be the best that they can offer. As it is, the Chronology presented cannot 
stand examination, but how does the normal Chronology stand in the face of the attacks made against 
it by the Society in its book? Surely these too must be the most destructive the Society is capable of 
producing. 


The purpose of this Chapter is to closely scrutinise these objections in the light of the facts. Having 
done this, we will ring the curtain down on the Chronology of the 70 years and pass onto another 
aspect of our discussion. 


Objection 1 BF page 160. 


“Judah went into exile from off its soil”. Judah had not done this 
nineteen years before this during King Jehoiakim’s reign. (A portion 
of Jeremiah 52:27 was quoted here). 


Answer Who said it did? The nation had not in its entirety gone into exile 19 years before, but the 
process had commenced. 


The very next three verses in Jeremiah 52 (verses 28, 29 and 30) list captives taken on 3 occasions. 
The final group being taken 4 years later than the above-mentioned group. The land was not 
completely desolate when Jeremiah said “Judah went into exile”, because verse 16 of this same 
Chapter says distinctly that “vine dressers” were left in the land. 


The objective of the Society’s statement was of course to give the impression that the people of Judah 
had to be in Babylon in Exile for 70 years while Judah lay desolate. Again though on examination, the 
Scripture does not fit the picture and no one can produce a Scripture to say that the people had to be in 
Exile for 70 years while the land lay completely desolate. 


Objection. 2 BF page 166 refers to the Captivity of Jehoiachin and others, and comments: 


Only some thousands of the Jews went into Babylonian captivity, not 
the whole Jewish nation. (See also BF page 287) 


Answer No one disagrees with this, the nation was to serve Babylon in Judah as a Vassal State. The 
Bible does not say that everyone had to go to Babylon, to serve for 70 years. Most of the people were 
progressively exiled in Babylon, but only a small group, consisting of Daniel and associates, was 
there for the full 70 years. 


Objection 3 BF pages 166 and 165 states: 


Flavius Josephus, the Jewish historian of the first century of our 
Common Era, is in harmony with the Holy Bible when he writes the 
following about the length of Jerusalem’s desolation: 


45 


Chapter five. Characteristic objections 


“He [the Chaldean historian Berosus in the third century BC] gives 
us a catalogue of the posterity of Noah, who adds the years of their 
chronology, from Noah himself to Nabulassar king of the 
Babylonians and Chaldeans with an account of this king’s exploits. 
He tells us that he sent his son Nabuchodonsor with a mighty army 
into Egypt and Judea where, upon his being informed of a revolt, he 
reduced the people to subjection, set fire to our temple at Jerusalem, 
and carried off our whole nation in captivity to Babylon. After this 
our city lay desolate during an interval of seventy years, till the days 
of Cyrus, King of Persia.” 


The reference given is “Book 1, section 36, of To Apophroditus on the Antiquities of the Jews in 
Answer to Apion. We are not informed which Translation is utilized here. It is certainly not Whiston’s 
Translation, from which a quotation immediately follows, Book 10 chapter 9 last paragraph of 
Antiquities of the Jews. The paragraph of the unknown translation is identified by Whiston as 
“Against Apion 1:19”. 


After these quotations, BF continues: 


Thus the seventy years that Jeremiah foretold was a period occupied 
completely by the desolation of Jerusalem and the land of Judah. 
They did not include a period of captivity of part of the Jewish nation 
in Babylonia. 


Answer Russell was not very impressed with Josephus and when discussing Herod’s death on page 
57 of Vol. 2 of Studies In the Scriptures, he stated, 


Unfortunately, the time of Herod’s death is not given by a reliable 
historian. Josephus gives some important periods in his history and 
the dates of some events, but these dates are not trustworthy. 


Further on, Russell quotes Appleton’s Cyclopaedia as stating under the subject “Chronology”, 


Josephus also gives dates, but he is altogether too careless to be taken 
into account. 


In 1944, the magazine Consolation (predecessor of Awake) was published in Australia. The issue of 
July 5, 1944 commented on page 30 concerning Josephus: 


His books are highly esteemed, and contain much of value and 
interest, although they are not always accurate. They sometimes 
contain material (such as legend and wrong chronology) that is hardly 
creditable to a Jewish historian. 


Being assured that the Society is aware of the situation concerning Josephus, it is surprising that 
unqualified use would be made of his record at “Against Apion” 1:19. Such a course is nothing short 
of amazing when we find Josephus saying at “Against Apion” 1:21 (only 2 verses later) concerning 
this same Berosus: 


These accounts agree with the true history in our books; for in them it 
is written that Nebuchadnezzar, in the eighteenth year of his reign, 
laid our temple desolate, and so it lay in that state of obscurity for 
fifty years. (Whiston’s Translation and emphasis supplied.) 


What was the correct duration of the complete desolation? There is no difficulty if we analyse what 
the Society quotes Josephus was saying. 


Nabulassar (Nabopolassar) was the father of Nebuchadnezzar and it was he who sent his son as 
commander of the Babylonian forces to combat the Egyptians in 605 BC. We recall that according to 
Jeremiah 46:2 and the “Babylonian Chronicle”, they met in battle at Carchemish. During this same 
year, Nabopolassar died and Nebuchadnezzar ascended the throne. 


46 


Chapter five. Characteristic objections 


From this period onwards, the City was desolate in an incomplete sense (CHORBAH). 19 years later 
the majority of those remaining in Judah were carried off to Babylon after the Temple etc. had been 
burned (2 Kings 25:8,9). 


Does the Society agree that the 70 years began in the year that Nabopolassar died? Clearly Josephus 
was mistaken in suggesting that the Temple was burned in this year and surely the Society knows this. 
Josephus was quite accurate in his other statement that the Temple was desolate for fifty years. (586 
BC-536 BC = 50 years.) 


The Society says that Nebuchadnezzar’s Ist year was 626 BC, so his father sent him on the expedition 
before this, yet the Society says the Temple etc., were destroyed in 607 BC. 


Josephus can be called to give his testimony, but as he was not a historian contemporary with the 
events of the 6th Century before Christ, we would be unreasonable to use him as an authority when he 
contradicts the Bible and the contemporary and reliable “Babylonian Chronicle.” (Josephus lived in 
the 1st Century AD.) When we view his testimony with an unbiased mind, we can appreciate how 
foolish it is to try and use him to support a particular theory when he gives evidence contradicting that 
theory elsewhere. 


Counting the 70 years from Nabopolasar’s last year is completely opposed to Watchtower Chronology 
and completely in harmony with the true a chronology for the period. 


Objection 4 BF page 138: 


It is because of making the mistake of dating the beginning of the 
seventy-year period for the desolation of Jerusalem and the land of 
Judah after king Jehoiakim reigned at Jerusalem but three years that 
the chronologers in Christendom throw their time schedule of history 
at least nineteen years out of order, shortening up the stream of time 
by that many years. 


They do this because of trying to harmonize the Bible records with 
the astronomical Canon of Claudius Ptolemy, an Alexandrian or 
Egyptian astronomer of the second century after Christ but whose 
system of astronomy has long since been exploded. In this we do not 
go along with such chronologers. 


Answer “Appendix C: Absolute Dates” demonstrates beyond question that there is a great deal more 
to the matter than “Ptolemy’s Canon”. Proof has been offered from the work of William Hales that 
chronologers were more concerned with the Bible record than the Canon, but surely they should not 
be condemned just because they don’t agree with the Society’s endeavours to maintain 1914 AD. This 
is the real reason why the Chronology of the Society and the chronologers in Christendom differ. How 
could a competent chronologist agree with the Society? 


When it is realised that the Society is completely dependent on “Ptolemy’s Canon” for the 539 BC 
date, its statement is astounding The authority for this absolute date is given on page 282 SI as 
Babylonian Chronology, 1956, Parker and Dubberstein. Page 10 of this book informs: 


The general basis for the chronology of the period here treated is 
furnished by the Ptolemaic Canon, with help from classical sources. 


Clearly the Society’s statement is unjust. It relies on Ptolemy itself. In 1922, June 15th, an article 
appearing in the Watchtower, “Seventy Years’ Desolation (Part II)” was written with the objective of 
discrediting all of the secular evidence that clearly proves the Society’s Chronology to be erroneous. 


The headings of the various sections give an indication of this. I will quote them as a point of interest: 


EARLY PAGAN “HISTORY” UNRELIABLE. 
GUESSES OF “AUTHORITIES”. 
SUPPOSITIONS, THEORIES, CONJECTURES. 
RECORDS FALSIFIED BY KINGS. 


47 


Chapter five. Characteristic objections 


UNTRUSTWORTHINESS OF ARCHAEOLOGISTS. 
DOUBTS, AND MORE DOUBTS. 


As can be seen, the opposition got the treatment. Under the section GUESSES OF “AUTHORITIES”, 
we are told: 


Ptolemy, ancient Greek “historian”, made up a list called “Ptolemy’s 
Canon” like a chronological table, which has been much used. This 
list, however, is unreliable in the dates of all events except those 
marked by an eclipse or other astronomical phenomenon which can 
be checked as to date by astronomical calculation. 


Now the inference is clear, the dates marked by an eclipse etc. CAN be relied upon! 


Professor Edwin R Thiele, (the author of The Mysterious Numbers of the Hebrew Kings) was kind 
enough to write to me on October 25, 1964, and I will quote from this letter some information that is 
noteworthy in view of the Society’s statement: 


Concerning the time of the beginning of Nebuchadnezzar’s reign. 
First of all, allow me to say that there is not the slightest question as 
to when that reign began. No other date in ancient history is more 
firmly established than this. That is because of the two eclipses 
involved. First there is an eclipse of April 22, 621, which took place 
in the 5th year of Nabopolassar, father of Nebuchadnezzar. Since 
Nabopolassar reigned twenty-one years, his death would thus have 
taken place in 605, when his son Nebuchadnezzar began to reign. 
Then we also have the eclipse which took place in the 37th year of 
Nebuchadnezzar, 568, which once more establishes 605 as the 
beginning of his reign. There could be no evidence more positive than 
this. 


Reference to the “Appendix C: Absolute Dates” reveals that the Eclipse of 621 BC is taken from 
Ptolemy and the 568 BC eclipse is calculated from a Babylonian observation tablet. The above- 
mentioned Watchtower suggests that we should accept 621 BC as the 21st year of Nabopolassar while 
the Awake of 22nd April, 1963, page 17 says: 


Mathematicians can calculate the date of tablets by the astronomical 
data they contain. 


There is no doubt then that Nebuchadnezzar’s 37th year was 568 BC. 


Notice on the same page of this Awake reference to Dr O. Neugebauer of Brown University. This 
man is one of the greatest authorities on Ancient Astronomy and Mathematics living. One of his many 
and most popular works on these subjects is “The Exact Sciences in Antiquity”. The Society could not 
but regard this man as capable of calculating the date of a Babylonian Astronomical Tablet. 


I wrote to Neugebauer and queried whether there was any doubt as to the accuracy of calculations 
from this tablet, which insist upon it being related to the year 568 BC. I received a reply dated 
October 9th 1964, which stated: 


The astronomically determined date which you mention in your letter 
of Oct. 2 is absolutely certain. 


Here we have two experts saying that there is not a shadow of a doubt about these two dates, and the 
Society agrees that their methods are quite in order, but they prove the Society to be 100% in error. 


The Watchtower dated Ist February, 1955 contains a question on Chronology. This apparently suited 
the Society’s purpose for it wrote a reply covering much more than the question deserved, covering 
several pages of the Watchtower. Some questions I have submitted have not received so much as one 
word in reply. Page 93 of this journal advises: 


48 


Chapter five. Characteristic objections 


The accuracy of astronomy tables containing the eclipses of the moon 
away back to 1207 BC establishes such an Absolute date. These 
tables prove that an eclipse of the moon occurred Friday, April 3, AD 
33, Julian calendar (or April 1 according to our present Gregorian 
calendar), at six minutes past 3 pm, Greenwich time. (Footnote refers 
to Canon der Finsternisse, by T. R. Oppolzer, Vienna 1877, Vol. II, 


p3.) 


In 1962, an English translation of this work was made and is known as The Dover Edition (translated 
by O Gingerich). On page 33 of this Edition, Oppolzer’s tables show that an Eclipse of the Moon took 
place on 22nd April, 621 BC and also on 4th July, 568 BC, which was the exact date of the Eclipse 
mentioned on the Astronomical Tablet (see “Appendix C: Absolute Dates”). 


All of the objections of the Society have the same characteristics, they all wither in the light of the 
facts and usually back-fire on themselves. It is astonishing that the very evidence that the Society 
provides itself, shoots down its own missiles. 


What possible answer could the Society give to the Astronomical Tablet related to Nebuchadnezzar 
37th year? They agree that “Mathematics can calculate the date of tablets by the astronomical data 
they contain.” 


The chronologists Hood and Wood in their The Chronology of Ezra 7 page 12 state: 


Archaeologists have found a document from the time of 
Nebuchadnezzar giving a series of astronomical observations for his 
37th year that locate that BC year unmistakably. 


On page 94 they provide more exact information as to the actual dates obtained. 


One of these anchor points, from which we can locate other relative 
dates, is furnished by an astronomical tablet bearing a series of 
observations dated in the 37th year of Nebuchadnezzar. These fix the 
year as having begun on April 22/23, 568 BC, and ended April 11/12, 
567 BC. 


To summarise the situation here is but to call attention again to the dates obtained from the eclipses 
and compare this information with the “Babylonian Chronicle” for the period. We have first of all 621 
BC as the 5th year of Nabopolassar. Compare this with-the portion of the “Babylonian Chronicle” 
quoted on my page 18. 


This establishes that Nabopolassar reigned for 21 years. If his 5th year was 621 BC (the eclipse 
proves that it was), then his 21st year (16 years later) must have been 605 BC. Nebuchadnezzar came 
to the throne in this year. The other eclipse shows that the 37th year of Nebuchadnezzar was 568 BC. 
(37th is of course 36 years plus some months.) 


His 1st year then must have been 604 BC, and the year of his coming to the throne, or his “Accession 
Year”, was the year before, 605 BC. Thus we have each eclipse providing corroborative evidence of 
the correct location of the other. 


In the face of all his conclusive evidence, and there is much more contained in the Appendix, all the 
Society can say is that Ptolemy’s “system of astronomy has long since been exploded”. Whatever has 
this to do with his Canon of Kings? We might as well say that Isaac Newton’s theories on Astronomy 


are not all accepted any more, so his comments on the book of Daniel are all wrong. 


The only information taken from Ptolemy’s writings on Astronomy for chronological purposes is the 
records of observations of eclipses, etc. 


Because Ptolemy’s system of astronomy, which re garded the Earth as the centre of the universe, has 
been found to be wrong, does not say that the observations of the ancient Babylonians recorded in his 
works are wrong. To draw such a conclusion would be very crooked thinking indeed. 


49 


Chapter five. Characteristic objections 


There are so many forms of evidence available that substantiate that the Ist year of Nebuchadnezzar 
was 604 BC, that this date is just not open to question. 


The Appendix “Ptolemy’s Canon” discloses that: 


Nebuchadnezzar reigned for 43 years between 604 BC and 562 BC. 
Amel-Marduk reigned for 2 years between 561 BC and 560 BC. 
Nargal-shar-usur reigned for 4 years between 559 BC and 556 BC. 
Nabonidus reigned for 17 years between 555 BC and 539 BC. 


You will be surprised when we extract details from the Society’s literature regarding Babylonian 
kings for this period and summarise them in the same fashion as above. 


First of all we have 539 BC, the year accepted by the Society as Nabonidus’ last year. SI page 139 
relates the year 553 BC to his 3rd year. 555 BC must therefore have been his Ist year. (See also 
Nabonidus Chronicle). 


Nabonidus reigned for 17 years between 539 BC and 555 BC 

(BE page 184) Labashi-Marduk reigned a few months 555 BC 

(BF page 184) Neriglissar reigned 4 years 556 BC — 559 BC 

(BE page 184) Amel-Marduk reigned 2 years 560 — 561 BC 

(BE page 279) Nebuchadnezzar reigned 43 years 562 BC — 604 BC. 


In this summary we have a duplicate of Ptolemy’s Canon, and yet on page 126 BF it is stated: 


In the fourth year of the reign of King Jehoiakim of Judah, or in 625 
BC, Nebuchadnezzar became king of Babylon. 


According to the summary, it would have been 605 BC. 


Endeavours to maintain Russell’s chronology in the midst of so many facts that prove it wrong have 
once again caused confusion to whoever wrote this part of the Babylon book. On the one hand it is 
suggested that Ptolemy’s Canon is “at least nineteen years out of order”. On the other hand we are 
provided data which corresponds exactly with the Canon and contradicts what the Society would like 
us to believe. 


Notice that BF page 183 claims that Amel-Marduk “succeeded Nebuchadnezzar to Babylon’s throne 
in 581 BC.” From the Table we have compiled from the Society’s figures, we can see that such a date 
for the accession of Amel-Marduk is impossible. 


Someone might claim that justice is not being done to the Society, and we could work from 581 BC, 
as the Society does. This is acceptable; let us see what happens. 


Nebuchadnezzar 

Amel-Marduk reigned for 2 years from 581 BC-580 BC 
Neriglissar reigned for 4 years from 579 BC-576 BC 
Labashi-Marduk reigned for a few months 576 BC 
Nabonidus 575 BC-539 BC 


BEF does not disclose how long Nabonidus reigned for, it merely states on page 184: 


Nabonidus ... now took the throne and had a fairly glorious reign till 
Babylon fell in 539.B.C. 


On this basis he would have reigned for 37 years approx. But if he commenced to reign in approx. 576 
BC and 575 BC was his first “regnal year”, how can the Society say his 3rd year was 553 BCE (SI 
page 139)? If 553 BC was his 3rd year then 555 BC obviously was his Ist. This is what is accepted by 
everyone else and usually by the Society too, so they just cannot make his reign span approx. 37 

years. 


50 


Chapter five. Characteristic objections 


The Society gives another line of indirect evidence which proves that it accepts that 555 BC was 
Nabonidus’ Ist “regnal year”. This is contained in BF page 197: 


In an article entitled “The Last Days of Babylon”, D. J. Wiseman, 
head of the Department of Western Asiatic Antiquities of the British 
Museum, describes the discovery of a stone monument inscribed in 
Babylonian which gives King Nabonidus’ own account of events 
during his reign over Babylonia. In this monument, the Harran stele, 
King Nabonidus of Babylon makes reference to the king of the Medes 
in the year 546 BC. 


It is very interesting that the year 546 BC should be mentioned, in fact it is very interesting that the 
Society should mention this article at all, for it deals largely with the new “Babylonian Chronicles”, 
published by Wiseman in his book Chronicles of the Chaldean Kings, which provide so much 
illuminating evidence on the last years of Judah. 


The Society has not passed on this valuable information, nor has it passed on other valuable 
information referred to by Wiseman which, as BF page 197 confirms, was published in Christianity 
Today Vol 11, No. 4, November 25, 1957. On page 9, Wiseman refers to the newly discovered Stele 
and advises: 


The three Harran texts all tell of events in the reign of the same 
Nabonidus. One of the newly found inscriptions purports to be the 
autobiography of the Lady Adad-guppi, the mother of Nabonidus. 
This remarkable old lady enumerates her pious deeds done at Harran 
to the gods Sin, Nergal, Nusku and Sadarnunna; it seems she gave 
great gifts to these gods in return for the benefits bestowed on her 
during her many years of service. She names the eight kings of 
Assyria and Babylonia in whose reigns she acted as the high priestess 
of the moon- god at Harran. 


When referring to Nabonidus, BF page 184 reports: 


He (Nabonidus) is reported to have been the son of a priestess of the 
moon at Harran. 


The salient point here is that not only does this lady name the 8 kings, but she ties their reigns into a 
given period (the length of her life) which proves that there were no gaps between their reigns. Each 
of the Kings from Nebuchadnezzar onward is described and complete agreement with Ptolemy’s 
Canon is found. (For further particulars, see “Appendix C: Absolute Dates”). 


Our concern at present though is the Society’s reference to “the king of the Medes in the year 546 
BC”. Where is this data obtained from? Wiseman does not mention this date in Christianity Today. 
However, he does mention such a date in Documents from Old Testament Times. On page 83, he 
says: 


The recent discovery of a text of Nabonidus from Harran which refers 
to the ‘King of the Medes’ in 546B.C. 


In Christianity Today, Wiseman does mention the text of the Stele which refers to “the kings of 
Egypt, of the Medes and of the Arabs ... in the tenth year of Nabonidus’ reign.” 


It is evident from a consideration of the facts that “the tenth year of Nabonidus’ reign” and 546 BC 
are synonymous. (See also Whitcomb’s Darius the Mede page 47.) If Nabonidus’ 10th year was 546 
BC, and BF page 197 agrees with this, then his Ist year was 555 BC, and so what the Society would 
have us believe is bewildering indeed. 


Other Objections. There are a few other objections raised by the Society against the Absolute 
Chronology for the 6th Century BC, but these have either already been dealt with or have been 
explained indirectly (e.g, Daniel 1:1 and 2:1). 


51 


Chapter five. Characteristic objections 


There are also other peculiarities involved in the Society’s Chronology. Perhaps I will mention one or 
two of these when we discuss the 2520 years (7 times). 


At this stage I submit that we have to admit that The Society’s Chronology has fallen! Truth Rules! 
By this time too, we should have gained a view of the Society’s Character from a different angle. At 
the conclusion of this entire consideration, it will have to be admitted that the evidence shows that the 
chronology for the period of the 70 years is inextricably bound together and there is conclusive 
evidence that the Society’s chronology is absolutely impossible. 


52 


CHAPTER SIX. THE SEVEN TIMES 


Are the “Seven Times” a period of punishment upon Israel and at the same time a period of 
domination by Gentile Governments? If so, is it legitimise to claim that this period extends over 2520 
years? 


We originally felt compelled to ask these questions as a result of references by Russell to Leviticus 
26:17, 18, 24, 28. We also read excerpts from his Vol. 2 of Studies in the Scriptures, pages 87, 88, 92, 
93 and 96. 


Russell placed his confidence in the record of Leviticus relating that the Jews would be punished 7 
times. He saw in Daniel 4 what he described a “Another Line of Testimony.” 


On October 9, 1910, Pastor Russell addressed a Jewish Mass Meeting. His address, “Zionism In 
Prophecy” was published by the Society in a book Pastor Russell’s Sermons. On pages 478 and 479 
of this book we are informed that Russell said: 


The whole period of time in which these various Gentile governments 
would dominate the world would last until Messiah’s promised 
Kingdom. And this period is symbolically stated to have been ‘seven 
times’; that is, seven years - evidently not literal years, but 
symbolical. - Dan. 2:28-45; Lev. 26:18, 24, 28. 


At their end, the lease of earthly power of Gentile governments will 
terminate in the great Time of Trouble foretold by Daniel (12:1). 
Then Messiah shall stand up in the sense of assuming control of 
earth’s affairs and Gentile governments will cease; for all nations 
shall serve and obey Messiah. Then God’s Chosen People, Israel, will 
come to the front in the world’s affairs: for they will become the 
representatives and instruments amongst men of Messiah’s Kingdom 
(etc.). 


It is significant that in his entire discussion, Russell never once referred to Daniel 4. There is no doubt 
that his confidence rested largely on the 26th chapter of Leviticus. (See also Government chapter VI, 
written by Rutherford, published 1928.) 


If you consider yourself a “careful student”, you will be interested in the advice of The Watchtower 
May I, 1922, page 133: 


It must be apparent to all careful students that the period of the gentile 
times would be a period of great punishment to Israel, and that that 
period of time must begin with some specific punishment marking the 
beginning of the gentile times (etc.). 


The Society today does not accept this and so is not a “careful student”? No, the Society no longer 
uses the 26th chapter of Leviticus to support its contention for 7 times of Gentile domination. The last 
reference I can find to these verses used in this manner is in the book The New World, published by 
the Society in 1942 and which states on page 66: 


The Lord God used Nebuchadnezzar, the king of Babylon, as his 
executioner to do the overturning. That was in 606 BC, and there the 
“seven times’, the ‘times of the Gentiles’, began. (Daniel 4:16, 23, 25, 
32; Leviticus 26:18, 21, 24, 28; Luke 21:24) 


Why is it today that Leviticus 26, which was the basis for Russell’s 7 times, has been dropped and 
today only Daniel 4, which was formerly only supporting evidence, is all that is used? (See for 
example, BF pages 349 and 372.) 


This appears to be another mystery similar to the shift from 454 BC to 455 BC for the 20th year of 
Artaxerxes and other strange manoeuvres we have encountered, As far as the answer to the question is 
concerned, I can only suggest possibilities. 


53 


Chapter six. The Seven Times 


1. The Watchtower March 15, 1963, enlightens us on the Society’s change of view as to the 
Jews’ position in Jehovah’s purpose: 


It was not until 1932 that it was realized that we had been following a 
false trail with respect to the natural Jews. Like many others we had 
expected them to return to Palestine and then be restored to God’s 
favour. ... It was only in 1932 that it began to be clearly seen that the 
true ‘Israel of God’, the chosen instrument for the major fulfillment of 
the many Hebrew prophecies of restoration, would be composed, not 
of natural Jews circumcised in the flesh, but of spiritual Jews or 
Israelites, that is, spirit begotten Christians. 


Russell had looked for blessings to come upon the Jewish Race, and on page 90 of Vol. 2 of Studies 
in the Scriptures, he said that 1914 would be followed by “the blessings recorded in the latter part of 
the same chapter (Lev. 26:44, 45)”. 


If the Jews were no longer to receive these blessings from after 1914, it would be rather difficult to 
maintain that their punishment would extend to this year. And yet 10 years later, in 1942 we find 
these verses still being used to support the “7 times” in The New World. No wonder reference is not 
made to the use of these verses in this publication by the Watch Tower Publications Index 1930-1960. 


2. Apossible reason for dispensing with the 7 times of Leviticus 26 is the change of 
Administration of the Society. All books written by Judge Rutherford up to the printing of 
Children in 1941 acknowledged his authorship. 


Jehovah’s Witnesses in the Divine Purpose reports on page 194 that Rutherford died on January 8, 
1942. On page 199, the book The New World is referred to as “a Scriptural study of the prophetic 
narrative of Job, enlarging and developing the theme of the talk ‘Integrity’, which Brother Rutherford 
had given as his opening discourse at his last assembly, the year previous”. 


The New World does not acknowledge Rutherford as author, and subsequent policy was for 
authorship of publications to be concealed. If he was not the author at least he was the originator of 
the theme which comprised one of his talks. Perhaps the new administration, which has shown less 
inclination toward following Russell, dropped Leviticus 26, realising that it could not be used because 
of the point raised under possibility 1. It is noteworthy that The Truth Shall Make You Free, published 
in the following year, makes no reference to Leviticus 26 but it does use Daniel 4. 


3. There is yet an obvious third probability why it was abandoned and that is that it should never 
have been used in the first place. Read in their context, these verses refer to the intensity of 
the punishment, i.e. sevenfold. 


Once again we have evidence of a switch, of method of calculation down through the years for the 
base doctrine of 1914. 


Luke 21; 24 


And Jerusalem will be trampled on by the nations, until the appointed 
times of the nations are fulfilled. 


What the “appointed times of the nations” or “times of the Gentiles” are, or when they commence, or 
their duration, is nowhere explicitly stated in the Bible. There are several feasible interpretations but 
one thing seems clear and that is that they must occur sometime after Jesus referred to them for he 
said, “Jerusalem will be trampled”, NOT “is being trampled”, or “will continue to be trampled”. 
Therefore it was an event for the future, not the continuation of a situation already in existence for 600 
years. Read Luke 21:20-24 for yourself, you will have no difficulty in recognizing this. 


54 


Chapter six. The Seven Times 


Daniel 4 


The onus is already on the Society to justify the way it uses the Scriptures of the Hebrews and 
Christian (Greek language) disciples, known as the Holy Bible to support its teachings. As Leviticus 
26 has been discarded, we can forget that, but what about Daniel 4? Does this Chapter say anything 
about 2520 years of Gentile domination? As Daniel makes no reference to any such thing, indeed the 
Bible in its entirety contains no such teaching, the Society faces an uphill battle. 


It is a well known fact that when an eagle is teaching its young to fly, it encourages the tardy ones by 
pulling the nest to pieces bit by bit. Finally the eaglet is forced to fly or crash to the ground below. If 
we pull the nest of the 2520 years to bits, will it stay aloft or will it fall like so much litter to the 
ground? How can we tell until we pull the nest to bits? 


The tree of Daniel 4:10 undoubtedly referred to Nebuchadnezzar (verses 20-22). However, we go 
beyond the clear intent of the Scripture if we make the tree also mean “world sovereignty” or “world 
dominion” as the Society does in BF page 176. Surely this point alone is a large piece out of the nest! 


Daniel chapter 4 applies to Nebuchadnezzar and to nothing else or to no one else. When this has been 
proved I will consider that the 2520 years has crumbled. 


I will make no attempt to interpret the King’s dream, for Daniel, with the aid of the God of heaven, 
revealed this secret. In verse 24 Daniel commenced the interpretation of the dream and in verse 28 
assures us (all of us) that the interpretation had its fulfilment upon Nebuchadnezzar: 


All this befell Nebuchadnezzar the king. 


At that moment the word itself was fulfilled upon Nebuchadnezzar 
(verse 33). 


There is no suggestion anywhere that anything should be learned from Daniel 4 other than what 
Nebuchadnezzar learned: 


Seven times will pass over you, until you know that the Most High is 
Ruler in the kingdom of mankind, and that to the one whom he wants 
to he gives it. (verse 25) 


Nebuchadnezzar was humbled and this taught him that 


[God’s] rulership is a rulership to time indefinite and his kingdom is 
for generation after generation (verse 34). 


Those who are walking in pride he is able to humble (verse 37). 


Closely examining, Daniel 4 (the nest), we may be astonished to note that there is nothing to suggest 
2520 years of Gentile domination of the Earth without interference from God’s kingdom. So why 
bother to pull the nest to bits further? 


In fairness to the Society, I will mention that they are not the only ones that have applied Daniel 4 to a 
period of 2520 years. Neither was Russell the first to do so. I know of two expositors who wrote at the 
beginning of the 19th century who considered that Nebuchadnezzar’s 7 times of madness represented 
the Gentile Times. (E. B. Elliott, Horae Apocalypticae Vol 3, page 247 and Birks, Elements of 
Prophecy page 353.) Of course they did not interpret Daniel 4 exactly the same as the Society does, 
but then neither did Russell. It is evident though that no special revelation was given to Russell, he 
probably only copied someone else. 


The type of reasoning necessary in the use of Daniel 4 is well demonstrated in BF page 178: 


Jehovah’s taking up his power to rule by establishing a kingdom of 
God for this earth came long after Nebuchadnezzar acknowledged 
Jehovah to be ‘King of the Heavens’. It is clear, therefore, that the 
“seven times’ or seven literal years in Nebuchadnezzar’s personal 
experience were symbolic. 


55 


Chapter six. The Seven Times 


This is not clear to me. Who said Jehovah was to take up his power to rule at the end of a period of 
seven times? What is supposed to be clear rests purely on an unfounded assumption. Is such a 
specious reasoning to be the basis for a foundation Doctrine of an organisation? Obviously it is, in this 
case. 


Some read to prove a preadopted Creed, 
Thus understand but little of what they read, 
And every passage in the Book they bend, 
To make it suit that all important end. 


The Society has often accused others of reading into the Bible instead of learning from it. I cannot see 
how the conclusion can be escaped that the Society reads into Daniel 4. 


When Leviticus 26 was used to teach 7 times of punishment to Israel, which was at the hands of the 
Gentiles, it would not have been so bad to read into Daniel support for this. Now though when 
Leviticus is no longer used, there is not the slightest excuse for using Daniel 4 in this manner. 


It is being used to maintain what was formerly taught on the basis of Leviticus 26. This is a theory, a 
theory which no longer has a basis and so an attempt is made to use what was formerly support for the 
theory, as the basis. 


A house with wooden stumps as the foundation is no uncommon sight. Sometimes to add a little extra 
support to the floor, etc., wooden wedges are driven in between the floor and the stumps. These 
wedges are not stumps however. If the stumps are removed, the structure will fall down. Daniel was 
only a supporting wedge for Leviticus 26 and now that this (the foundation stumps) has been 
removed, the wedge is of no use. It doesn’t look like a stump and no one should expect it to support 
the doctrine. 


Needless to say, the Society would be completely stumped without tt. 


Prophetic Time 


If we turn the page mentioned above of BF, we find reference on page 179 to: 


A symbolic or prophetic year, the number of days is fixed at the 
unchanging number of 360, and each day thereof stands for a whole 
year. “A day for a year, a day for a year”. Numbers 14:34; Ezekiel 
4:6. 


In the prophetic book of “Revelation”, a thousand two hundred and 
sixty days are spoken of as being equal to a “time and times and half a 
time”, or three and a half times. (Revelation 12:6, 14) If we divide 
three and a half (3.5) into a thousand two hundred and sixty days, it 
gives us three hundred and sixty (360) days to a time. 


Accordingly, a symbolic or prophetic ‘time’ would Scripturally equal 
three hundred and sixty (360) years. If, now, three and a half 
symbolic “times” amounted to 1,260 symbolic days, that is to say, 
1,260 years, then twice three and a half (or seven) symbolic “times” 
would be twice 1,260 years, that is to say, 2520 years. 


This of course illustrates the use of the 7 times of Daniel 4, and could be considered as a satisfactory 
arrangement if it was proven that Daniel 4 has to do with others beside Nebuchadnezzar. 


The 7 times passed over Nebuchadnezzar. I am sure that everyone would like to know why the 3% 
times mentioned by the Society do not represent 1260 years? Can it be considered anything but 
unreasonable to arbitrarily choose to use the “day for a year” principle with some prophetic periods 
and not with others? Can such a procedure be justified? Obviously it cannot! 


Russell applied the “day for a year” principle to all these prophecies and on page 64 of Vol. 3 of 
Studies in the Scriptures he wrote: 


56 


Chapter six. The Seven Times 


The time, times and half a time, or three and a half times or years 
(360 X 3% = 1260 days, symbolic time — 1260 literal years), here 
mentioned, are elsewhere shown to be the period of Papacy’s power. 
Compare Dan. 7:25; 12:7 and Rev 12:14 with Rev. 12:6; 13:5. 


Rutherford supported these methods for a while and in his book The Harp of God written in 1927, 
informs us that 


Applying the same rule, then, of a day for a year, 1335 days after 539 
AD brings us to AD 1874, at which time, according to Bible 
chronology, the Lord’s second presence is due. If this calculation is 
correct, from that time forward we ought to be able to find some 
evidences marking the Lord’s presence. 


It is not the purpose of this writing to enter into a detailed statement 
of Biblical chronology. The searcher for truth can find an extensive 
treatment of this question in Volumes 2 and 3 of Studies In The 
Scriptures. (Quoted from page 230; the 1335 days are those of Daniel 
12:12.) 


Today these time prophecies are calculated as referring to literal days (except the 7 times and the 70 
weeks of Daniel 9:25) and are all applied to various events that have occurred in the history of the 
Society since 1914. 


I am of the definite opinion that one of the main reasons that Russell had for plugging for 70 years of 
complete desolation of Judah, was because this brought the concluding date of his Gentile times to 
1914. This date was 40 years from 1874 AD, and fitted in with his understanding of Prophetic 
parallels etc. 


Examination of the alleged fulfilments on the literal day basis reveals them to have been forced. Take 
as an example the 2300 days of Daniel 8:14. Your Will Be Done on Earth states on page 215: 


Count now from the beginning of this International Convention of 
London on May 25, 1926, and we shall find that the 2,300 days of 
evenings and mornings bring us to October 15, 1932. 


A review of pages 212 to 214 indicates that the “transgression causing desolation” of Daniel 8:13 was 
the act of the Nations in not heeding the Society’s condemnation of the League of Nations contained 
in a resolution adopted at the above-mentioned Convention. Now as we have learned, the count begins 
“from the beginning of this International Convention of London on May 25, 1926.” (See also World 
Recovery page 55.) 


Why would anyone count from the beginning of the Convention? The Resolution wasn’t even 
mentioned until the Friday (May 28) according to paragraph 41 on page 212, and wasn’t make public 
until the following Sunday night (para. 42, page 213) in an address given at the Convention. World- 
wide publicity must have been very limited, according to para. 43. 


Daniel 8: 14 says: 


Until two thousand three hundred evenings (and) mornings; and (the) 
holy place will certainly be brought into its right condition. 


The fulfilment of this is explained on page 215 of the above-mentioned book: 


How was Jehovah’s sanctuary cleansed vindicated or restored to its 
rightful state by that date? Examine the official journal of Jehovah’s 
witnesses, The Watchtower as of that date. Note page 319. That page 
sets out the Resolution adopted by the New York company of 
Jehovah’s witnesses on October 5, 1932. It called for a cleansing of 
the congregational organization, a restoring of it to the rightful state 
of Jehovah’s sanctuary class. How? By the ridding of the organization 
of ‘elective elders’, or elders that had been elected to the office of 


57 


Chapter six. The Seven Times 


eldership by the stretching out of the hands. (in other words, by the 
democratic method.) 


Page 216 claims: 


The announcement in The Watchtower magazine of October 15, 1932, 
at the end of 2,300 evenings and momings was the official 
notification made by Jehovah through his visible channel of 
communication that his sanctuary of anointed ‘living stones’ had been 
cleansed, vindicated and justified. 


All this is so obviously tailored that it is difficult to believe that anyone could seriously believe it. 
Unfortunately, in its efforts to maintain 1914, the Society must make these other prophecies fit too. I 
shouldn’t have to mention that they are designed to strengthen the Society’s position too. 


Although the Society tries to minimize the importance of the Chronology today, it is only too true that 
it is the Chronology that is the basis of the prophetic interpretations. When things didn’t turn out as 
expected in 1914 and later it was becoming too long a period since 1874, parts of the whole 
chronological arrangement were dropped. Christ’s presence was shifted forward to 1914 etc., and the 
2300 days. Also, the prophetic days were treated as literal days. The above arrangement is apparently 
the best the Society can do. 


The Watchtower May 1, 1914, made no secret that it was the Chronology that was the basis of the 
prophetic interpretations, page 134 says: 


We have pointed out that the chronology is the basis of nearly all the 
suggestions of prophetic interpretations set forth in STUDIES IN 
THE SCRIPTURES. 


When the chronology of the Scripture Studies was interfered with, the prophetic interpretations of 
necessity were also altered. As the Chronology is wrong what else could we expect but confusion? 
The Watchtower has often said that Jehovah is not a God of confusion. This is unquestionably true, 
The Society then could not possibly be the organisation of Jehovah, despite its continually telling us 
that it is the “visible channel of communication”. 


It is unfortunately true that what is really false can appear to be true and so appealing. Paul advised 
that what is false can “spread like gangrene” (2 Tim. 2:17). 


It was so satisfying to be among those who called themselves “Jehovah’s Witnesses”. I felt so secure 
and content. I was among some of the most sincere and devoted people you could hope to be in 
company with. 


But that was not enough, it is the truth that must always be our goal. I am so glad that I followed the 
admonition “Make Sure Of All Things; Hold Fast To What Is Right” (1 Thess. 5:21). 


When I discovered that much of what I had been spreading was not right, I could no longer “hold 
fast” to it. I realized that I had really been only carrying on a lie. If I carried on in it, I would have 
been demonstrating to God that I did not want the truth, but liked the lie. 


Revelation 22:15 contains specific condemnation of such a practice, applying this condemnation to 
“those who practice spiritism and the fornicators and the murderers and idolaters and everyone liking 
and carrying on a lie.” 


Breaking away has meant the severing of association with so many dear friends. I hope they will 
understand better after having read this volume. 


Great truths are dearly bought. The common truth, 
Such as men give and take from day to day, 
Comes in the common walk of easy life, 

Blown by the careless wind across our way. 


Great truths are dearly won; not found by chance, 
Nor wafted on the breath of summer dream; 


58 


Chapter six. The Seven Times 


But grasped in the struggle of the soul, 
Hard buffeting with adverse wind and stream. 


Sometimes, ‘mid conflict, turmoil, fear and grief, 
When the strong hand of God, put forth in might, 
Ploughs up the subsoil of the stagnant heart, 
It brings some buried truth-seeds to the light. 


Not in the general mart, ‘mid corn and wine; 
Not in the merchandise of gold and gems; 
Not in the world’s gay hall of midnight mirth, 
Nor ‘mid the blaze of regal diadems; 


Not in the general clash of human creeds, 

Nor in the merchandise ‘twixt church and world, 

Is truth’s fair treasure found, ‘mongst tares and weeds; 
Nor her fair banner in their midst unfurled. 


Truth springs like harvest from the well-ploughed fields, 
Rewarding patient toil, and faith, and zeal. 
To those thus seeking her, she ever yields 
Her richest treasures for their lasting weal. 


Longfellow was the writer of this piece of poetry and it was printed in Poems of Dawn published by 
the Watch Tower Bible & Tract Society, 1912. 


59 


CHAPTER SEVEN. 6000 YEARS FROM ADAM’S CREATION? 


A few of the Witnesses who have approached me on my present stand have queried whether I believe 
that it will soon be 6000 years since Adam’s creation? They have insisted that this period will soon 
expire and have asked, doesn’t this prove that Armageddon must come in the next few years? The 
suggestion is that this is supporting proof for 1914 AD, and that Armageddon will occur and the 6000 
years expire within a generation from 1914 (Matthew 24:34). 


The thousand year reign of Christ following Armageddon is said to make up a period of 7000 years. 
The 7th day upon which God rested (Genesis 2:2) is said to expire at the conclusion of the 
Millennium and therefore to be 7000 years long. 


The basis of this is really a Jewish tradition. George L Murray says on page 194 of Millennial Studies: 


Barnabas patterned his eschatological plan on the week of creation in 
the first chapter of Genesis. God worked for six days and rested on 
the seventh. The present world order would continue in operation for 
six thousand years, and the seventh millennium would be one of rest, 
holiness and peace. (Barnabas lived in the first century.) 


The following is a quotation from the writings of Barnabas, also provided by Murray: 


Behold, today will be a thousand years. Therefore, my children, in six 
days, that is in six thousand years, all things will be finished. “And he 
rested on the seventh day”, this meaneth when His son coming shall 
destroy the time of the wicked man, and judge the ungodly and 
change the sun and the moon and the stars, then shall He truly rest on 
the seventh day. 


What the Society teaches is a variation of this. There seems to be no reason to doubt that what 
Barnabas said is the basis for the statement appearing on page 378 of The Watchtower June 15, 1961, 
which I quote: 


That God’s rest day consists of seven 1,000-year days was also 
observed by some Jewish rabbis several hundred years ago. In 1626 
Henry Ainsworth quoted one of them in his Annotations upon the 
First Booke of Moses Called Genesis as saying: “If we expound the 
seventh day, of the seventh thousand of years, which is the world to 
come, the exposition is, and he blessed, because in the seventh 
thousand, all souls shall be bound in the bundell of life ... so our 
Rabbins of blessed memory, have sayd in their commentarie; God 
blessed the seventh day, the holy God blessed the world to come, 
which beginneth in the seventh thousand (of years).” 


Russell presented his attitude to this tradition on page 39 of Vol. 2 Studies in the Scriptures. He said: 


Here we furnish the evidence that from the creation of Adam to AD 
1873 was six thousand years. And though the Bible contains no direct 
statement that the seventh thousand will be the epoch of Christ’s 
reign, the great Sabbath Day of restitution to the world, yet the 
venerable tradition is not without a reasonable foundation. 


If 1872 AD saw the end of 6000 years from Adams creation, then Russell’s date for this event must 
have been 4128 BC. 


The Truth Shall Make You Free page 152 provides the date for Adam’s creation as 4,028 BC. 


The Kingdom Is At Hand page 171 mentions an adjustment to 4026 BC. 
New Heavens And A New Earth page 364 shows that the date had been adjusted to 4025 BC. 


Now it is 4026 BC again. See BF page 682 and SI page 285. 


60 


Chapter seven. 6000 Years from Adam’s Creation? 


While I do not suggest that adjustments should not be made to dates when errors have been 
discovered in a chronological framework, I do suggest that we have definite proof that Adam’s 
creation date is uncertain. 


BE page 634 informs: 


Measuring by means of the Bible timetable from the first man’s 
creation in the garden of Eden, we are now close to the end of six 
thousand years from Adam’s creation. 


First off, as the Society points out on page 95 of The Watchtower, February Ist, 1955: 


No one today is able to find out how much time Adam and later Eve 
lived during the closing days of the sixth creative period, so no one 
can now determine when six thousand years of Jehovah’s present rest 
day come to an end. 


This must apply if the days of Creation are not accepted as literal days. There is also another problem 
which is involved with ascertaining the date of Adam’s creation and that is that the Bible apparently 
was never intended to be used for such a purpose. Although we may be able to ascertain approx- 
imately when Adam was created, we have no guarantee that any date calculated is not in error, 
perhaps even to the extent of hundreds of years. 


We have already seen that the Society chooses one of the “Absolute Dates” in the BC period and 
works backwards from that. Immediately, its chronology is in error because of the mistake in 
stretching the period of 70 years to about 90. Then there is the complex period of the Hebrew Kings. 


Most systems of recent date give a date for the schism approximately 60 years different to that of the 
Society. For example, the monumental work of Professor E. R. Thiele, The Mysterious Numbers Of 
The Hebrew Kings, quoted in The Watchtower February 1, 1955, page 94, and by A. H. Macmillan in 
Faith on the March gives the date of the schism as 931 BC. The Society says it was 997 BC (SI page 
284). 


I will mention in passing that A. H. Macmillan wrote his book after approximately 60 years 
association with the Society. He should have known better than to say on page 229: 


Although the archaeological evidences referred to here were not 
known in 1914, they have since only served to refine and corroborate 
Russell’s calculations. 


This is psychologically interesting, for there is not one piece of archaeological evidence that 
corroborates Russell’s calculations. On the contrary, it tears them to shreds. Macmillan himself does 
not allow a period for the reign of Darius the Mede. 


I am absolutely convinced that the Society’s chronology for the 70 years is all wrong. I am positive 
that its chronology for the period of the Kings is wrong, and I know that there are other very great 
difficulties to overcome before a solid chain of dates can be set down and which connect the date of 
the creation of Adam to an “Absolute Date”. 


Probably the greatest difficulties are to be found in the Genealogies, for it seems certain that there are 
gaps in the Biblical Genealogies. Their main purpose apparently was to give a line of descent rather 
than to be used to give a strict chain of dates 


Luke, in providing Jesus’ genealogy, includes Cainan between Shelah and Arphaxad (Luke 3:35, 36). 
When reading these verses, one would naturally assume that Arphaxad was the Father of Cainan, who 
was the Father of Shelah. Now, when we read Genesis 11:13 we find that no mention is made of 
Cainan but it is stated that, “after his fathering Shelah, Arphachshad continued to live four hundred 
years”. This proves that gaps could exist in other genealogies too. 


SI page 285 contains a chain of dates compiled by the Society which extend from Arpachshad to the 
death of Terah. No mention is made of Cainan. What are we to do with Luke 3:35 and 36 then? On 
this same page of SI (285), reference is made to “the Samaritan Pentateuch and the Septuagint, both of 


61 


Chapter seven. 6000 Years from Adam’s Creation? 


which are based on Hebrew texts older than the Masoretic”’. If the Society wants to recommend the 
value of the Septuagint in the matter under review, it has to contend with the fact that the Septuagint 
does include Cainan at Genesis 11:13, and this gives a period of 130 years from between the birth of 
Cainan and Shelah. It also gives the period between the birth of Arpachshad and Cainan as 135 years. 


There is no need to go into a long explanation of all this, as the evidence on the chronology to 1914 
conclusively proves the Society to be totally wrong. Already I have shown that this matter of 6000 
years to the Millennium etc., is nothing more than something that sounds good on the surface. When 
we scratch the veneer off, it is very frail material that we find beneath. 


Further evidence can be found by those interested, in The Genesis Flood by John C Whitcomb, Jr., 
and in Archaeology and Bible History by Joseph P Free. The following quotations are from pages 17 
and 18 of the book by Free: 


The genealogy in Matthew 1:1-17 omits three kings (Ahaziah, 
Jehoash, and Amaziah) and indicates that Joram begat Uzziah, who 
was his great-grandson (Matt. 1:8) 


One of the illustrations of a compressed genealogy in the Old 
Testament is found in Ezra 7:3, where six generations are omitted 
(which are given in a more complete genealogy in | Chronicles, 
7:7ff). Such occurrences give evidence that the Bible may not give a 
complete record in a genealogy, but rather an indication of the line of 
descent. 


The term “son” is also used in the sense of “descendant”, shown by 
the fact that some of those referred to in Genesis 46:18 as the “sons of 
Zilpah” were actually her grandchildren, and furthermore it is said 
that she “bore” them, or begat them. Thus we see that the word 
“begat” may sometimes be used in the sense of “to have as a 
descendant”. 


My attitude in view of all this, is I am not sure that it is possible to ascertain how long ago it was 
when Adam was created. I am prepared to accept that it was in the vicinity of 6000 years ago. It 
would not surprise me if 6000 years have passed since that event already, neither would I be surprised 
if 6000 years since Adam’s creation expire after Armageddon. I have no confidence at all in any 
tradition (or whatever else it may be called) which claims that there will be a period of 6000 years 
from the commencement of the 7th day, on which God rested, to Armageddon. I fail to see how 
anyone can claim that the 7th day must be 7000 years long. 


In concluding this Chapter, I would point out something that be more than a coincidence. I think it is. 
Note that the date Russell gave for the end of the 6000 years — AD 1873 — fitted in exactly with his 
scheme of things. I am convinced that the same thing applies to the Society and 1914, etc., for the date 
has been bumped up about 100 years. 


62 


CHAPTER EIGHT. SIGNS OF WHAT? 


Although we have established beyond question beyond that the “Times of the Gentiles” do not 
comprise a period of 2520 years stretching from 607 BC to 1914 AD, there is one final subject that if 
not reviewed, would leave our consideration incomplete. 


BE page 180 claims: 


[These 2520 years] would end about the middle of the month Tishri 
(or near October 1), AD 1914. That is an unforgettable year, for in 
1914 World War 1 broke out and the Gentile system of things has 
never been the same since then. 


Page 503 extends this thought a little further by reporting that: 


The months wore on until November 11, 1918, when an armistice 
brought World War 1 to an end, with Christendom in particular 
bleeding from terrible wounds, suffering also from earthquakes, 
pestilences and famines with also a shameful record of religious 
persecution. All this was tangible proof that the Gentile Times had 
ended in 1914 and that God’s kingdom had been born in the heavens, 
and His Messianic King the Lamb of God, Jesus Christ, had stood up 
in power on the heavenly Mount Zion. 


Here we have our final point requiring examination highlighted. “All this” (i.e., World War 1, 
earthquakes, pestilences, famines, persecution) is said to prove that the Gentile Times had ended and 
God’s Kingdom had been set up. Obviously the claim made here is rather vague, however the booklet, 
Gods -Kingdom Rules — is the World’s End Near? published by the Society in 1958, provides 
information that clarifies what the Society’s claim really is. After claiming that God’s Kingdom had 
been born in 1914, page 23 commences a section headed “Factual Evidences”, and the following 
suggestion is made: 


We do not ask you to accept the mere date 1914 as proof that God’s 
kingdom rules. There is more to the matter than the mere date. We 
ask you to accept what came with that date and what therefore 
confirms that date. 


When prophesying about the world’s end, Jesus gave no date. He 
gave what may be more convincing than a date by which we could 
know that God’s kingdom has begun to rule. Jesus foretold the 
world’s happenings and conditions. Three Bible writers give us 
separate accounts of what Jesus said. 


Then World War 1, famines, pestilences, earthquakes, etc. are again mentioned, and on page 25 it is 
claimed: 


This long series of world-distressing events did not begin accidentally 
in 1914. It began in 1914 because the ‘times of the Gentiles’ ran out 
that year. Its beginning in that year stamped 1914 as the year when 
the “times of the Gentiles” ended ... World events from 1914 onwards 
prove not only that Jesus Christ was a true prophet but that in 1914 he 
came into the Kingdom power to which he had a right and that his 
presence in the heavenly kingdom began then. 


What we have just read illustrates again the Society’s minimizing the importance of the chronology 
today. If it minimizes the chronology, what does it do to the signs? Does it exaggerate the signs? 
Don’t let us be presumptive, let us see. 


If we strip these statements of all verbosity, we can appreciate that what the Society is really claiming 
here is that all of its chronological claims leading to 1914 must be correct because all of the events 
that have occurred since that date are said to be the Signs given to the Apostles by Jesus and recorded 


63 


Chapter eight. Signs of What? 


in Matthew 24, etc. Jesus gave these signs in response to a question by his Apostles as he sat upon the 
Mount of Olives as recorded at Matthew 24:3. 


They asked, according to the Authorised Version of the Holy Bible, “what shall be the sign of thy 
coming”. The Society translates this passage in the New World Translation of the Holy Scriptures, 
“what will be the sign of your presence.” Here we find a problem requiring the consideration of the 
word “parousia”. 


Parousia 


“Parousia’”, should it be rendered “PRESENCE” or “COMING” at Matthew 24:3? Whether these 
signs began fulfilment in 1914 or not is really immaterial, the problem is — do they show Jesus to be 
PRESENT or COMING? If it should be COMING, it matters: not when they commenced fulfillment. 
If it should be COMING, then all hope of saving the 1914 platform, upon which so many sincere 
people build their hopes, and upon which the Society stands or falls, will be gone. 


This does not mean that all HOPE is gone, for God and Jesus still exist and will remain faithful to 
their promises. It only means that one has to change his way of thinking and of obeying the Almighty. 


The New World Translation of the Christian Greek Scriptures (1950) says in the “Appendix”, page 
779 on the word PAROUSIA: 


The tendency of many translators is to render it here “coming” or 
“arrival”. But throughout the 34 occurrences of the word (par-ou-si’a) 
from its first occurrence at Matthew 24:3 to its last occurrence at 1 
John 2:28, we have consistently rendered it ‘presence’. From the 
comparison of the par-ou-si’a of the Son of man with the days of 
Noah at Matthew 24:37-39, it is very evident that the meaning of the 
word is as we have rendered it. And from the contrast that is made 
between the presence and the absence of the apostle at 2 Corinthians 
10:10, 11 and at Philippians 2:12, the meaning of par-ou-si’a is so 
plain that it is beyond dispute by other translators. 


It is true, as shown by Dr Adolf Deissmann in his Light from the 
Ancient East on pages 368, 369, that from the Ptolemaic period down 
into the 2nd century AD, one of the Eastern technical meanings of 
par-ou-si’a was the arrival or visit of a king or emperor. However, 
this does not deny or disprove that in the Christian Greek Scriptures 
the word has the meaning of PRESENCE where it is used in 
connection with Jesus Christ and others. To prove what a word means 
the Scriptural context is more decisive than any papyrus usage of the 
word in a technical way. 


In analysing the Society’s case for the rendering of this word as PRESENCE, we are first of all 
confronted with the fact that “The tendency of many translators is to render it here ‘coming’ or 
‘arrival’.” 

Why is this? Is it because translators are not aware that the word can be translated “PRESENCE”? 
No, that could not be true for several times in the King James Version of 1611 for example, the word 
is translated PRESENCE. Then do translators refuse to render it PRESENCE at Matthew 24:3 just to 
oppose the Watchtower? Such a claim would be unreasonable for the King James Version was 
published in 1611, long before Charles Taze Russell ever settled upon this rendering in 1876. 


It is obvious that Scholars have no sinister motive in rendering PAROUSIA as COMING or 
ARRIVAL and that the blanket translation to PRESENCE as insisted on by the Society is not 
necessary. 


Could it be that the Society is the one with the axe to grind in this matter? If the word can be 
translated in more than one way it would be unwise to maintain that it must be translated just one way 
because it is acceptable in some or even most texts. 


64 


Chapter eight. Signs of What? 


Dr Joseph F Thayer on page 490 of his Greek - English Lexicon advises that the word can be rendered 
“presence” or “the presence of one coming, hence THE COMING, ARRIVAL, ADVENT.” He says: 


In the N.T. esp. of The ADVENT, ie. the future, visible RETURN 
from heaven of Jesus, the Messiah, to raise the dead, hold the last 
judgment, and set up formally and gloriously kingdom of God: Mt. 
XXIV. 35. 


The Interpreter’s Dictionary of the Bible when commenting on PAROUSIA reports: 


The Word ‘Parousia’ was used in classical and Koine Greek in the 
general sense of ‘presence’ but also of ‘arrival’ or ‘coming’. It occurs 
four (five?) times in the LXX with these meanings (Neh. 2:6 (text?); 
Jud. 10:18; II Macc 8:12; 15:21; If] Macc 3:17). 


As for the “comparison of the par-ou-sia of the Son of man with the days of Noah at Matthew 24:37- 
39”, it is evident that Jesus was emphasizing the unpreparedness of people in general at his return and 
the consequent execution of judgement. He said in verse 39 that just as the flood came suddenly on 
people in this state in Noah’s day, so would his PAROUSIA occur at a like time. 


PLEASE NOTE that what Jesus said concerning Noah’s day follows on from his advice that the signs 
would show that he is near at the doors (verse 33) but yet no one knows the day and hour when he 
will come (verse 36). Despite some being aware that he will come at any time, although not knowing 
exactly when, the general condition will be as it was in Noah’s day, when he arrives (verses 38 and 
39). 


As though taking us forward in time to the actual scene, Jesus illustrated the unpreparedness by 
reference to two men in a field and two women grinding away on the hand mill (verses 40 and 41). He 
then further emphasized his warning on unpreparedness by saying “Keep on the watch, therefore, 
because you do not know on what day YOUR Lord is coming” (Matthew 24:42). 


The next point mentioned in the “Appendix” to The New World Translation is the contrast mentioned 
“between the presence and the absence of the apostle both at 2 Corinthians 10:10, 11 and at 
Philippians 2:12.” 


This is an interesting situation for we have PAROUSIA contrasted with ABSENCE (being away or 
somewhere else) and obviously the opposite to ABSENCE is PRESENCE (being there). 


No one disputes that PRESENCE is the correct reading here. However this is not the only interesting 
thought to be drawn from this comparison. Does the Society stick to the strict literalness of this word 
and say that Christ is actually PRESENT? Obviously NO! Awake of May 8, 1962, page 8 reports that: 


He comes to earth in that he turns his attention to the things of earth. 


Before commenting on this claim, I think a quotation from the book Faith On the March (A. H. 
Macmillan) might help: 


The mistake C. T. Russell had made, I pointed out was not as to the 
time, 1914, but his error was only as to WHERE the kingdom had 
been established — in heaven instead of on earth. 


Obviously when 1914 came and went and the Kingdom had not been established on Earth and then 
more years passed by, the thing to do was to say it had been established in Heaven. It is an obvious 
fact that Christ could not be PRESENT at the Earth and ruling from Heaven at the same time. 
Therefore the literal rendering of PAROUSIA as PRESENCE (opposite to ABSENCE) finds the 
Society’s arrangement wanting. 


Referring back to what Macmillan said, it is obvious that if C T Russell HAD made a mistake as to 
the time (and it is so obvious that he did) then it is still possible that the Kingdom will be established 
on Earth. 


65 


Chapter eight. Signs of What? 


On page 9 of his book, Macmillan quotes Russell as saying: 


If October 1915 should pass and we should find ourselves still here 
and matters going on very much as they are at present ... then we 
would think, Have we been expecting the wrong thing at the right 
time? 


Did the Chronology deserve such confidence? Obviously not, and consequently another alternative 
would be more likely. Perhaps they were expecting the RIGHT THING at the WRONG TIME? 


Back to The New World Translation “Appendix” where mention is made of Deissmann’s book Light 
from the Ancient East pages 368, 369 and the Society says, 


It is true that from the Ptolemaic period down into the 2nd century 
AD, one of the Eastern technical meanings of par-ou-si’a was the 
arrival or visit of a king or emperor. 


The Watchtower July 1, 1949, page 197 provides extracted portions from these pages and I re-quote 
them as follows: 


From the Ptolemaic period down into the 2nd century AD we are able 
to trace the word in the East as a technical expression for the arrival 
or the visit of the king or emperor. The parusia of the sovereign must 
have been something well known even to the people, as shown by the 
facts that special payments in kind and taxes to defray the cost of the 
parusia were exacted, that in Greece a new era was reckoned from the 
parusia of the Emperor Hadrian, that all over the world advent coins 
were struck after a parusia of the emperor, and that we are even able 
to quote examples of advent-sacrifices. The subject of parusia dues 
and taxes in Egypt has been treated in detail by Wilcken. The oldest 
passage he mentions is in the Flinders Petrie Papyrus II 39e of the 3rd 
century BC where, according to his ingenious interpretation, 
contributions are noted for a crown of gold to be presented to the king 
at his parusia. 


The Interpreter’s Dictionary of the Bible, in its discussion of PAROUSIA also refers to the technical 
usage of the term, as does George Milligan, DD on page 145 of his St Paul’s Epistles to the 
Thessalonians. However, the Society acknowledges the technical usage of the word, so there is no 
point in providing further quotations. 


What we do need to consider is the claim made by the Society in the “Appendix” mentioned above: 


To prove what a word means, the Scriptural context is more decisive 
than any outside papyrus usage of the word in a technical way. 


While we are considering the context, I consider it to be of interest to review why I used to consider 
Matthew 24:3 to refer to an invisible PRESENCE of Jesus and how I thought the context tau ght this. 


If we examine this Scripture, we are not left in doubt as to who used this word PAROUSIA. It was 
Jesus’ Disciples asking for Signs of his PAROUSIA. I was influenced to reason that the word 
PAROUSIA should only be rendered PRESENCE. If this PRESENCE was to be visible, why would 
his followers need signs? Alternatively, if he was to return invisibly, then of course they would ask for 
Signs. As he was invisible they would need signs. A couple of reference that reflect this attitude are 
found in the two publications mentioned hereafter. 


Jehovah’s Witnesses the New World Society by Marley Cole (a book favourable to Jehovah’s 
Witnesses, published in 1956, which is available for purchase from the Society). On page 153, a 
chapter discussing “Doctrines of the New World” is commenced. This chapter consists of a discussion 
between Cole and “Thomas James Sullivan ... Director and Superintendent of Ministers and 
Evangelists.” On page 167 Sullivan asks, 


66 


Chapter eight. Signs of What? 


Did you know that the Disciples did not expect Christ to return 
visibly? In Matthew 24:3; they asked Jesus: ‘What will be the SIGN 
of your presence and of the consummation of the system of things?’ 
And Jesus told them that there would be world wars, food shortages, 
(etc.)”. 


On page 215 of The Watchtower July 15, 1949 it is explained that: 
When the apostles asked Jesus for the sign of his coming and of the 


end of this world, they were really asking for the evidence of the 
establishment of Kingdom as having taken place in the heavens. 


Of course, if these statements were true it would be reasonable to translate PAROUSIA as 
PRESENCE. These statements are not true however, as The Watchtower of September 15, 1964, now 
admits. On page 576 it states concerning these Disciples: 


They did not appreciate that he would not sit on an earthly throne; 
they had no idea that he would rule as a glorious spirit from the 
heavens and therefore did not know that his second presence would 
be invisible. 


So then, considering this question in its context, we have the Disciples expecting the Messiah to 
literally return to the Earth, visibly as their King. They would have been conversant with the technical 
usage of the word PAROUSIA referring to the visit of a King, and they expected their King to return 
visibly. They were asking for signs that would indicate when to expect this visit as king. Therefore I 
was wrong in thinking that their asking for signs indicated that they expected Jesus’ PAROUSIA to be 
invisible. 

How can we conclude otherwise than that the rendering COMING is quite legitimate? The only 
reason for translating PAROUSIA to PRESENCE would be if the Disciples understood that Jesus’ 
visible return would be perceived only by signs. In other words, he would be unknown to them and 
his visit would be a secret one. This is manifestly incorrect, for Jesus gave explicit warning against 
such visits by those who claimed to be the Messiah at Matt. 24:23-26 and in verse 27 he made it 
abundantly clear that his PAROUSIA would be no secret affair, but would be visible to all. It would 
be as evident as a flash of lightning in the Sky. 


The undisguised situation is that the question of the Disciples cannot be used to teach an invisible 
PRESENCE of their King. 


Christs’ Return Visible and Personal 


When I first considered becoming one of Jehovah’s Witnesses and I was first studying the Doctrines 
of the Watchtower Bible and Tract Society, I found this Doctrine concerning the return of Christ the 
most difficult to accept. Now that I have reconsidered the question and given it more thorough 
consideration, I find that the Bible is just full of the teaching of a personal, visible return of Christ. 
Consider the following examples, all of course taken from The New World Translation. 


At Luke 19:12, Jesus likened himself to a man of noble birth who travelled to a distant land to secure 
kingly power for himself AND TO RETURN. Not to just turn his attention from that distant land to 
his own. Verse 15 says: 


Eventually when he got back after having secured the kingly power. 
(emphasis supplied) 


Jesus made it quite clear that he was COMING BACK. 


At John 14:3, he said: “I am coming again.” He was with them then and he promised to REPEAT his 
visit by COMING AGAIN. 


67 


Chapter eight. Signs of What? 


How can we possibly deny the testimony of Acts 3:20, 21? 


And that he may send forth the Christ appointed for you, Jesus, whom 
heaven, indeed, must hold within itself until the times of restoration 
of all things of which God spoke through the mouth of his holy 
prophets of old time. 


There are numerous other examples. Why not examine Matthew 16:27; 24:27; 30, 42, 46; 25:19, 31; 
Luke 9:26; Philippians 3:20; 1 Thessalonians 4:16; Titus 2:13; 1 John 3:2, 3; Jude 14, 15; Revelation 
22:12, etc., for yourself? 


I have reserved consideration of Acts 1:11 until last because I would now like to comment briefly on 
the objections usually raised by the Society to the suggestion that Christ will personally and visibly 
return. Acts 1:11 reveals the advice of the Angels: 


This Jesus who was received up from you into the sky will come thus 
in the same manner as you have beheld him going into the sky. 


How did he go into the sky? Verse 9 answers: 


While they were looking on he was lifted up and. a cloud caught him 
up from their vision. 


The Scripture teaches, then, that He went VISIBLY and PERSONALLY in the CLOUDS. As he 
literally WENT AWAY, then he must literally RETURN, PERSONALLY, VISIBLY, and in the 
CLOUDS. For the Angel said he “will come”, and he surely will. 


One of the latest aids provided by the Society so that its adherents may spread its teachings to others 
and overcome objections, is a small booklet called Sermon Outlines. Page 26 suggests when referring 
to Acts 1:11, “Only disciples saw ascension; return similar”. The Angel did not say that his return 
would be ““similar”. He did say that he will: 


Come thus in the same manner as you have beheld him going. 
John confirmed this testimony at Revelation 1:7 by saying: 
Look! he is coming with the clouds, and every eye will see him. 


Does that sound as though only disciples will see him? The Society says that Jesus’ coming is beheld 
with the eyes of understanding. Did the disciples behold Jesus going to Heaven with the eyes of 
understanding? Certainly not. If he is to return in the same manner as they saw him go, he will return 
so that his disciples can see him, VISIBLY, PERSONALLY and in the CLOUDS. Other objections 
that are said to support an “invisible parousia or presence” are: 


Told disciples world would see him no more. John 14:19. 


This Scripture reads, according to the New World Translation: 


A little longer and the world will behold me no more, but you will 
behold me, because I live and you will live. 


I think it fair to say that this is the key Scripture in the defence of the invisible presence theory of the 
Society. Jesus spoke these words prior to the Crucifixion, but of course he knew it would shortly take 
place. After the resurrection, he did not appear to those alienated from God but only to his followers. 
Hence his words are clear. He referred to the World of that time and said nothing to indicate that he 
meant for all time (see also John 16:16). 


In Acts 20:25 and 38, Paul told some of his friends that they would see him no more, surely he had no 
thought of suggesting to them that they would not see him again, even in the resurrection. Neither 
must we lose sight of the fact that in this same 14th Chapter of John, verse 3, we have the promise that 
he is COMING AGAIN. 


68 


Chapter eight. Signs of What? 


A good deal of space is devoted in the Society’s discussions to the claim that Christ gave his human 
life as a Ransom and was raised an invisible spirit. Whether these claims are true or not is another 
question, but these claims would not prevent Christ returning visibly and personally. 


There are one or two other objections of a minor nature but if one is prepared to give these unbiased 
consideration too, it will readily be observed that they are of no “real substance either. 


A Glance at the History and Peculiarities of this Doctrine 


This subject was introduced for discussion because the Society suggests that the Signs confirm their 
Chronology. The “Christadelphians” also claim that “The Times of the Gentiles” expired in 1914 and 
arrive at this date by the use of a chronological arrangement (which also collapses under examination) 
different to that of the Society and which is opposed to that of the Society. Now if the Signs confirm 
the Society’s arrangement, then they must also confirm that of the Christadelphians, but how can they, 
when each system contradicts the other? Incidentally, Christadelphians claim that Christ will YET 
RETURN VISIBLY. 


A position is usually arrived at after due consideration of the evidence (all of it). Contrary to this 
principle, the Society has decided upon conclusions and has constantly changed its understanding of 
the evidence which is supposed to demand the conclusion, in order to maintain the conclusion. The 
following are just a few more points that clearly demonstrate my assertion. The product that the 
Society produces is a counterfeit 1914. 


Jehovah’s Witnesses in the Divine Purpose reports on page 18 that it was in the year 1876 that 
Charles Taze Russell became convinced that Christ’s 2nd presence had commenced in 1874. (For 
Russell’s own report on the matter, see The Watchtower June Ist, 1916.) Having this conviction, 
when Russell began publishing a Magazine in 1879, he called it Zion’s Watch Tower and Herald of 
Christs Presence. Of course what it was heralding is now understood to have been incorrect, as 
Christ’s presence has been brought forward from 1874 to 1914. 


Vol. 2, page 160 of Studies in the Scriptures demonstrates Russell’s attitude toward the Signs etc. 
contained in Matthew chapter 24. He believed that verses 1 to 14 cover the entire Gospel Age and 
verses 15 to 22 have a double application — literally to the close of the Jewish age and figuratively to 
the end of the Gospel age, of which the Jewish age was a shadow. Verses 23-26 contain words of 
warning against false Christs, etc. According to this arrangement the preaching of the Kingdom 
mentioned in verse 14 had taken place throughout the Gospel Age. 


In the book Pastor Russell’s Sermons on page 678, Russell is recorded as saying concerning Matthew 
24:14: 


The Gospel is the announcement beforehand that the Kingdom is 
coming. When the Kingdom comes, of course the preaching that it is 
coming will be at an end; for the entire object of this preaching is to 
prepare for this coming Kingdom of God. 


Russell died in 1916 and Judge Rutherford became the new President of the Watchtower Society. In 
1921 the Society published a book written by Rutherford entitled The Harp of God. On page 244, 
Rutherford claimed that Christ received power to reign in 1914. However, he wrote: 


It would be reasonable to expect him to be present some time before 
he would take unto himself his great power to reign. His presence 
beginning in 1874. 


On pages 245 and 246 of his book, the Signs of Matthew 24 are considered, where it is stated: 


These, said the Master, mark the beginning of the end of the world, 
which takes place during the time of his presence. 


69 


Chapter eight. Signs of What? 


At this time, it was maintained that the Signs commenced in 1914 although Christ was present since 
1874. Today we are urged to accept the Signs as identifying 1914 as the beginning of Christ’s 
Presence. If the Society thought that it was not necessary to believe this in 1921, why is it necessary to 
believe it now? In 1927, Rutherford had another book published by the Society, the title being 
Creation. This book provides evidence that the Society had changed its view slightly, however 1874 
and 1914 were still maintained. 


On page 324 we read: 


The period of the Gentile times must end in 1914 AD. That marks the 
due time for the coming of “him whose right it is” to take over the 
affairs of the world. That, of course, would mean the presence of the 
Lord taking action in things pertaining to the world. 


On page 325 it is asserted: 


The facts hereinbefore considered show that the Lord was present 
from 1874 forward, in this, that he was doing a special work 
concerning his church, to wit gathering together the saints (etc.). 


So we have Christ present from 1874 and commencing a different phase of his presence in 1914 
Prophecy published in 1929 stated: 


The Scriptural proof is that the second presence of the Lord Jesus 
Christ began in 1874 AD. (page 65) 


Preparation published in 1933, says on page 231 that Jehovah’s organisation was: 


Doing the Elyah work under the leadership of Christ Jesus from 1874 
to 1918. 


Having dropped the Chronology leading to 1874, the Society now says that Christ’s presence began in 
1914, because of Chronology which is still maintained and because of the Signs which formerly did 
NOT demand this. Once again we have clear evidence that it is the Chronology that is the basis of the 
Society’s understanding of matters. Seeing that that is wrong, what of what is left? 1914 and all that 
goes with it is counterfeit. 


If a sheet of paper, on which a key has been laid, be exposed for some minutes to the sunshine, and 
then instantaneously viewed in the dark, the key being removed, a fading spectre of the key will be 
visible. Let this paper be put aside for many months where nothing can disturb it, and then in darkness 
be laid on a plate of hot metal, the spectre of the key will again appear. In the case of bodies more 
highly phosphorescent than paper, the spectres of many different objects which may have been laid 
on in succession will, on warming, emerge in their proper order. 


This is equally true of the record of the Society. It is unfortunately the result when this record is 
exposed to the light of truth that we see the stain of so much confusion, adjusting, and twisting in 
order to maintain 1914 and its position of authority over its adherents. 


70 


CHAPTER NINE. SIGNS OF PREJUDICE 


The Society claims that the Signs identify 1914 positively. Others see no truthfulness in this claim 
whatever. What is the true position? We have the confusing situation where the Society claims to be 
telling the truth but then so do the others. Obviously, someone could not possibly be telling the truth, 
for the Signs either identify 1914 or they do not. 


It is told of Alexander the Great that he had a soldier in his army who bore his own name but was a 
great coward. The emperor, enraged at his conduct, justly said to him, “Either change your name or 
learn to honour it.” Can we also ask that whoever is not telling the truth, should admit it or else start 
doing so? 


For nation will rise against nation and kingdom against kingdom. 
(Matthew. 24:7) 


This is really the Scripture that the Society uses to identify 1914, because that was the year when 
World War | broke out, and the Society says that this was the fulfilment of the Prophecy. 


In considering this claim, let it first of all be noted that it is not necessary to connect this Scripture 
with 1914, for if we follow the interpretation suggested by Russell (and others), we have up to verse 
14 of Matthew chapter 24 applying to the whole Gospel Age. When we also consider verse 6 of this 
chapter, we can understand better. 


You are going to hear of wars and reports of wars; see that you are 
not terrified. For these things must take place, but the end is not yet. 


Verse 7 commences “For”. Now as everyone knows, the word “For” is a conjunction ( joining verses 
6 and 7 together). Therefore verse can be taken as explaining verse 6. In other words, we have Jesus 
saying that his followers would hear of wars but not to be worried, as these would not bring about the 
end, and they were not to the end because of Wars. There would be many wars before the end, FOR 
(or because) nation will rise against nation etc. Then follows the quick resume of history down 
through the Gospel Age. 


Of course, if we followed the Society’s suggestion and aligned these verses with World War | and 
other events which have taken place since 1914, we would really have 1914 identified ONLY by the 
1st World War. If it is reasonable to say that 1914 must be the year because of the War beginning in 
that year, then to follow this line of logic to its logical conclusion we should also be able to ascertain, 
beside the year, the Month, the Day and so on. 


BE page 180 points out that 


[The] appointed times of the nations (Gentile Times) would end about 
the middle of the month Tishri (or near October I), AD 1914. That is 
an unforgettable year, for in 1914 World War 1 broke out and the 
Gentile system of things has never been the same since then. 


The inference is that God certifies this Chronology by beginning the Signs then too. The Watchtower 
October 15, 1961, page 620, says: 


It was not merely accidental, it was not by mere miscalculation on the 
part of some maniac, that World War | broke out in 1914 and that the 
world has never been the same since then. It was because the 
“appointed times of the nations” ended in 1914. 


That year was God’s own chosen time to renew the kingdom of God 
over the earth and put his self-sacrificing Son Jesus Christ on the 
heavenly throne to rule mankind and to destroy the enemies of God 
and of man. By means of the Bible’s time schedule, together with 
historical chronology, we can calculate the date 1914 exactly, as 
being 2520 years from Jerusalem’s destruction in 607 BC. But even if 


71 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


we did not have the means to calculate the date, we have the visible 
evidences foretold by divine prophecy to prove the date. 


The mention of the “date” here is very vague because the end of the “appointed times of the nations” 
(according to the Society’s reckoning) and the beginning of the Signs (according to the Society’s 
interpretation), cannot be brought closer together than in the same year, because World War 1 began 
long before October Ist, 1914. 


Your Will be Done on Earth reveals on page 271 that Austria-Hungary declared War on Serbia on 
July 28, 1914. Germany declared war on Russia on August Ist and upon France on August 3rd. 
Britain declared war upon Germany on August 4th. The rising of Nation against Nation and Kingdom 
against Kingdom in 1914 began therefore, long before October Ist. 


If the following of one Nation after another into the conflict in 1914 was the beginning of the Signs, 
and if the beginning of the Signs point to the time when Christ began his PRESENCE, we have him 
present before Jehovah’s appointed time, according to the Society’s Chronology. This would mean, 
according to the Society, that he was turning his attention toward the affairs of the Earth before he 
was supposed to. Does this seem likely to you? 


Obviously Jesus’ second presence could only begin once, and so any semblance of confirmation of 
the Chronology by the Signs is one of appearances only, which too cannot stand examination. 


I have already demonstrated that whether the signs began fulfilment in 1914 or not is really 
immaterial because they are signs of Jesus’ coming. There can be no doubt that the Society has 
repeatedly changed its interpretation of the Bible and World events to favour 1914 because it is 
prejudiced toward that date. It is influenced by this prejudice. 


Chemists tell us that a single grain of the substance called iodine will impart colours to seven 
thousand times its weight of water. It is nothing short of amazing how the few leaders of the Society 
have succeeded in staining or prejudicing the minds of so many others in favour of 1914. Iam sure 
that it can be said quite truthfully that there are 3 basic reasons for this. 


1. The Society has repeatedly stated that the Signs commenced in 1914. 
2. The Society claims this in a confident insistent way, ridiculing all those who do not agree. 


3. The Society enjoys a position of absolute authority in the eyes of Jehovah’s Witnesses. They 
believe whatever the Society tells them. It is a common expression among Jehovah’s 
Witnesses that the Watchtower says this or the Watchtower says that, as though if this is true, 
the matter is settled. 


It is indisputably true that Jehovah’s Witnesses have been given what appear to be very good 
arguments in favour of the teaching that the Signs began in 1914. It is true too that as they go from 
door to door, victory after victory is gained by using these arguments, and so to the Witness these 
arguments become even more convincing. Yet, though these arguments are able to score victories, 
even convince others of their factualness, they are not necessarily true. 


It is very easy for a person to become convinced of something which is pleasing to him, or in which 
he wants to believe. If it was true that Jesus Christ has been present in Kingly power since 1914, it 
would be a wonderful thing. Particularly if one was one of Jehovah’s Witnesses who were to gain 
eternal life at any time since that date. Can any one of Jehovah’s Witnesses deny that this is pleasing 
to him and is what he wants to believe? 


Think of those who formulate the Doctrines. Do you think that they want to believe this? Do you 
think that they want to believe that they will rule as Kings with Jesus? They have constantly arranged 
their thoughts to fit in with this hope. 


It is not difficult to construct good arguments in support of what we want to believe, BUT 
unfortunately the beliefs don’t follow from the arguments. The arguments follow from the beliefs. 


There are many other examples of such prejudice in other religions, not the least of which is the belief 
in the British Israel theory by some people. So it is with 1914, arguments have been continually 


72 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


raised, dropped and amended so that the belief is retained. The Society refuses to accept any facts 
which prove their belief to be in error. I cannot go along with them in this. 


If you have found yourself growing angry at my suggestions, may I suggest to you that you have 
proof of your prejudice If you consider that you can consider facts that prove that the signs did not 
commence in 1914, and that the Society’s claims are the result of prejudice, with a clear mind, I offer 
the following for your consideration. 


World War 1 


We have first for consideration the World War which commenced in 1914 but which, as has already 
been observed, did not commence at the time when the Society claims the “Times of the Gentiles” 
ended. In any event, Jesus made no mention of World Wars. He merely referred to Nation rising 
against Nation and Kingdom against Kingdom as explanation of his statement to his followers that 
they would hear of Wars and rumours of Wars. 


However, for the purpose of considering whether the Society is prejudiced or not, we can assume that 
Jesus referred to an International War as beginning the Signs. Was the 1st World War the one to 
which he referred? 


In answer, I suggest that we refer to Encyclopedia Britannica 1961 edition, and consider the article 
“War” in Vol. 23. pages 321-335. Page 323 provides some very enlightening information. 


In a list of 278 wars participated in by the members of the modern 
community of nations from 1480 to World War II, 135 were 
international, 65 imperial add 78 civil. (see Q Wright, A Study of War, 
1942, pp. 64Iff.) These wars varied greatly in magnitude from 
relatively minor episodes involving only two small countries and 
lasting only a few months, to such events as the Thirty Years’ war, 
the Seven Years’ War, the Napoleonic Wars and World Wars I and II, 
involving all of the great powers, many other states, millions of 
casualties and, with the exception of the first, extending all over the 
world. 


The civil wars, including the French Huguenot wars of the 16th 
century, the Great Rebellion, and the German Thirty Years’ War in 
the 17th century, the French Revolution in the 18th century, the 
American Civil War and the Chinese Taiping rebellion in the 19th 
century, and the Russian and Chinese revolutions in the 20th century, 
were extraordinarily costly in life. 


Imperial wars were as a rule the least costly in life because of the 
usual marked disparity in military power between the belligerents. 


Each of 15 International wars during the modern period (four in the 
17th, seven in the 18", two in the 19", and two in the 20th century) 


included substantially all of the great powers _as_belligerents. 
(emphases supplied) 


Several other quotations from this same article could be produced as evidence that by no stretch of the 
imagination can it be claimed that Nation rose against Nation and Kingdom against Kingdom for the 
first time in 1914. 


No one denies that the 1914 World War was greater in magnitude than any War that preceded it. No 
doubt it was named as a “World War” because of its magnitude. Nevertheless, the second “World 
War” was greater in magnitude again and was more truly a “World War” than “World War 1” or any 
of the conflicts mentioned above. It seems reasonable to assume that the next War will have even 
more to recommend it as a “World War”. 


73 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


The following is a further quotation from page 323 of the abovementioned Vol. of Britannica 


Wars showed a slight tendency to decrease_in length during the 
modern period, but in all other aspects they tended to increase in 
magnitude. There were more battles, more participants, larger forces, 
larger numbers of casualties, more extensive areas of occupation and 
greater mechanization resulting in much heavier economic costs. This 
tendency was by no means continuous. The costs of the Thirty Years’ 
War of the 17th century were very great. World War II, however, was 
greater in all these respects than any other war in history. (emphasis 
again supplied.) 


I submit that the selection of World War | as the time of Nation rising against Nation and Kingdom 
against Kingdom is the product of prejudiced reasoning designed to support 1914. 


Tho Melbourne Newspaper, The Sun in its issue Sept. 5, 1962, contained an article, “DISASTER and 
what it costs”. This article was inspired by the terrible Earthquake that shook Persia only four days 
earlier. It stated that: 


In terms of human lives, injuries, devastation, cost and misery, the 
world’s greatest, and worst disaster was World War II. 


Why not commence the signs in 1939? This article gave information on other “DISASTERS” to 
which I will refer, e.g: 


Earthquakes and volcanoes are among the worst disasters man has to 
suffer, but they are not the greatest takers of life. 


The Black Death, which swept Asia and Europe in the 14th century, 
took about 40 million lives. 


But still within memory of many today was the influenza epidemic of 
1918 which was believed to have killed more than 21 million as it 
swept the world. The scourge “depopulated” India. In China more 
than 13 million were said to have died. At sea, ships were regularly 
found floating with everyone dead on board. 


For the present, we will content ourselves with the next sign: 


Food Shortages 


Reference to any Encyclopaedia or other authoritative work on Famines will not disclose a famine (of 
any consequence anyway) during the year 1914. There were famines before that year and there have 
been famines since that year. There is no doubt that largely because of the huge increase among the 
population of the world, there is a great shortage of food in many places today. Among the many 
disasters that would occur as Signs of Jesus’ coming, as given by him, were Famines or Food 
Shortages. 


Information on subjects such as these is usually easiest to find in an Encyclopaedia. Encyclopedia 
Americana, for example provides some interesting information, the 1963 edition Vol. 2 pages 8 and 9 
provides some details that I will summarize. The relevant sections, anyway. 


Famines during the latter part of the last Century included Ireland’s “Potato Famine” of 1846-47, one 
million died. 


Famines occurred in India in 1861, 1869, 1876-1878 (which took a toll of 5,000,000 victims), 1899- 
1901, 1943 and 1952. 


Russia has suffered two major famines since the establishment of the Soviet regime. 1921-23 and 
1932-1933. 


74 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


Perhaps the most lethal of all modern famines occurred in North 
China in 1877-1878 when floods destroyed food stocks over a vast 
area, thus dooming to starvation some nine million inhabitants. 


On what grounds can we say that these famines were not included in Jesus’ prophecy? Would it be 
because they would not then match the Chronology? 


Encyclopaedia Britannica, under the heading “Famine” gives a long list of famines, 12 of which 
occurred during the 19th Century. How anyone could identify Famines or Food Shortages with 1914 
is a question that requires answering. 


One might not object to a claim that a general food shortage has been becoming more evident in the 
World. What though has this to do with 1914? Did this food shortage commence in 1914, or 1800, or 
1880, or some other date? It cannot be claimed that Famines or Food Shortages point to 1914. I 
suppose it can be claimed what I should have said is that such a claim cannot be supported by 
evidence, logic, or reason. 


Earthquakes 
Earthquakes demand our attention next. 
The above-mentioned newspaper, The Sun, advises that: 


The most disastrous earthquake on record was the one in the Shensi 
province of China that occurred in 1556 and took an estimated 
830,000 lives. 


But this has been exceeded over the years by Sicily’s notorious 
volcano, Mt. Etna. Since its first recorded “blast” in 476 BC, it has 
accounted for more than one million lives. 


Recorded history’s greatest natural upheaval occurred at 10 a.m. on 
Monday, August 27, 1883 — the mighty Krakatoa explosion, a blow 
that literally shook the world. 


Krakatoa was a 3000 ft volcano in the Straits of Sunda, between Java 
and Sumatra. On August 26, after lying dormant many years, it began 
erupting. Every few minutes, came earth-tremoring detonations. 


The noise was heard thousands of miles away — in South Australia, 
New Guinea, Ceylon. It set off tidal waves more than 100 ft. High. As 
far away as England strange twilights and sunsets were seen for a 
year. The tidal waves carried round the world three times. 


Krakatoa’s outburst wiped out towns and villages. The tidal waves 
sank ships far away at sea. The death toll has been recorded as 
35,500. 


The Genesis Flood by Henry M. Morris and John C. Whitcomb Jr. (1964) mentions this catastrophe 
and others. On page 264: 


The great Krakatoa earthquake in the East Indies in 1883 created 
immense waves at least 100 feet high and travelling up to 450 miles 
per hour, inundating neighbouring islands and drowning nearly 
40,000 people. A tsunami from this quake was still two feet as it 
passed Ceylon and nine inches high at Aden beyond the Arabian Sea. 


In 1946, a tsunami originating in a quake in the Aleutian Island region 
traveled 470 miles per hour across the Pacific, creating a 19-foot high 
“tidal” wave on the shores of Hawaii, with great destruction. A wave 
that swept across the Bay of Bengal in 1876 left 200,000 people dead. 


75 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


Ripleys’ Believe it or Not (8th Series) refers to: 


The Seamen who were drowned by a catastrophe 5000 miles away! 
Several hundred sailors lost their lives and 16 ships were wrecked in 
Broughton Bay, Wales, on Jan. 6, 1868 by a Tidal Wave created by 
an earthquake in South America. 


Australasian Post May 14, 1964 contains an article, “The GIANT jolts”. It says: 


The intensity of an earthquake is rated by its effects on rock and earth 
and on man and his works. 


This is why it is difficult to state which earthquake has been the 
greatest as each must be judged in terms of loss of life and property 
damage in the human world, or marked changes in the earth’s 
formation. 


It is generally conceded in modern times that the most famous ‘quake 
was the Lisbon earthquake of 1755, although since then there have 
been the terrible jolt at Tokyo in 1923 and the recent Alaskan disaster, 
said to be the strongest ever. 


Did destructive earthquakes start to occur only in 1914 AD? Doubtless as population and building etc. 
has increased, so has the potential for earthquakes to kill and destroy increased. 


Nevertheless, reference to encyclopaedias etc., shows that numerous destructive earthquakes took 
place before 1914. The well known earthquake which occurred in San Francisco in 1906, just a few 
years prior to 1914, is one of these. 


Earthquakes (1957) by G A Eiby provides some interesting statistics in the Appendix, which I will 
present for consideration. These statistics prove that it is absolutely impossible to identify 1914 by 
earthquakes. 


Important Earthquakes since 1904. 


This list begins in 1904 because that is the first year which 
instrumental magnitudes are available. It contains all shocks with a 
magnitude of 8 or more, together with the most important 
intermediate and deep shocks, which generally have somewhat 
smaller magnitude than the shallow ones. 


In addition, it contains shocks of less intensity that have been the 
subject of important researches or have attracted unusual public 
attention. As in the list of earlier shocks, proper names have been 
given in capitals. Magnitudes have been taken from the lists in 
Gutenberg and Richter’s Seismicity of the Earth from USCGS 
Epicentre cards from Pacedena station Bulletins, and in a few cases 
from the bulletin of the New Zealand network. 


Date Epicentral Region Magnitude com 
1904 Jan. 20 Panama TA 
June 25 Kamchatka 8 
June 25 Kamchatka 8.1 
June 27 Kamchatka 7.9 
Aug 27 KOLYMA, Siberia TA 
Dec 20 Costa Rica TA 


76 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


Date Epicentral Region Magnitude aot 
1905 Apr 4 KANGRA, India 8 
July 9 SW of Lake Baikal 84 
July 23 SW of Lake Baikal 8 
1906 Jan 21 HONSHU, Japan 8 340 km 
Jan 31 Colombia, Ecuador 8.6 
Apr 18 SAN FRANCISCO, California 84 
Aug 17 Aleutians 8 
Aug 17 Chile 8.4 
Sep 14 New Guinea 8.1 
Dec 22 SIKIANG, China 7.9 
1907 Apr 15 Mexico 8.1 
Oct 21 KARATAG 8 
1908 Dec 28 MESSINA Ti 
1910 Jun 16 Loyalty Islands 8.1 100 km 
1911 Jan 3 TIEN SHAN, Turkestan 8.4 
Feb 18 FERGHANA, Pamirs Ti 
Jun 15 Ryukyu, Japan 8.2 160 km 
1912 May 23 Burma 8 
1913 Mar 14 Moluccas 7.9 
1914 May 26 New Guinea 7.9 
Nov 24 Marianas 8.1 110 km 
1915 May 1 Kamchatka 7.9 
Oct 3 NEVADA, USA Ti 
1916 Jan 13 New Guinea 7.8 
1917 May 1 Tonga 8 
Jun 26 SW of Hawaii 8.3 
1918 Aug 15 Caroline Is. 84 
Sept 7 Kurile Is. 8 
1919 Apr 30 Tonga 8.3 


The list continues but we do not need follow it further for we are mainly interested to see if anything 
happened in 1914 to identify that year as the beginning of a series. Can you see anything to support 
the Society's contention? 


There have been several serious earthquakes in recent years, and this is acknowledged. There is 
nothing to suggest however, that Jesus' promise that there would be “earthquakes in one place after 
another” commenced its fulfilment in 1914 AD. 


77 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


Were there not “earthquakes in one place after another” in 1906 AD, for example? Eiby lists 7 
earthquakes in that year that occurred in various localities all over the World. 


If earthquakes have been occurring with greater frequency or in greater magnitude, what evidence is 
there to tie the commencement of this sudden change with the year 1914 AD? Obviously there has 
been no sudden change. If there has been an increase, it has been a gradual change over recent 
centuries. 


Pestilences 


The Society draws attention to pestilences that have occurred since 1914, particularly to the Spanish 
Influenza Epidemic of 1918-1919. 


If this epidemic occurred since 1914, is it not true that it occurred also since 1906 or 1844 or any other 
previous date? Why insist that it identifies 1914? Why not 1918? 


It is obvious that the Society is biased in this matter too when it is considered that “The Plague” has 
been occurring off and on throughout the Earth for centuries. Has the Society mentioned anything 
about the outbreak during the years immediately prior to 1914? Encyclopaedia Britannica (1961) Vol. 
17 page 991 reports, 


Ports in south China became plague distribution centres, and between 
1894 and 1922 the disease spread throughout the whole world, more 
widely than during any great foregoing epidemics ... The reported 
number of deaths between 1896 and 1917 was 9,841,396; the 
maximum reached in 1907 was 1,315,892 — a rate of 5.16 per 1,000 of 
the population. Fortunately, in the ensuing 25 years the incidence 
curve turned downward towards greatly diminished prevalence. 
(emphasis supplied) 


(Please refer to my page 74 for the comments I drew attention appearing in the Melbourne newspaper 
The Sun.) 


Surely, on the basis of the brief evidence provided here alone, it cannot be denied that only the items 
that might tend to support 1914 are considered or fed to readers of the Society’s Publications. 


Darkened Sun and Moon 


Consideration could also be given to the darkened Sun and the Moon not giving its light mentioned in 
Matthew 24:29, for the Society has great difficulty in providing a literal interpretation of this 
prophecy. The interested reader is referred to The Watchtower of April Ist, 1962 and Your Will Be 
Done On Earth page 320. 


There is no doubt that all of the evidence is made up to present a 1914 which is unknown either to the 
Bible or to History. Like all counterfeits it can be detected as such upon close examination. 


Generation 


In an endeavour to try and convince that the Signs must all occur in one cluster (in other words, since 
1914) the Society tries to make gain of Matthew 24:34 “Truly I say to you that this generation will by 
no means pass away until all these things occur.” (See also Mark 13:30 and Luke 21:32.) 


The Society claims that all the Signs must occur in one generation so that one generation can see them 
all. We would have to be sure that a generation meant a group of people living over a certain period 
before we could be sure of the claim made. What did the word “generation” mean? 


Awake September 22, 1962 asks, 


Was Jesus using the word “generation” in a symbolic way? No, we 
should not say that the word “generation” here has a symbolic 
meaning and that it refers, for example, to persons of the spiritual 
body of Christ exclusively, or only to the true Christian organization 
itself. 


78 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


The word ‘generation’ at Matthew 24:34 is to be viewed in an 
ordinary sense, as at Acts 13:36 and Mark 8:12. Acts 13:36 speaks of 
David’s very own generation, a literal generation. The generation of 
persons living in Jesus’ time, persons who sought a sign, according to 
Mark 8:12, was a literal generation. 


That a symbolic application to a “generation” of wicked persons is 
not meant at Matthew 24:34 is apparent when we read the preceding 
verse, “Likewise also you, when you see all these things, know that 
he is near at the doors”. 


Need I say that all this fits in very well with the Society’s arrangement. But does it fit in with the 
facts? Is it necessary to derive this meaning from Jesus’ words? 


As we scan through the record of the life of Jesus, we find that he used this expression on many 
occasions, “this generation”. An examination of these seems to indicate quite clearly that it was his 
custom to often refer to the Jews in this manner (see Matt. 11:16; 12:41;42; 23:36; Mark 8:12; Luke 
7:31; 11:29-32 and 50, 51; 17:25.) Therefore there seems to be justification in applying his expression 
at Matthew 24:34 to the Jews or the people then living. He would have then been referring to the 
destruction of Jerusalem. 


The Magazine People, dated November 25, 1959 refers to this subject and comments, 


The early Christians thought the end was near, basing their belief on 
the words of Christ, Who, speaking about the end of the world, said: 
“Verily I say unto you that this generation shall not pass, till all these 
things be done.” 


Later, it was explained that the words of the Gospel have been 
misinterpreted. By “generation” a period of about 1,000 years was to 
be understood. The final catastrophe, it was declared, would occur in 
AD 1000. 


In fact, in the year 1000 everyone expected the end of the world. 
Many documents dating from the end of the first millennium begin 
with the words ‘On the eve of the end of the world.’ 


In Europe at that time there was a general desire for atonement, and 
many of the rich gave away their possessions. 


This interpretation stretches a “generation” to a period of 1,000 years. The Society has it at about 70 
or 80 years usually, but the abovementioned Awake was more cautious and did not suggest a definite 
number of years, although it suggested that Armageddon comes “Within the span of a generation, the 
generation experiencing the realization of the events foretold in Jesus’ prophecy”. Therefore a 
generation would be about the length of a man’s lifetime. 


Collins National Dictionary says that a generation is “usually calculated at 33 years.” 


Some point out that the primary definition of the Greek word for generation, genea, is “race, kind, 
family, stock, breed”. They claim that the promise is that the generation — nation or family of Israel - 
will be preserved until the signs etc. have been fulfilled. (See Scofield Reference Bible.) This is also a 
reasonable possibility and it is rather wonderful when one thinks of it that although being scattered for 
centuries, the Jewish race maintained its identity. 


Others say Jesus referred to “the generation of believers”, as though Jesus was saying that true 
believers would continue until all the things he mentioned had expired. This does not seem an 
unreasonable interpretation either, for the word sometimes refers to certain types or people possessing 
similar characteristics, e.g. Jesus spoke of “the sons of this system of things” at Luke 16:8 as being 
“wiser in a practical way toward their own generation (or types) than the sons of the light are.” (see 
Thayer’s Greek Lexicon and W E Vine, Expository Dictionary of New Testament Words.) 


79 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


There other possible interpretations and I have an open mind on the subject. I prefer the suggestion 
that Jesus referred to the Jewish Race. Whatever one’s conclusions are, it is clear that that they are not 
able to be positive and are probably influenced by some other factor. This applies to the Society too. 
Its interpretation is once again in favour of 1914 and is only one among several possibilities. As its 
understanding of the basic matter (1914) is in error, it is more than likely that its interpretation of this 
matter is in error too. 


Faithful and Discreet Slave 


After mentioning various signs etc. related to his PAROUSIA in Matt. 24, Jesus gave a series of 
parables intended to inculcate preparedness for the crisis associated with his return (see also the 
comments on my page 65). 


In verses 43 and 44, we learn of the Thief in the Night. Verses 45-51 contain a parable related to 
Faithful and Unfaithful Servants. Chapter 25:1-13 describes the parable of the Ten Virgins. Following 
on from this we learn of Waiting Servants Entrusted with “Talents”. 


The Society has taken the parable concerning the Faithful and Unfaithful Servants, saying that it itself 
is the Faithful and Discreet Slave (Faithful and Wise Servant) of verse 45. 


The Watchtower of June Ist, 1963, advises, 


We have gained all this knowledge through the arrangement Jehovah 
is pleased to use at the present time, namely through his anointed 
spirit-be gotten witnesses, comprising the ‘faithful and discreet slave’ 
class described by Jesus at Matthew 24:45-47. This slave class has 
used the Watch Tower Society as its legal instrument since 1884, and 
the chief publication of dissemination of Bible truth since 1879 has 
been the Watchtower. It is so even to this day. Develop deep respect 
for this arrangement, for this is pleasing in the eyes of Jehovah. 


I lost any respect I ever had for the Society when I learned the truth of this matter under review. I 
know that any respect that one had for the Society and its “Bible truth” would not be “pleasing in the 
eyes of Jehovah.” 


The parable being considered here can also be read at Luke 12:42-46. When reading the parable, we 
can see quite clearly that the emphasis is upon the contrasting behaviour of two servants. One 
faithfully performs his duties, the other displays a lax attitude, thinking that he can satisfy his own 
lusts at a time when he is sure his Master will not come back. Probably he thinks he can straighten 
himself out before his Master comes but, being lax and unprepared, he will get caught. 


So when Jesus asked in verse 45 “Who really is the faithful and discreet slave?” the answer obviously 
is The Servant who all the time, that is every hour of every day, attends to his duties just as though his 
Master would return at that very minute. The Faithful Servant justly receives a reward described in 
verse 47. The highest reward a Servant can get is probably to be made overseer of all that belongs to 
his Master. What a high honour! Likewise, a faithful Christian will receive the greatest honour and 
reward held out by God. The Unfaithful Servant will in contrast receive the severest punishment as 
signified in verse 51. 


The parables concerning the “Virgins” and the “Talents” also demonstrate the reward of watchfulness 
or preparedness, and the Society has no right to seize upon one of these parables to provide itself with 
credentials so that it can set itself up as an organisation claiming the right to tell everyone else what 
they must believe. That the Society is NOT entitled to do this is emphasised by the fact that the basis 
for much of its teaching is false. This has been amply demonstrated both in this section on Signs and 
in the section on Chronology etc. 


It is interesting to note that Pastor Russell used to be identified as the Faithful Servant by his 
followers. As time went on after Russell died, the position of authority had to be assumed by the 
Society. On page 239 of The Harp of God, Rutherford said, 


80 


Chapter nine. Signs of Prejudice 


Without doubt Pastor Russell filled the office for which the Lord 
provided and about which he spoke, and was therefore that wise and 
faithful servant, ministering to the household of faith meat in due 
season. 


Without a doubt? (see also Watchtower page 74, 1/3/922) 


Being the spokesman for a God is virtually as good as being that God yourself. Many men have 
realised this down through the centuries and have exploited the position. The Priests in many Pagan 
religions are examples, and perhaps the Pope of the Roman Catholics is the most notable. Ripley's 
Believe it or Not! contains a very interesting tit bit: 


The War Council that was Ruled For 8 Years By An Empty Chair 


GENERAL EUMENES, secretary to Alexander the Great, dominated 
the other Generals after Alexander's death by convincing them the 
Monarch had appeared in a dream and ordered the council to hold all 
future meetings in the Royal Tent — in the presence of Alexander's 
Throne, Crown and Scepter. Eumenes was obeyed as spokesman for 
the Royal Ghost from 323 BC, the year of Alexander's death, until 
315 BC — when the General himself was slain. 


Apparently the others never found out. Having this position, the Society maintains a position of 
absolute authority in the eyes of Jehovah's Witnesses. Consequently, they study what the Society says 
the Bible says, rather than the Bible. Their study is prepared for them always, it is really just a process 
of continuous indoctrination. 


I cannot see where the Society is Faithful or Discreet. I can see where it is prejudiced. 


It is as though the Society were in a labyrinth, as long as it refuses to commence in all but one 
direction (1914) it will remain forever lost. 


All those who remain alive and do not realise this beforehand will have this proved to them one day. 
Whichever way it goes, I hope that you will have made your decision in the light of the facts. 


81 


CONCLUSION 


The Society has provided conclusive evidence of its meandering all over the place down through the 
years in order to maintain 1914 and the position of the absolute authority it has usurped as God’s 
organisation and his only channel of communication. A case is presented but continually amended in 
order to maintain the conclusion and a beautiful picture is built up. 


BUT we find on examination that the artful expedient of leaving out some of the facts is resorted to, 
and it is unfortunately also true that the consideration of these facts exposes the Society’s picture as a 
mere illusion. 


Will their lack of faith perhaps make the faithfulness of God without 
effect? Never may that happen! But let God be found true, though 
every man be found a liar. (Romans 3:3, 4) 


A rich man once entertained a friend whom he had not seen since childhood. A great feast was 
prepared and the tables were laden with the most delicate dishes. Gold and silver was everywhere. 
The rich man took an apple from a golden dish which was large and smooth and rosy, and as he 
handed it to his friend, he said, “Look at this apple, it lay upon a dish of pure gold and it is a beautiful 
sight to see.” His overwhelmed friend took the apple and cut it through, but alas there was a worm at 
the core. 


So it is with many Doctrines of religious organisations. They are served in the brilliance of the 
Scriptures as though they were of the greatest value. When taken and cut to the core and examined 
closely many of them are found to be unfit for consumption. They are found to be rotten at the heart 
irrespective of how they are dressed up and irrespective of their being recommended to us by others. 


YW page 363 instructs that: 


All who become Jesus’ disciples by dedicating themselves to Jehovah 
God as he did must obey the command to be baptized in water. They 
must also accept teaching that God provides through his visible 
organization on earth. 


Once we accept the teachings of the Society that conflict with the Bible it is obvious that we cannot at 
the same time “let God be found true”. Once we accept the Society as the authority to tell us what we 
should or should not believe, we are entirely at their mercy. 


Its teachings are made to appear plausible but they are insidious and untrue. If the Society was 
teaching the truth on this matter, it would welcome any queries such as I have raised. I have written to 
the Society on several occasions, begging help on several of these matters, but you will not read these 
questions and the answers given in The Watchtower. My questions were avoided and no assistance 
whatever was given. 


You should not take my word for this, you have the responsibllity yourself to “let God be found true” 
and to “make sure of all things.” Have you made sure of your beliefs related to 1914? If you have, you 
should have no difficulties in solving the problems I have raised. If you have not, then you will no 
doubt want to do so for your eternal welfare may depend on it and you are no doubt aware of your 
responsibility to those for whom you are responsible. 


If you cannot find the answer to these problems, why not try getting clarification from the Society? If 
you wish to do this, then here are some of your problems. 


1. Can 539 BC be calculated without the use of Ptolemy’s Canon? 


2. What evidence is there that Ptolemy’s Canon is in error in 604 BC (Nebuchadnezzar’s lst 
regnal year) and is not in error in 539 BC? 


3. Why is 539 BC an “Absolute Date” yet 604 BC and 597 BC are not? 


4. Why not date the COMPLETE desolation of Judah from 586 BC to 516 BC, if it has to be 70 
years? 


82 


10. 


11. 


12. 


13. 


14. 


15. 


16. 
17. 
18. 
19. 
20. 


21. 


22. 
23. 


24. 


Conclusion 


As Astronomers can calculate the date of Tablets containing Astronomical data, why doesn’t 
the Society accept the positive Astronomical evidence that Nebuchadnezzar’s 37th year was 
568 BC? 


How can the Society account for the fact that thousands and thousands of cuneiform tablets 
have been unearthed which date the reigns of the New Babylonian Kings in complete 
harmony with Ptolemy’s Canon and not a scrap of evidence has been found anywhere to 
suggest an extra 20 years approx? 


The Stele of the lady Adda-guppi agrees exactly with Ptolemy’s Canon and proves that there 
were no gaps between the reigns of the New Babylonian Kings. We also have exact 
confirmation from Berosus. How can this evidence be denied? 


How can the Society explain its list of New-Babylonian Kings, as when we compare this list 
with the dates given, we find them irreconcilable? 


If the “Nabonidus Chronicle” makes the 539 BC date absolute, why doesn’t the other 
“Babylonian Chronicle” make other dates absolute, such as 604 BC and 597 BC? 


Is it not possible that Ezra used the Tishri (or Civil Year) Calendar when reckoning the Ist 
year of Cyrus? Could not the return have taken place in 536 BC? 


If Cyrus’ reign was counted as beginning after that of Darius the Mede, how can his re gnal 
years begin counting before 537-536 BC? 


If we want to count 70 years back from 536 BC or 537 BC, how do we prove that the 70 years 
were full years and not inclusively reckoned? 


According to the “figure specialists” Parker and Dubberstein (Babylonian Chronology 626 
BC-AD 75), the 23rd year of Nebuchadnezzar was 582 BC. As Jeremiah 52:30 reports, the 
final group of Captives being taken in this year, why not commence the desolation and the 
2520 year period from 582 BC? We would then arrive at AD 1939 for the end of the “Times 
of the Gentiles” and this was the year when the greatest War ever broke out. Maybe around 
1984 or 1994, the Society will switch to an arrangement like this. That is, if it still exists. 


Does not Jeremiah 27:6, 7 indicate that the servitude to Babylon began long before the 11th 
year of Zedekiah? And what about Jeremiah 29:10? 


Does not the Society’s reference to desolation in “the complete sense” indicate that there can 
be desolation in an INCOMPLETE sense? (cf. SI page 284 as an example.) 


Could not the Jews have served Babylon in their own land? 

How can Daniel 1:2 be explained if it relates to Jehoiakim’s 11th year? 

What proof do we have that Daniel did not use the Tishri Calendar at Daniel 1:1? 
Why cannot the 3 years training of Daniel 2 be reckoned inclusively? 


Cannot the Hebrew expression CHORBAH refer to an occupied land? (cf Jeremiah 25:18 and 
Ezekiel 33: 27, 28.) 


Cannot 2 Chronicles 36:21 be saying that the land lay at rest for the final 50 years of Judah’s 
desolation until the full period came its end? 


What evidence is there that 2 Chronicles 36:21 fulfilled Leviticus 26? 


Is it not true that 2 Chronicles 36:21 does not fit the Society’s Chronology even in the way it 
wants to interpret it? 


Do not Jeremiah 18:7-10 and 42:7-13 prove that the land need never have become desolate 
“in the complete sense”? 


83 


25. 


26. 


27. 


28. 


29. 


Conclusion 


Why does Daniel use the plural of CHORBAH (“devastations”’) if he referred to a period of 
complete desolation over 70 years? Would it not be that he was referring to the successive 
devastations that brought Judah to a state of complete desolation? 


What PROOF is there that Daniel 4 applies to a period of 2520 years of Gentile Domination 
without interference from God’s Kingdom? What principles of interpretation are employed in 
discerning this? 


What authority has the Society to apply the year-day principle to some time prophecies and 
not to others? 


Seeing that the Disciples expected a personal, visible visit by their King, how can their 
question concerning his PAROUSIA be construed to teach an “invisible presence”? 


What significant Sign occurred on or about October Ist to identify it as the end of the “times 
of the Gentiles’? (1.e. in AD 1914.) 


There are countless other problems, as a reading of this volume will have revealed, and there are a lot 
more points that could be raised. 


Jehovah’s Witnesses are acknowledged as having great zeal and I know from personal experience that 
the ordinary Witness is sincerely desirous of serving God. However, if they are teaching what the 
Society says, and this is not true, then they are not witnessing for Jehovah, they are witnessing for the 
Society. They are WATCHTOWER BIBLE & TRACT SOCIETY WITNESSES, not Jehovah’s 
Witnesses. I have stopped witnessing for the Watchtower. 


I bear them witness that they have a zeal for God, but not according to 
accurate knowledge. (Romans 10:2.) 


I have witnessed the zeal and sincerity of “Jehovah’s Witnesses” and I know that this usually applies 
from the local Branch Servant down through the District and Circuit Servants to the common 
Publisher. Whoever it is, or whoever they are, that devise what is supposed to be channelled from God 
cannot be regarded in the same esteem. How can they be, in view of all the evidence? These people 
seem to have engaged in a hate campaign against all those who, after considering the evidence, cannot 
agree with them. Why should they follow the Society? Jesus said, 


If then, a blind man guides a blind man, both will fall into a pit. 
(Matthew 15:14) 


The Society is so obviously wrong, yet its writings are all slanted toward inclining us to believe that 
everyone else is wrong. Testimony proving my assertion is not hard to find. Take as an example The 
Watchtower 15th February, 1959, page 103. 


At the end of the “seven times” about October 1, 1914, the nations of 
Christendom were engaged in the madness and beastliness of World 
War 1. 


By that time the nations that professed to be Christian should have 
lived up to their claim. They should have shown themselves better 
than heathen Nebuchadnezzar and should have made an 
acknowledgment of Jehovah God as the Sovereign of the universe 
and the only rightful Ruler of the earth. 


Ah, but could it be that they did not know that in the fall of 1914 the 
Gentile times or the “appointed times of the nations” had run out? 
No! Rather, they should have known that at the expiring of those 
“times” about October 1, 1914 Jehovah would bring to birth his 
promised kingdom in the heavens by seating his anointed Son, Jesus 
Christ on the throne of the Kingdom to rule in the midst of his 
enemies. 


84 


Conclusion 


They should have known this, not just because the Bible was on hand 
in millions of copies in many languages and because there were 
hundreds of thousands of clergymen paid to explain the Bible; but 
because, since 1877, the anointed remnant Jehovah’s witnesses were 
proclaiming the coming of those things in 1914. 


As this article continues, we reach such statements as, 


Surely, Christendom should have known! ... The worldly rulers 
particularly those of Christendom, are without excuse. They had 
opportunity to learn from God’s widely published Word, the Bible, 
and by means of his Witnesses on earth. 


As I read this Watchtower, I reflect that it was early in 1959 that I first attended the Watchtower 
Study at a “Kingdom Hall” of Jehovah’s Witnesses. Perhaps this Watchtower was one of the first I 
studied. No doubt I then considered the material to be deep and scholarly, as some would consider the 
Babylon Book. 


Now I find it to be rather pitiful. Why should Christendom have known? What the Society teaches 
concerning “the Times of the Gentiles” was not scriptural in 1914 and even though it has changed 
considerably, it is not true now. The false prophets of Jeremiah’s day claimed to be speaking the truth 
on Jehovah’s behalf, but that did not make it so, although they apparently were enjoying a measure of 
success. We as individuals have a responsibility before God NOT TO MISREPRESENT HIM. 


On December 17th, 1962, the Society sent a circular letter to all members of the Clergy and this 
accompanied the booklet, The Word — Who Is He? According to John. The penultimate paragraph 
made the following plea: 


As you are well aware, heavy responsibility falls on those who are 
teachers of the Word of God. Some are inclined to preach things that, 
as the apostle Paul said, would suit the liking of their congregations. 
Others feel themselves bound to the dogmas of their church. But each 
one will have to render an account to the One upon whom the life of 
all creation depends, “the God and Father of our Lord Jesus Christ.” 


No adherent of the Society is exempt from this responsibility. NO ONE should feel bound to the 
dogmas of the Society. This will not excuse anyone, for “each one will have to render an account.” 


I recognise my responsibility to present this exposure to all that I know who need it. May I conclude 
then by again borrowing from the Book of Job 5:27: 


Look! This is what we have investigated. So is it. Hear it, and you — 
know it for yourself. 


85 


APPENDIX A: THE TISHRI CALENDAR 


SI page 280 provides a table “The Year Of The Israelites”. Two years are disclosed, the “Sacred 
Year” beginning in NISAN and the “Secular Year” beginning in TISHRI. Paragraph 19 states, 


According to the ancient Biblical reckoning, the year ran from 
autumn to autumn. This was particularly suited to an agricultural life, 
the year beginning with plowing and sowing about October 1, and 
ending with the gathering in of the harvest. ... To this day, many 
peoples of the earth still start their new year in the autumn. 


At the time of the exodus from Egypt, in 1513 BCE, Jehovah decreed 
that Abib (Nisan) should become “the start of the months” for the 
Jews, so that they now had a “sacred year” running from spring to 
spring. (Ex. 12:2) 


However, the Jews in this day observe a secular or civil year 
beginning in the autumn, Tishri being the first month. (see also The 
Watchtower July 15, 1951 page 447) 


It is recognised by all authorities that the year in early times ran from autumn to autumn. There is the 
obvious requirement at Exodus 12:2 for the Israelites to commence the Months in Nisan. Thus the 
“Sacred Year” was born. 


But this does not even suggest that the old autumn to autumn year did not continue, indeed there is 
very clear evidence that it did. All that is suggested is that the nation now had a year running from 
Nisan to Nisan for the location of Festivals. This fact was recognised in the days of Josephus: 


Moses appointed that Nisan, which is the same with Xanthicus, 
should be the first month for their festivals, because he brought them 
out of Egypt in that month: so that this month began the year as to all 
solemnities they observed to the honour of God, although he 
preserved the original order of the months as to selling and buying, 
and other ordinary affairs. (Antiquities 1:3:3, Whiston’s Translation.) 


The Tishri Calendar was not peculiar to just the Hebrews. 


The Assyrians, like the Jews, had two new year days — Nisan for the 
sacred year, Tishri for the civil. The Seleucidean year began in Nisan, 
the Arsacidan with Tishri. (Epping and Strassmaier, Astronomisches 
aus Babylon, p. 177.). (Hastings Dictionary of the Bible (1902) Vol. 
4, page 765.) 


Jack Fine gan states, on page 92, of Handbook of Biblical Chronology, 


In summary, we find ourselves concerned chiefly with two Jewish 
Years, one beginning in the spring on Nisan 1, one beginning in the 
fall on Tishri 1. Regardless of which year is used, numbering of the 
months is normally in sequence from Nisan. (see also my page 15) 


Some may consider it strange to have a system such as this. However, as David Noel Freedman points 
out on page 226 of The Bible And The Ancient Near East, 


A modern illustration would be the overlapping civil and fiscal 
calendars of the U.S. Government. In practice, a dual calendar poses 
no particular difficulties; the problem for the scholar is to determine 
the calendrical basis of the preserved figures. 


Australians too know that business organisations in this country find no difficulty with a “Financial 
Year” beginning in the 7th Month. 


86 


Appendix A: The Tishri Calendar 


SI page 283 claims that the years of a King “were generally counted from Nisan to Nisan”. The truth 
is that some reigns were counted from Nisan to Nisan while others were reckoned by years 
commencing in Tishri. The Bible does not state which method was used and as Freedman says, the 
problem is to “determine the calendrical basis for the preserved figures.” W F Albright stated on page 
102 of Interpretation January 1952. 


We do not know directly whether the civil year began in the spring 

(Abib and Nisan), like the religious year (at least in certain periods), 

or in the autumn, like the Phoenician Year, the year of the Gezer 

Calendar, and the later Jewish religious year.” (Albright is referred to 

in SI page 86.) 
I repeat, the Bible does not say directly that either one Calendar or the other was used in a specific 
instance but we do have clear evidence that both Calendars existed. As the Society uses only the 
Nisan Calendar for the last days of Judah and has not revealed that Daniel 1:1 and Jeremiah 25:1 and 
46:2 can be reconciled by recognising that Daniel used a Tishri Calendar while Jeremiah used a Nisan 
Calendar, I will provide further evidence for the use of a Tishri Calendar. 


The Gezer Calendar 


W F ALBRIGHT translated the text of a small plaque of soft limestone commonly referred to as “The 
Gezer Calendar” in BASOR 92, December 1943. This plaque is dated to the 10th Century BC. 
Albright considers that the tablet was written on by a schoolboy as a school exercise. The Tablet is 
only approx. 4 inches long and 3 inches wide. 


The Gezer Calendar relates the months to the tasks to be performed in 
the successive phases of agricultural work. (Finegan op. cit. page 17) 


Albright says on page 22 of the above-mentioned article, 


The scribe was almost certainly an Israelite, since the language is 


good Biblical Hebrew. 

The following is Albright’s translation of the text: 
His two months are (olive) harvest; (Sept.-Nov.) 
his two months are grain-planting; (Nov.-Jan.) 
his two months are late planting; (Jan.-March) 
his month is hoeing up of flax; (March-April) 
his month is barley harvest; (April—May) 
his month is (wheat) harvest and 
festivity; (May-June) 
his two months are vine-tending; (June - Aug. ) 
his month is summers-fruit. (Aug.-Sept.) 


It is quite evident that in Palestine in the 10th Century BC, the Calendar began in the fall (Tishri) and 
if we add up the months of the Gezer Calendar, we can see that there were 12 months in the Calendar. 


The Tishri Calendar in Solomon’s Day 


1 Kings 6:1 explains that it was in the 2nd month of the 4th year of Solomon that he proceeded to 
build the Temple. Verse 38 carefully records that it was completed in the 8th month of the 11th year 
of this King, “so that he was seven years at building it”. 


We have already observed that the Hebrews used the “Inclusive” method of reckoning when adding 
numbers, and also that they began the count of their months from Spring, irrespective of which 
Calendar was used (Spring or Fall). 


If the construction began in the 2nd month of a NISAN year (the 4th of Solomon) and ceased in the 
8th month, 7 years later (the 11th year of Solomon), it is obvious that the Temple would have taken 
7 years in building. Inclusively reckoned it would have taken 8 years to build. (See my page 25 
concerning “Inclusive Reckoning”.) 


87 


Appendix A: The Tishri Calendar 


Conversely, if the reckoning was according to the Tishri Calendar, we would have the 2nd month of 
the 4th year of Solomon falling 7 months after the commencement of his year 1. On this same basis, 
the 8th month of his 11th year would fall only 1 month after the year began. (Tishri being the 7th 
month.) Therefore the building project would have taken less than 7 years, but it would have been 
termed 7 years according to the practice of the Hebrews to reckon inclusively. It was not their practice 
to call 7/2 years, 7 years. This would have been termed 8 years. 


When we say Jesus was in the grave from Friday afternoon to Sunday morning, we refer to the period 
involved as 3 days. This is the same method, and we have evidence that the reckoning in 1 Kings 6 
was according to the Tishri Calendar. 


The Society is clearly in error when it states on page 101 of BEF: 


At the end of seven and a half years this costly temple ... was 
completed. 


It is worthy of note that the Gezer Calender and Solomon’s Temple building both belong to the 10th 
Century BC. 


The Tishri Calendar in Josiah’s Day 


Confirmation of reckoning by the fall year is found as late as in the 
eighteenth year of King Josiah. In his eighteenth year (II K 22:3), the 
“book of the law” was found in the house of the Lord (II K 22:8) and 
in the self-same eighteenth year the Passover was celebrated (II K 
23:23). 


The numerous intervening events between the finding of the law book 
and the observance of the Passover could hardly have been 
concentrated within the two weeks between Nisan 1 and Nisan 14 as 
would have been necessary if Josiah’s eighteenth year had only begun 
on Nisan 1; therefore his eighteenth year must have begun the 
preceding Tishri 1. (Finegan op, cite page 201) 


We know that the Passover was celebrated on the 14th day of Nisan. If Josiah’s year began on Nisan 
Ist, the maximum period for all of the events mentioned in 2 Kings 22 and 23 to have been carried out 
would have been 14 days. This was obviously impossible. 


It cannot be disputed then that Josiah’s 18th year began before Nisan Ist, and that Tishri 1st was the 
date. At least 6 months would then be available for the activities referred to. 


It is reasonable to insist that the Tishri Calendar was in use in Josiah’s day. Josiah lived at the same 
time as Nebuchadnezzar’s father, Nabopolassar. 


The Truth Shall Make You Free (see my page 9) states on page 239: 


In Nebuchadnezzar’s time the year began counting from the fall of the 
year, or about October 1, our time. 


The Tishri Calendar in Nehemiah’s Day 
Attention was drawn on my page 13 to the fact that BF page 386 reports that, 


According to Nehemiah’s reckoning of the lunar year, the year began 
with the month Tishri (which Jews today recognize as the beginning 
of their civil year) and ended with the month Elul as the twelfth 
month. 


Although Elul was the 12th month by count, it was referred to as the 6th Month. 


The evidence for the Tishri Calendar in this instance is clearly contained in Nehemiah 1:1 and 2:1. 
Nehemiah refers to events in the month of Chislev in the 20th year of Artaxerxes. Later, he refers to 


88 


Appendix A: The Tishri Calendar 


further events in this same 20th year but this time in the Month of Nisan. If a New Year commenced 
in Nisan, the events would have been in the 21st year of Artaxerxes. 


To those who accept what the Bible says, there is clear indication of use of the Tishri Calendar, for 
Artaxerxes 20th year obviously continued beyond Nisan until Tishri. 


Some are not satisfied with the Bible statement. Hayim Tadmor suggests on page 227 of the Journal 
of Near Eastern Studies X V (1956) 


The discrepancy that Nisan, the first month of the year, is still 
included within year 20 may be explained in several ways. The 
simplest one is that Nehemiah carelessly carried over “Year 20” 
although Nisan was already the beginning of Year 21. A second 
possibility is that the “5S” of the “25” years present in the parallel 
passage in Josephus, Ant. XI. 168, has dropped out. 


If anyone wants to follow the Chronology of Josephus in preference to Nehemiah, they are welcome 
to. The suggestion that Nehemiah made a mistake is not very appealing to a Bible believer either, 
particularly in view of the fact that the Jewish copyists never corrected the error and the translators of 
the Septuagint, who apparently adjusted the Chronology of the Hebrew writers to correspond with 
their own calculations, translated this passage so that it is still in accord with the Hebrew. 


Horn and Wood point out on page 70 of The Chronology Ezra 7 that 


Rudolf Kittel (GESCHICHTE DES VOLKES ISRAEL, Vol. 3, p. 
616) thinks that the words “in the twentieth year” of Neh. 1:1 were 
mistakenly taken over from chapter 2:1. 


See my page 23 where BF page 172 is referred to as citing Kittel as one of the Hebrew scholars who 


propose that the Hebrew text of Daniel 2:1 should be “twelfth year” 
instead of “second year”. 


Kittel obviously has very little respect for the accuracy of the Masoretic text and one would have to be 
very careful before placing any confidence in his advice. 


The Elephantine Papyri 
When referring to the Tishri Calendar, Edwin R Thiele comments: 


The Jewish Aramaic Papyri from Elephantine also provide evidence 
that the same method was employed in Egypt in secondary datings for 
the years of Persian Kings. (BASOR 143, October, 1956.) 


In concluding our brief consideration of some of the evidence for a Tishri calendar, we can consider a 
few points relating to the Elephantine Papyri. 


A discussion of the methods of dating employed on these Papyri is contained in an article by S H 
Horn and L H Wood, “The Fifth-Century Jewish Calendar at Elephantine”, Journal of Near Eastern 
Studies XIII, No. 1 (1954) pp 1 ff. Practically all of this article appears as an Appendix to the book by 
these same authors, The Chronology of Ezra 7. 


The Papyri identified as “Kraeling 6” clearly demands the use of a Tishri Calendar by the Jewish 
Colony on the island of Elephantine in Upper Egypt, who lived at the same time as Nehemiah. 


It is true that Richard A Parker, another expert in these matters, disputes the conclusions of Horn and 
Wood in this matter. He disagrees that a Tishri Calendar is definitely demanded, in his article also 
contained in the Journal of Near Eastern Studies but in Vol. XTV (1955). Nevertheless, Horn and 
Wood could only be wrong if “Kraeling 6” contains a scribal error, and Parker asserts that it does. He 
admits on page 273 of this Journal, 


All that is required to accept their result is the absolute correctness of 
the date as written. 


89 


Appendix A: The Tishri Calendar 


On page 275 he says, 
The year number must be Jewish if no scribal error be present. 


The evidence for the Tishri Calendar is inescapable and there is every justification for the claim that 
Daniel calculated by this Calendar at Daniel 1:1. There is no justification for ignoring this evidence 
and making his 3rd year, his 11th. 


90 


APPENDIX B: PTOLEMY’S CANON 


What is termed “Ptolemy’s Canon” is a list of Kings commencing with Nabonassar, a King of 
Babylon, in 747 BC. It continues to the end of the Neo (New) Babylonian Empire, listing the 
Babylonian Kings, followed by the Persian Kings until that Empire was overthrown by Greece. 


The name of Alexander the Great then appears, followed by the Ptolemaic Rulers of Egypt. Finally, 
the Roman Rulers are recorded, bringing the list down to the 2nd Century AD, to the day of its 
compiler, Claudius Ptolemy, who lived in Alexandria. 


Ptolemy is famous as a geographer, a mathematician and as an astronomer. Because of his writings on 
Astronomy, he compiled his Canon of Kings and later gained fame as a chronologist. His most 
famous work on Astronomy is best known by its title in Arabic, the “Almagest”. 


The Almagest contains a considerable amount of information on the motions of the moon and planets, 
and in order to demonstrate his theories on these motions, Ptolemy compared various Eclipses, 
Planetary positions, etc., of his day with those recorded by the ancients. 


It is obvious that for the consideration of motions, the time period that lapsed between the various 
positions of heavenly bodies he referred to, was of vital importance. For example, A History of 
Astronomy by A Pannekoek (1951) page 151, says concerning Ptolemy, 


To find the return to the apogee (the “anamolistic period”), he made 
use of three Babylonian eclipses from 721 and 720 BC, and compared 
them with three observed by himself in AD 133, 134 and 136. 


Page 155 contains further observations by Pannekoek on Ptolemy’s motives. 


He took two lunar eclipses observed at Babylon, so chosen that the 
moon was at its greatest distance from the earth. One was the eclipse 
of April 22, 621 BC, one-fourth of the moon’s diameter was eclipsed; 
computation showed the moon to be at a distance ... At the other 
eclipse, July 16, 523 BC, half its diameter was eclipsed and with a 
distance ... (etc) 


Historians today locate the date of the Astronomical data referred to by Ptolemy as so many years 
“BC” e.g., April 22, 621 BC. Ptolemy, to accomplish his purpose of indicating the interval between 
observations, provided his list of Kings. As the Canon commenced with Nabonassar in 747 BC, 
Ptolemy, when listing subsequent Kings, gave not only the number of years of their reign, but also the 
number of years since 747 BC, or the first of Nabonassar and this is termed the “Nabonassar Era”. 


The following is a list of the Kings of the Neo Babylonian Empire from Nabopolassar to Nabonidus 
and then Cyrus and Cambyses of the Persian Empire, as listed by Ptolemy: 


Nabopolassar __ reigned 21 years 123-143 years of Nabonassar Era 
Nebuchadnezzar 43 years 144-186 years of Nabonassar Era 
Amel-Marduk 2 years 187-188 years of Nabonassar Era 
Nergal-shar-usur 4 years 189-192 years of Nabonassar Era 
Nabonidus 17 years 193-209 years of Nabonassar Era 
Cyrus 9 years 210-218 years of Nabonassar Era 
Cambyses 8 years 219-226 years of Nabonassar Era 


The Encyclopaedia Britannica (1962) Vol. 2 page 574 states, 


The Greek astronomer Ptolemy says that Mesopotamian records of 

eclipses were available from a date expressed as 747 BC. 
The value of the Canon for historical purposes is very simply expressed by E R Thiele on page 46 of 
The Mysterious Numbers of the Hebrew Kings. 


What makes the canon of such great importance is the large amount 
of astronomical material recorded by Ptolemy in his Almagest, 


91 


Appendix B: Ptolemy’s Canon 


making possible checks as to its accuracy at almost every step from 
beginning to end. 


Over eighty solar, lunar, and planetary positions, with their dates, are 
recorded in the Almagest which have been verified by modern 
astronomers. The details concerning eclipses are given with such 
minuteness as to leave no question concerning the exact identification 
of the particular phenomenon referred to, and making possible the 
most positive verification. 


Horn and Wood provide further information of value on pages 43, 44 of The Chronology of Ezra 7: 


As to the possibility of confusing any of these eclipses with others 
occurring on the same date of different years, it is to be noted that a 
lunar eclipse come only at full moon. A full moon can occur on the 
same date in our calendar only every 19 years but can recur in the 
Egyptian calendar, which shifts backward through the seasons only 
about every 25 years. ... Besides, not all full moons can be eclipsed; 
this can take place only about twice a year. Therefore the possibility 
of a lunar eclipse recurring on the same Egyptian date is reduced still 
more. 


Further, Ptolemy’s 19 eclipses, dated by year, day, and even hour, are 
all in mutual agreement, and various astronomers who have 
calculated these eclipses by modern methods have all agreed on their 
dates, varying only slightly as to the hour. Oppolzer’s tables of lunar 
eclipses show that the average variance between his computations and 
Ptolemy’s statements is about ten minutes. 


For other comments on the accuracy of the eclipse records, etc, see the “Appendix: Absolute Dates”. 


The eclipses recorded by Ptolemy for the period we are concerned with took place on 22nd April, 621 
BC, in the 5th year of Nabopolassar (the father of Nebuchadnezzar) and 16th July, 523 BC, the 7th 
year of Cambyses (the son of Cyrus). 


It is of great interest to note that what was probably the original record of this last mentioned eclipse 
has been discovered on a clay tablet. The following is quoted from page 26 of New Light On The 
Bible and the Holy Land (1892) by Basil T A Evetts, M.A. 


Ptolemy says, “In the seventh year of Cambyses, which is the two 
hundred and twenty-fifth year of Nabonassar, in the Egyptian month 
of Phamenoth, in the night of the seventeenth-eighteenth, one hour 
before midnight, according to the hour of Babylon, the moon was 
eclipsed, beginning by the north, to the half of her diameter”. 


In the cuneiform text inscribed upon the clay tablet from Babylonia 
we read: “In the year seven (of Cambyses), in the night of Tammuz 
the fourteenth, three hours and one third after nightfall, there was an 
eclipse of the moon. At its maximum, half of the diameter 
disappeared, beginning by the north”. 


The two statements fully agree and Ptolemy, or rather, Hipparchus, 
from whom he derived his knowledge of Babylonian astronomy, 
probably borrowed his record of this eclipse from the very cuneiform 
text, a copy of which is now in the British Museum. 


See also Olmstead, History of the Persian Empire page 202. 


Absolute proof is available then that Ptolemy provided correct details of ancient astronomical 
observations, despite the fact that his “system of astronomy has long since been exploded”. (cf. BF 
page 138 and my page 47 ff.) 


92 


Appendix B: Ptolemy’s Canon 


Note that Ptolemy used the Egyptian Calendar for the seventh year of Cambyses (“Egyptian month of 
Phamenoth”). He consistently used this calendar when referring to the Kings, irrespective of the 
system employed in the country concerned. There is no problem in converting dates given in an 
Egyptian year to our own because the Egyptians consistently used a year of 365 days. It therefore falls 
a day behind the Julian Calendar (which is used for BC dating) every four years. 


If we look to “Ptolemy’s Canon” for the name of a King who reigned less than a year we will be 
disappointed. Remember that Ptolemy’s purpose was to have a means of identifying years or dates in 
the past. A King who reigned for only part of a year would not serve this purpose. The few months he 
may have reigned would be counted in the years of his predecessor. There are 10 Kings who reigned 
less than a year whose names have been omitted from the Canon. (See Hales A New Analysis of 
Chronology Vol. 1 page 172.) 


We can be confident that what James B. Lindsay said in his Chronoastrolabe (1858) concerning 
Ptolemy’s Canon is true, “‘a foundation is laid for chronology sure as the stars.” 


93 


APPENDIX C: ABSOLUTE DATES 


Reference to the Watch Tower Publications Index 1930-1960 directs us to three Watchtower 
magazines providing information on “Absolute Dates”. These were printed in the years 1952, 1955 
and 1959. The Watchtower referred to for the year 1959 discusses the 15th year of Tiberius Caesar 
and therefore there is no need to concern ourselves with it here. 


The Index for each of the years 1961 and 1962 provide no references to “Absolute Dates”. For the 
year 1963, attention is drawn to SI pages 85, 281-2, 284-285, 335 and the Report on “Everlasting 


Good News” Assembly of Jehovah’s Witnesses page 56. 


So that we can appreciate what the term “Absolute Date” means to the Society, I will quote from the 
sections mentioned and offer brief comments after each quotation. 


The Watchtower May 1, 1952, page 271. 


Almost all early Bible chronology ties in with secular history at the 
year 539 BC, in which year the fall of Babylon to Darius and Cyrus of 
the Medes and the Persians occurred. In late years, several cuneiform 
tablets have been discovered pertaining to the fall of Babylon which 
peg both Biblical and secular historic dates. 


The one tablet known as the “Nabunaid Chronicle” gives the date for 
the fall of Babylon, which specialists have ascertained as being 
October 12-13, 539 BC, Julian Calendar, or October 6-7, 539 BC, 
according to our present Gregorian Calendar. [History of the Persian 
Empire, by Olmstead, 1948, p. 50; also Light From The Ancient Past, 
by Finegan, 1946. p. 190]. This tablet also says that Cyrus made his 
triumphant entry into Babylon 16 days after its fall to his army. Thus 
his accession year commenced in October, 539 BC. 


However, in another cuneiform tablet called “Strassmaier, Cyrus No. 
11”, Cyrus’ first regnal year is mentioned and was determined to have 
begun March 17-18, 538 BC, and to have concluded March 4-5, 537 
BC. It was in this first regnal year of Cyrus that he issued his decree 
to permit the Jews to return to Jerusalem to rebuild the temple. (Ezra 
1:1) The decree may have been made in late 538 BC or before March 
4-5, 537 B.C. [Babylonian Chronology 626 BC-AD 45, by Parker and 
Dubberstein, 1942, pp. 11, 27.) 


At this stage I consider it necessary to draw attention to the fact that the Society does not provide 
information anywhere as to HOW the date in 539 BC is calculated. It merely refers to the tablets of 
the Babylonians and to authorities who calculate the date. I cannot see how we can interpret their 
method otherwise than to assume that they recommend these authorities to us as completely 
authoritative on dates. 


The puzzling situation that arises is that these very same authorities, using the very same methods and 
the very same type of material, produce other dates which conflict entirely with the Society’s 
Chronology. The old question comes up, “How can we accept one of these dates as reliable and not 
the others?” 


For example, the figure specialists Parker and Dubberstein on page 12 of Babylonian Chronology 626 
BC-AD 75 (the latest edition of their work) give evidence for the beginning of Nebuchadnezzar’s 
reign in 605 BC, and consequently for the Battle of Carchemish (Jeremiah 46:2). The tablets referred 
to also “peg both Biblical and secular historic dates”. Several tablets are utilised, one being the 
Babylonian Chronicle and one other being BM92472 Strassmaier, Nabuchodonosor, No. 2. 


Strassmaier was a Catholic Priest who spent a tremendous amount of time copying cuneiform tablets. 
So on each hand we have the Chronicle and details of a tablet, the text being provided by Strassmaier. 


94 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


The same figure specialists determine the date but the Society will only accept the 539 BC date. This 
they say is accurate because these figure specialists are authoritative on these matters. The other dates 
are not accepted because it conflicts with their arrangement and so the tablets used for calculating 
these dates are branded as “incomplete or inaccurate secular accounts”. (Awake March 22, 1960, page 
7). The figure specialists are no longer accurate but are regarded like those 


Chronologers in Christendom (who) throw their time schedule of 
history at least nineteen years out of order. ...They do this because of 
trying to harmonize the Bible records with the astronomical Canon of 
Claudius Ptolemy. (BF page 138) 


What a contrast! There is nothing more incomplete or inaccurate about the tablets related to 605 BC 
than there is about those related to 539 BC. 


On my page 47 I drew attention to the fact that on page 10 of their work, Parker and Dubberstein say, 


The general basis for the chronology of the period here treated is 
furnished by the Ptolemaic Canon, with help from classical sources. 


The ordinary Witness is unfortunately led to believe that “Ptolemy’s Canon” is not necessary for the 
calculation of 539 BC. He reads statements such as that already quoted which casts reflections upon 
the accuracy of ““Ptolemy’s Canon” and also those such as the following quoted from The Watchtower 
February 1, 1955, page 94 (which is the next reference we come to in the Watchtower Index): 


The outstanding Absolute date for the BC period of the Hebrew 
Scriptures is that for the fall of Babylon as the capital city of the third 
world power at the hands of Cyrus, king of the Persians, October 13, 
539 BC, Julian calendar (or October 7 by our present Gregorian 
calendar), which event is referred to at Isaiah 45:1. This date is made 
Absolute by reason of the archaeological discovery and deciphering 
of the famous Nabunaid Chronicle, which itself gives a date for the 
fall of Babylon and which figure specialists have determined equals 
October 13, 539 BC, according to the Julian calendar of the Romans. 
[Babylonian Chronology 626 B.C.—A.D. 45, by Parker and 
Dubberstein, 1942, p. 11.] (emphases are supplied) 


The figure specialists again are found to be Parker and Dubberstein. Note that the writer is cautious 
enough to say that this is the “outstanding Absolute date”, NOT the only one. It could not be the 
“outstanding” one if there were not others. The only reason why it is “outstanding” is because it is the 
ONE used by the Society. 


The ordinary Witness, when reading this statement, would think that the Nabunaid Chronicle itself 
gives the date 539 BC. Several have told me that this is what they understood. The truth is that it gives 
no such thing. How could it? The Babylonians knew nothing about the Christian Era. What the tablet 
does say is disclosed in part on page 335 of SI. 


In the month of Tashritu (Tishri, Hebrew 7th month), when Cyrus 
attacked the army of Akkad in Opis on the Tigris ... the 15th day, 
Sippar was seized without battle. Nabonidus fled. The 16th day 
(October 11-12, 539 BCE Julian or October 5-6 Gregorian) Gobryas 
(Ugbaru), the governor of Gutium and the army of Cyrus entered 
Babylon without battle. 


Obviously the tablet only provided the date, the 16th of Tashritu for the fall of Babylon to the figure 
specialists. 


How then is the year determined by them? Please note the quotation from their work page 10 just 
mentioned on my page 95. It is all very simple, the tablet relates to the last year of Nabonidus, which 
was his 17th. According to “Ptolemy’s Canon”, this 17th year was 539 BC. (see “Appendix B: 
Ptolemy’s Canon”.) 


95 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


On page 13 of their book on Babylonian Chronology, Parker and Dubberstein give as evidence for the 
last year of Nabonidus, being 539 BC, the “Nabonidus Chronicle.” Several other tablets are referred 
to, one being published by Strassmaier. Parker and Dubberstein obtained the year (539 BC) of course 
from Ptolemy’s Canon. 


Perhaps I should elaborate a little here for the year 539 BC can be, and has been calculated without 
reference to “Ptolemy’s Canon” at this point. It would help if I explained how Parker and 
Dubberstein’s work on the cuneiform tablets has been arranged and so what follows is a brief report 
on this. 


Cuneiform Tablets 


The dates of the new moon in ancient Babylon can be calculated astronomically. A new moon of 
course meant a new month. Therefore, tables can be compiled of the months of the Babylonian years. 
For our convenience, the years can be identified in terms we understand, so many years before the 
Christian Era. (There are various problems involved such as the identification of the years containing 
embolismic months, but these can usually be identified from information contained on the tablets 
themselves. We do not need to go into all that here.) 


We have already noted (cf my page 48) that it has been established that the 5th year of Nabopolassar 
was 621 BC, because of the Eclipse mentioned by Ptolemy. (See also “Appendix B: Ptolemy’s 
Canon’”.) Here we have a definite anchor point from which to work, but how can we move from here? 


Encyclopaedia Britannica (1961) Vol. 5, page 655 informs, 


There are two sources for the Chronology of the New Babylonian and 
Persian Empires, the canon of the Greek historian Ptolemy, and the 
reckoning which can be traced almost month by month and day by 
day; the tablets give names of rebels against Persian kings (etc.). 


And so our attention is drawn to the Cuneiform tablets as a source for Babylonian Chronology. 
“Strassmaier, Cyrus No. 11” is just one of the thousands of tablets available for this purpose. 


Parker and Dubberstein have listed the various Kings in the order given by Ptolemy and summarised 
their reigns by reference to tablets dated earliest and latest in each reign. This is not always possible 
later in the Persian period as when Papyrus became more popular for recording purposes fewer clay 
tablets are available. Nevertheless, this does not apply in the period from Nabopolassar to Cambyses, 
these years are fully checked by the clay tablets. The practice was to date business documents on a 
certain date in the particular year of whoever was the King. For example: 


Cause ... iron implements (and) 80 KUDUTUM to be taken to 
Nergal-sarra-usur by the hands of Nabu-sum-iddina, secretary of 
Nergal-sarra-usur. Month lyyar, day 12th, year 43rd, Nabu-rudurri- 
usur king of Babylon. (The Old Testament in the Light of the 


Historical Records of Assyria and Babylonia by T G Pinches, page 
440. 


This tablet is one of the many that prove that Nebuchadnezzar reigned for 43 years. It is not used by 
Parker and Dubberstein as there are three tablets dated approx. 6 months later in Nebuchadnezzar’s 
43rd year. The very latest tablets of his reign and the very earliest of his successors help to establish to 
within a few days when he died. Parker and Dubberstein state on their page 12, 


The first tablet dated to Amel-Marduk (see below) comes from 
Sippar(?) and is dated on the same day as the last tablet of 
Nebuchadnezzar from Uruk. Accordingly, Nebuchadnezzar died 
during the first days of October, 562. 


The Society doesn’t accept the date here mentioned. I have used Nebuchadnezzar as an example. By 
following this process, Parker and Dubberstein have summarised the evidence of the cuneiform 
tablets and an examination of the results obtained reveals that they agree exactly with “Ptolemy’s 
Canon”. 


96 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


There are literally thousands of these tablets and they provide no evidence whatsoever for a gap of at 
least 19 years between the reigns of the Babylonian Kings somewhere. This gap between the 
Society’s Chronology and every other piece of evidence would have to be accounted for somehow if 
the Society’s Chronology was correct. What a strange situation! (Or is it?) 


Calculation from 621 BC (the date provided by the eclipse record) by adding the years of the 
Babylonian Kings brings us to 539 BC as the last year of Nabonidus and for the fall of Babylon. We 
have Nabopolassar’s reign positively located by the eclipse and we know that he died in 605 BC 
because of the statements of the Babylonian Chronicle, and because the clay tablets substantiate that 
he reigned for 21 years. Therefore we could calculate from 605 BC. 


Cambridge Ancient History page 224 (I think it was Vol. 2) states, 


The date 539 for the Fall of Babylon has been reckoned from the 
latest dates on the contracts of each king in this period, counting from 
the end of Nabopolassar’s reign in 605 BC, viz. Nebuchadnezzar 43: 
Amel Marduk 2: Nergal-shar-usar 4: Labashi-Marduk (accession 
only): Nabonidus 17 = 66. 


Please observe that once again we have conclusive evidence that although Ptolemy’s “system of 
astronomy has long since been exploded”, his Canon of Kings is still accurate. (cf. BF page 138) 


Our next reference to the Society’s “Absolute Date” is found in SI page 85. 


This date 539 BCE is an absolute date, that is, a date fixed, proved 
and accepted by secular history. 


Just prior to this statement several quotations are provided from authorities that mention this date. The 
Society’s definition of an “Absolute Date” is a correct one but there are other dates such as 605 BC 
for the Battle of Carchemish and the accession of Nebuchadnezzar, and 597 BC for the capture of 
Jerusalem under Jehoiachin, which are “proved and accepted by secular history”. Furthermore, they 
are accepted by the very same authorities that the Society refers to as mentioning 539 BC. Werner 
Keller is one of these. On pages 272 and 273 of the London edition of his The Bible as History he 
provides the dates 605 BC and 597 BC for the events I have mentioned. If we are to be influenced by 
his providing 539 BC, why shouldn’t we also be influenced by his providing 605 BC and 597 BC as 
dates for Bible events? 


SI pages 281 and 282 add nothing to our knowledge of “Absolute Dates”. We are merely informed 
that, 


An absolute date is a calendar date that is proved by secular history to 
be the actual date of an event recorded in the Bible. 


605 BC and 597 BC contain dates of events “recorded in the Bible”, but the Society refuses to accept 
them. Our attention is directed this time only to the “Nabonidus Chronicle” and again to Parker and 
Dubberstein as the “Modern authorities.” We recall that they are not considered as authoritative by the 
Society for dates that contradict their arrangement. SI page 284 claims under the heading “Counting 
Back To Adam’s Creation” that 


The absolute date for this calculation is that of Cyrus’ overthrow of 
the Babylonian dynasty 539 BCE. 


Why is this the “absolute date”? Why not another further back in time? (Proof was given on my pages 
60 to 62 that it is not reasonable to claim to be able to count the years back to Adam.) 


SI page 285 does not appear to contain any information on the subject and SI page 335 contains the 
portion of the text of the Nabonidus Chronicle which we have already considered. 


Finally, we have for consideration the item on page 56 of the Report on ‘Everlasting Good News’ 
Assembly of Jehovah’s Witnesses. Brief mention of a visit to the British Museum is made. 


97 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


Of special interest to the conventioners was the Nabonidus Chronicle, 
which the Museum authorities placed on show just for the period of 
the “Everlasting Good News” Assembly. Because this chronicle helps 
date the fall of Babylon in the year 539 BC it is of great importance, 
and most of the Witnesses saw it here for the first time. 


No doubt the Society asked for the Nabonidus Chronicle to be put on display. What a pity it did not 
ask for the Nebuchadnezzar Chronicle to be also displayed, for this chronicle is also of “great 
importance” as it helps date the Battle of Carchemish, Nebuchadnezzar’s accession date, the capture 
of Jerusalem under Jehoiachin etc. 


It is also contained in the British Museum and I am sure that not only would it have been the first time 
most of the Witnesses had seen it, I would venture to say that it would have been the first they had 
ever even heard of it. They do however hear and read plenty about the Nabonidus Chronicle. 


In our consideration of the Society’s definition of an “Absolute Date”, we have found nothing 
incompatible with the definition that might be provided by anyone else. We have noted however that 
they have chosen only one date for the Hebrew Scriptures and ignore the others. The Watchtower 
February 1, 1955, page 95 stresses that, 


It is well to understand that all Bible chronology dates for events prior 
to 539 BC must be figured backward from the Absolute date of 539 
BC. 


When we do “understand” this matter of “Absolute Dates” it is not well for the Society for such a 
practice is NOT necessary at all. The Society is forced into adopting such a false procedure in order to 
protect its Chronology. It will make no endeavour to make clear why the “Absolute Dates” 605 BC 
and 597 BC should be ignored in favour of 539 BC. Could it be that it just happens to suit the Society 
this way? 


On my page 6, I referred to Pastor Russell who advised that Bible History does not cover the period 
from 539 BC down to the Christian Era. Therefore, whether we like it or not, we must rely on the 
Pagan Nations to provide us dates. 


In order to ascertain whether this information can be relied upon (surely this must be admitted already 
for the period we are investigating), I will provide further information on the sources available for the 
Chronology of the Babylonian Kings. In doing so, I will again draw attention to a suggestion made by 
the Society and upon which I am sure every adherent of the Society will wish to ponder. The 
Watchtower July 15, 1922, page 217: 


When a date is indicated by several lines of evidence it is strongly 
established. The scientific law of probabilities imparts a united 
strength to the strands of the cable of chronology far greater than the 
sum of the individual lines of evidence. This is a law which is 
implicitly relied upon in important affairs: viz., that when a thing is 
indicated in only one way it may be by chance; if it is indicated in two 
ways, it is almost certain to be true; and if in more than two ways, it is 
usually impossible that it is by chance, or that it is not true; and the 
addition of more proofs removes it entirely from the realm of chance 
into that of proven certainty. 


I believe in this principle. Without any reservations, I state that this principle, when applied to the 
sources that establish the Chronology for the period under review, shows that this Chronology is 
proved beyond question. The evidence is so varied and inextricably bound together, that it is not even 
possible for it to be wrong. 


98 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


The sources we have examined so far for the period are: 


1. Ptolemy’s Canon (see “Appendix B: Ptolemy’s Canon”). 


2. The Cuneiform Tablets which certify the number of years shown by Ptolemy, from 
Nabopolassar to Cambyses, to be absolutely correct. 


The next source (#3) that I wish to draw attention to is Berosus, the Babylonian. 


Berosus 


The Society puts forward the record of Berosus as preserved by Josephus to substantiate a point 
concerning the 70 years on pages 164 and 165 of BF. The section quoted is identified in Whiston’s 
Translation as Against Apion 1:19. The Society will probably never make public why it will not 
accept Josephus’ quotation from Berosus, Against Apion 1:20: 


Berosus ... says in his third book: ““Nabuchodonosor, after he had 
begun to build the fore-mentioned wall, fell sick, and departed this 
life, when he had reigned forty-three years; whereupon his son Evil- 
merodach obtained the kingdom. He governed public affairs after an 
illegal and impure manner, and had a plot laid against him by 
Neriglissoor, his sister’s husband and was slain by him when he had 
reigned but two years. 


After he was slain, Neriglissoor, the person who plotted against him, 
succeeded him in the kingdom, and reigned four years; his son 
Laborosoarchod obtained the kingdom, though he was but a child, 
and kept it nine months; but by reason of the very ill-temper and ill 
practices he exhibited to the world, a plot was laid against him also by 
his friends, and he was tormented to death. After his death, the 
conspirators got together, and by common consent put the crown 
upon the head of Nabonnedus, a man of Babylon ... when he was 
come to the seventeenth year of his reign, Cyrus came out of Persia 
with a great army; and having already conquered all the rest of Asia, 
he came hastily to Babylonia. (etc.).” 


A summary of the Chronology Berosus provides is a duplicate of “Ptolemy’s Canon”. 


Nabuchodonosor reigned 43 years 
Evilmerodach reigned 2 years 
Neriglissor reigned 4 years 
Laborosoarchod reigned 9 months 
Nabonnedus reigned 17 years. 


Ptolemy does not mention Laborosoarchod because, as has already been observed, a reign of less than 
a year was of no use in counting years. (see my page 93). Speaking of the Canon of Ptolemy, Robert 
William Rogers comments on page 333 of Vol 1 History of Babylonia and Assyria (1902), 


It begins with Nabonassar and extends to Alexander the Great. It was 
plainly made for astronomical and not for historical purposes, and 
therefore only contains the names of those kings who began to reign 
with the beginning of a year and continued to its end. Kings who 
came to the throne after the beginning of the year and reigned but a 
few months are not named at all. 


Berosus was a Babylonian of the 3rd Century BC (see BF page 164). It would obviously be a mistake 
to accuse him of being one of the “chronologers in Christendom” who try to “harmonize the Bible 
records with the astronomical Canon of Claudius Ptolemy”. How could Berosus try and harmonize 
anything with Ptolemy seeing that Berosus lived several hundred years before him? Yet there is 
complete harmony between his list of Babylonian Kings and that of Ptolemy. 


99 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


The next source (#4) that I wish to draw attention to is the Adda-guppi Stelae 


The Adda-guppi Stelae 


Basil T A.Evetts provides on page 310 of his New Light on the Bible and the Holy Land (1892), a 
portion of the text of the Nabonidus Chronicle for the 9th year of Nabonidus, 


On the fifth of Nisan, the king’s mother died in the town of 
Durkarashu, on the banks of the Euphrates, above Sippara. 


BE page 184 reports that 


[Nabonidus] is reported to have been the son of a priestess of the 
moon at Harran. 


At Harran, in 1956, Dr. D S Rice discovered three basalt stelae. The translation of the inscriptions on 
these was published in 1958 by Dr. C J Gadd (Anatolian Studies Vol. VII, pages 35ff.) Two of these 
inscriptions relate to the last king of Babylon, Nabonidus, and one to his mother, the lady Adda- 
guppi. It is worth noting this inscription for it provides details confirming the Chronology of the 
Chaldean dynasty. The inscription is identified as H1.B. 


There is no doubt that Adda- guppi was a “priestess of the moon at Harran’”, for the inscription says 
she was. As far as Iam aware, the Society could only have made this observation from knowledge 
gained from this text. To me at least, this is very interesting. (See also my page 51.) 


The following are a few lines from the Stelae as translated by Gadd. The numbers at the 
commencement of each line are not in the text, but this is the usual way of identifying the lines of 
inscriptions. 


1. I (am) the lady Adda-guppi! mother 

2. of Nabium-na’id, king of Babylon ... 
29. From the 20th year of Assurbanipal, king of Assyria, that I was born (in) 
30. until the 42nd year of Assurbanipal, the 3rd year of Assur-etillu-il?’, 
31. his son, the 21st year of Nabopolassar, the 43rd year of Nebuchadnezzar 
32. the 2nd year of Awel-Marduk, the 4th year of Neriglissar, 
33. in 95 years of the god Sin, king of the gods of heaven and earth. 


The quotation just given was from column 1. What follows is quoted from column 2: 


26. From the time of Assurbanipal, king of Assyria, until the 9th year 

27. of Nabu-na’id king of Babylon, the son, offspring of my womb 

28. 104 year of happiness, with the reverence which Sin, king of the gods 
29. placed in me, he made me flourish, my own self. 


(NB. Sin was the Moon God). 
An arithmetical summary covering the Kings mentioned is as follows: 


Col. 1, lines 29-35 Adda-guppi was born in the 20th year of Assurbanipal and lived beyond his 42nd 
year. Therefore: 


20th to 42nd year of Assurbanipal = 22 years 
Reign of Assur-etilluili = 3 years 
Nabopolassar = 21 years 
Nebuchadrezzar = 43 years 
Evil-Merodach = 2 years 
Neriglissar = 4 years 


Line 33 says this totals 95 years 
Col II line 26 takes us down to the 9th year of Nabonidus _9 years 
Line 28 provides the total as 104 years _ 104 years 


100 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


The 9th year of Nabunaid agrees with the Nabonidus Chronicle, for this was the year in which Adda- 
guppi died at the ripe old age of 104 years. 


Adda- guppi, like Ptolemy, does not mention the short reign of Labashi-Marduk, who reigned only for 
a couple of months between Neriglissar and Nabonidus. The point is again that a reign of only a 
couple of months was of no value in counting a number of years. 


Seeing that the length of these Kings’ reigns are tied into 104 years, there is no possibility of gaps 
existing between the Kings. Again we have perfect agreement between “Ptolemy’s Canon”, Berosus, 
the summary of details calculated from the Babylonian business documents presented by Parker and 
Dubberstein and now the evidence provided by the Adda-guppi Stelae. 


Did Adda-Gupp make the mistake of following Ptolemy too? Hardly, she was living at the same time 
as the Chaldean Kings. Ptolemy’s Astronomy was erroneous but not his Canon of Kings. 


Two years after this Inscription was published, the Society branded the records that prove its 
Chronology to be in error, “incomplete or inaccurate secular accounts” Awake March 22, 1960, page 
7. 


What is incomplete or inaccurate about these records? Remember that the principle suggested by the 
Society requires that if a date is suggested “in more than two ways, it is usually impossible that it is by 
chance or that it is not true; and the addition of more proofs removes it entirely from the realm of 
chance into that of proven certainty.” 


We have complied with all of these requirements. So far, we have produced four lines of evidence 
which positively substantiate each other. If the evidence produced is not sufficient to convince that the 
Society is wrong, nothing will. 


We have proved that “Ptolemy’s Canon” for the period between Nabopolassar and Cyrus is in the 
realm of “proven certainty.” The only item that conflicts is the Society’s Chronology and this has 
been exposed as in error in countless ways. 


On my page 49, I dealt briefly with Astronomical Evidence. I shall now pass on to provide a few 
further details on this interesting subject, which provides a further strong link in our chain of 
Chronology. Before doing so though, I want to stress that while I have only been concerned to prove 
the Chronology for the Babylonian Kings, the Chronology for the Assyrian Kings before them is also 
quite accurate. 


Encyclopedia Americana (1963) Vol. 6, page 640 reports concerning Assyrian Chronology. 


This is founded upon abundant sources of information which are for 
the most part corroborative. As a result, the period from 911 to 626 
BC is established with possible discrepancies amounting to one year 
in some reigns. From 911 to 1068 BC, the margin of error may be as 
much as ten years, and beyond the latter date the possibility of error 
increases. 


The next source (#5) that I wish to draw attention to is Astronomical Evidence. 
Astronomical Evidence 
(See also my page 49) 


After commenting on eclipses of the Sun mentioned in Assyrian Tablets and eclipses of the Moon 
recorded by Ptolemy, Samuel Alfred Mitchell in his Eclipses of the Sun (1951) stated: 


These eclipses of sun and moon fix the dates of Eastern chronology 
with great exactness. 


H. Grattan Guinness, Light for the Last Days (1888) page 37: 


When we reach the chronological question, we enter a region where 
there is much less room for opinion or for difference of judgement, as 


101 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


the results depend on astronomically verified data, and exact 
arithmetical calculation. 


Chronology of the Times of Daniel, Ezra and Nehemiah (1848) by James Whatman Bosanquet: 


Concerning Ptolemy’s Canon, Dr. Prideaux has observed, “The truth 
of it may at any time be demonstrated by astronomical calculations, 
and no one has ever calculated those eclipses, that hath not found 
them fall right in the times where placed; and therefore, this being the 
surest guide which we have in the chronology”. 


Referring to the reigns of Cambyses and Darius Hystaspis, Sir Isaac Newton acknowledged in his 
book Observations Upon the Prophecies of Daniel: 


The reigns of these two kings are determined by three eclipses of the 
moon observed at Babylon, and recorded by Ptolemy; so that it 
cannot be disputed. 


Newton died in 1727 AD. These statements have been provided in order to indicate how, over the 
years, men who have been experts in the fields of Astronomy and Mathematics have realised the 
exactness that Astronomical evidence gives to Chronology. Quotations such as these could be 
multiplied many times, but these span several centuries and are sufficient. 


All Christians know that our God has in the heavens a masterpiece of precision, and Mathematicians, 
whether they are Christian or not, admit this also, for they are able to calculate with great exactness 
the position of the Planets for thousands of years either forward or backwards. 


The Babylonians slowly realised that Eclipses etc. occurred at frequent intervals and they called the 
interval between the beginning and the end of a series of Eclipses, which takes approx. 18 years and 
11 days, a “Saros”. 


Hugh Godfrey has some comments of interest on the “Saros” in his A Treatise on Astronomy (1934) 
page 250, 


This method is still used to determine at what new-moons, or full- 
moons, eclipses will occur — the strictly accurate modern methods 
being afterwards employed to calculate the character and details. 


From what has been stated in the previous articles, we infer that when 
the sun, the moon, and the node return to the same relative positions, 
the same eclipses may recur. ... If, therefore, during one of these 
cycles of 18 years 11 days, a record be made of all the eclipses which 
occur, they will be found approximately to repeat themselves. This 
period was known to the Chaldeans and called Saros. 


O Neugebauer wrote in The Exact Sciences in Antiquity (1962 Edition) page 101: 


Around 700 BC, under the Assyrian empire, we meet with systematic 
observational reports of astronomers to the court. ... We should recall 
here Ptolemy’s statements that eclipse records were available to him 
from the time of Nabonassar (747 BC) onwards. 


On my page 49 I drew attention to the Society’s acceptance of the Canon der Finsternisse by T R 
Oppolzer (Dover edition in English) which provides calculation of the dates of eclipses away back to 
1207 BC. The Ancients recorded them, the Moderns can identify them. 


+} 


The Interpreter’s Dictionary of the Bible (1962) Vol. 1 page 585 says concerning “Ptolemy’s Canon”: 


The Canon of Ptolemy, though coming from the second century AD, 
records the reigns of Babylonian kings back to Nabonassar in 747 
BC, as well as the reigns of later Persian, Ptolemaic, and Roman 
rulers. Its accuracy has been established by Ptolemy’s mention in 
another writing of numerous solar, lunar, and planetary positions, 


102 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


including eclipses, all dated in the reigns of the various kings 
mentioned in his canon. In every case, astronomers have confirmed 
these dates exactly. 


In the “Appendix B: Ptolemy’s Canon”, I drew attention to the tablet which provides details of the 
same eclipse recorded by Ptolemy for the 7th year of Cambyses. Cambyses was the son of Cyrus (see 
BE page 188) and as this eclipse took place in the 7th year of Cambyses (16th July, 523 BC) his first 
year must have been 529 BC. According to the Cuneiform tablets, Cyrus reigned as King over 
Babylon for 9 years (see BF page 365). His first year was then 538 BC. His accession year according 
to these tablets was therefore 539 BC. (Remember that the Jews did not necessarily date from this 
year.) 


Similar comments on the relationship of Nabopolassar and Nebuchadnezzar have already been 
offered. Ptolemy recorded an eclipse in 621 BC, the 5th year of Nabopolassar. The Babylonian 
Chronicle proves that he died in his 21st year. Therefore this was in 605 BC. Nebuchadnezzar, his son 
began to reign in this year and also became “World Ruler” in this year. 


On this evidence presented, 605 BC and 539 BC are of practically equal certainty. I think it would be 
fair to say that 605 BC is more certain because we can attach the Babylonian Chronicle, as well as the 
Cuneiform Tablets to Nabopolassar’s reign, whereas we only have the cuneiform tablets to add on to 

the eclipse year in Cambyses reign. 


Nebuchadnezzar’s years are therefore AT LEAST as firmly fixed as those of Cyrus. The Nabonidus 
Chronicle is of no help because it relates to the reign of Nabonidus and if we have to work down from 
the eclipse in the 21st year of Nabopolassar or work up from the Eclipse in the 7th year of Cambyses 
as we do to calculate the years of his reign, it is obvious that there is a greater margin for error. 


There is only one other way that the reigns of the Kings for this period can be located. That is to 
utilise the Astronomical Tablet related to Nebuchadnezzar’s 37th year. The evidence of this Tablet 
swings the weight of evidence very heavily in favour of Nebuchadnezzar’s years being more 
positively located than those of Cyrus. The accuracy of the location of Cyrus’ reign is not however, 
disputed. 


To more or less sum up the position on Absolute Dates so far, and to introduce us to our final source 
of evidence for the period concerned, I quote from The Chronology of Ezra 7 by Horn and Wood, 
pages 94 and 95: 


One of these anchor points, from which we can locate other relative 
dates, is furnished by an astronomical tablet bearing a series of 
observations dated in the 37th year of Nebuchadnezzar. These fix the 
year as having begun on April 22/23, 568 BC and ended on April 
11/12, 567 BC. 


Another astronomical tablet of equal importance has established that 
the 7th year of Cambyses lasted from April 6/7, 523 to March 25/26, 
522 BC. With the help of the Canon of Ptolemy and thousands of 
dated cuneiform documents written on clay tablets, which agree 
throughout as to the total of regnal years for each king, it is possible 
to arrive at exact dates for each of the kings reigning in the period 
between the two astronomical tablets. 


See also A T Olmstead, History of the Persian Empire, pages 201 and 202, and The American Journal 
of Semitic Languages and Literatures Vol. LV April 1938, pages 121 and 122. 


The Astronomical Text Dated to Nebuchadnezzar’s 37th Year 


Encyclopaedia Britannica (1961) Vol. 7, page 914, briefly mentions the eclipse which took place in 
Nebuchadnezzar’s 37th year: 


In a Babylonian observation tablet of 568 BC, mention is made of 
failure to observe a predicted eclipse of the moon. The eclipse is 


103 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


found by computation to have been real but invisible at Babylon. It 
was doubtless predicted by cycle. 


The Tablet is contained in Berlin Museum and a complete translation and consideration of it is 
contained in a German publication. Neugebauer, Paul V. and Weidner, Ernst F. wrote the article “Ein 
astronomischer Beobachtungstext aus dem 37. Jahre Nebukadnezars II (-567/66)”. An English 
translation of this article title is An astronomical observation text from the 37th year of 
Nebuchadnezzar (-567/66). The title of the book in which this is contained is Berichte uber die 
Verhandlungen der Konlgl. Sachsischen Gesellschaft der Wissenschaften zu Leipzig, Phil. -hist.- 
Klasse 67 (1915), part 2, pp. 29-89. (Reports Concerning the Proceedings of the Royal Saxon Society 
of Science at Leipzig.) 


On page 29, the authors advise that the Tablet is identified as VAT4956. On page 35, the portion of 
the Tablet which reports that the predicted Lunar eclipse was not seen, is translated. (It did occur but 
was not visible at Babylon.) 


On page 50, the date of the eclipse is disclosed as SIVAN 15, or according to calculation, July 4th, 
568 BC. The Babylonian Astronomer obviously made his calculation on the basis of a cycle known to 
him, most likely it was the “Saros”. 


From the information derived from the Tablet, Neugebauer and Weidner were able to calculate the 
first day of many of the Months of the year (Spring to Spring in Babylon). The result of this 
calculation appears on page 66: 


Nebukadnezar Jahr 36 Schaltader 1 = -567 Marz 24/25 
Nebukadnezar Jahr 37 Nisan 1 = -567 April 22/23 
Nebukadnezar Jahr 37 Aru 1 = -567 Mai 22/23 
Nebukadnezar Jahr 37 Sivan 1 = -567 Juni 20/21 
Nebukadnezar Jahr 37 Tebet 1 = -566 Januar 14/15 
Nebukadnezar Jahr 37 Sebat 1 = -566 Februar = 12/13 
Nebukadnezar Jahr 37 Adar 1 = -566 Marz 14/15 
Nebukadnezar Jahr 38 Nisan 1 = -566 = April 12/13 


The Tables presented by Parker and Dubberstein in Babylonian Chronology 626 BC - AD 75 for 568 
BC agree exactly with these results and of course were calculated quite independently and from other 
sources. 


Some will no doubt have noticed that the dates mentioned in relation to this tablet have not been 
Classed as BC but have been prefixed by a minus sign. The reason for this is explained by Jack 
Finegan on page 133 of Handbook of Biblical Chronology: 


Mathematically speaking, the omission of zero in a sequence of 
numbers involves an error and accordingly, in astronomical 
reckoning, the first year before AD 1 is designated as year Zero and 
from there on back the years are marked with a minus sign, while the 
years moving forward from Year Zero are marked with a plus sign. 


An example of the two methods is as follows:- 


Historical Astronomical 
AD 2 = +2 
AD 1 = +1 
BC 1 = 0 
BC 2 = -1 
BC 3 = -2 


This helps us to appreciate that the -567 of the Astronomer is equal to the 568 BC of the Historian. 


104 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


The double dating (e.g. 24/25) arises because: 


The Babylonian day of 24 hours was reckoned from sundown to 
sundown. (J Philip Hyatt, Journal of Biblical Literature LXXV, 1956 
page 277.) 


Therefore parts of two of our days cover one day of the Babylonians. (The same thing applied to the 
Jews.) 


Reference to the list of Month beginnings reveals that the 1st of Sivan was the same as 20/21 of June 
in -567 (568B.C.) and therefore the 15th of Sivan, when the watch was made for the Eclipse, was 4/5 
of July. These calculated Month beginnings also then corroborate the result of the Eclipse 
computation. 


Oppolzer’s Canon der Finsternisse proves that an eclipse of the Moon took place on July 4th, 568 BC, 
but it was daytime at Babylon, when the Moon was eclipsed in a position visible from further around 
the Earth. (Where it was of course, night time.) This accounts for the notation of the Babylonian 
Astronomer that he failed to witness the eclipse. 


Commencing on page 72, Neugebauer and Weidner provide details of the position of the planets on 
various dates as recorded on the Tablet. The location of Saturn, Jupiter, Venus, Mars and Mercury are 
provided. 


BE page 331 informs us, 


Much information has been systematically collected by the 
Babylonians and from it we have here the beginning of astronomy. 
The groups of stars which now bear the name ‘Twelve Signs of the 
Zodiac’ were mapped out for the first time, and the planets Mercury, 
Venus, Mars, Jupiter, and Saturn were known. 


We can see then that the Tablet provides observed positions of all the known planets. The 
observations were not haphazardly recorded either. 


Chaldean observations may be illustrated by an ephemeris prepared in 
568. ... Already the course of the planets is definitely fixed in degrees 
and minutes with reference to the constellations and stars. (A T 
Olmstead, page 200 History of the Persian Empire, and page 120 The 
American Journal of Semitic Languages and Literatures Vol. LV, 
April 1938. 


The groups of stars mentioned by BEF are the “constellations” referred to by Olmstead. And There 
Was Light by Rudolph Thiel confirms on page 15, “There are twelve constellations in the Zodiac.’ 


’ 


On the following page of each reference given, Olmstead observes 


Not only were the cycles of all the planets but Mercury known with 
astonishing precision, but the astronomers were not satisfied with 
their results and were seeking to make them more precise. 


The cycles of the planets (i.e., the period each planet takes on one revolution about the Sun) are 
disclosed on page 128 of the Encyclopaedia Britannica Atlas (1961) “Modern Space Map.” 


Mercury 88 days 
Venus 224.7 days 
Earth 365.25 days 
Mars 1.88 years 
Jupiter 11.86 years 
Saturn 29.46 years 
Uranus 84.02 years 
Neptune 164.79 years 
Pluto 248.43 years 


105 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


Seeing that the position and date of the position of each of the Planets known in those days is 
definitely recorded on the tablet, and Astronomers say that the Tablet relates to the year 568 BC. We 
have the 37th Year of Nebuchadnezzar definitely located by the several lines of evidence on the 
Tablet. 


The Planets did stand in the relation to each other recorded on the Tablet in 568 BC. Remember that 
the Society is satisfied that Astronomers can calculate the date of tablets from the Astronomical data 
that they contain. (See my page 48 and Awake, April 22nd, 1963 page 17.) 


Now picture what the situation would have to be for this Tablet to fit another year with which the 
observation details on the tablet coincided. 


To do this, it is necessary first of all to consider the peculiarities related to each planet. For 
convenience sake, we will start with the Earth and we will station ourselves at Babylon where the 
original observations were made. As the positions of the Planets are located with reference to the 
Constellations, the Earth would have to be back in its same relation to them as it was on the date of 
the record on the Tablet. This only happens at the end of each complete revolution around the Sun and 
therefore once a year. So if an alternative year is to be found for the planets to stand in the same 
relation to each other, it would have to be very nearly in exact multiples of 365.25 days away from the 
dates in 568 BC. This point may be better understood when the positions of the planets are being 
considered. 


A paragraph from the book A Key to the Heavens by Leo Mattersdorf might also help, page 83: 


Hence, the constellations for ages have presented the same 
formations, and those we see on a spring evening, let us say, we shall 
see at the same time the next spring. The stars become old looked-for 
friends, and the rising of the springtime star groups presages the 
advent of another season of warmth, flowers, and blossoms. The 
evening stars of other times of the year are similarly identified with 
their respective seasons, and actually present for us an infallible 
celestial calendar. 


Of all the planets known to the Babylonians, Saturn has the cycle taking the longest period of time, 
ie., 29.46 years. Therefore it would be back in its required position almost 29% years before or after 
568 BC. 


Obviously though, the Earth would have completed 29% cycles in this time and though Saturn would 
be in position, the Earth would be half-way on its journey around the Sun again. And what about the 
other planets? Let us take the planet with the next largest orbit, Jupiter (11.86 years). At the end of 
29¥2 years it would be nowhere near its required position on the specified date, for it would have 
circled the Sun twice (23.72 years) and have been nearly half-way around the Sun again. There is no 
need to consider the other planets, for clearly a date approx. 29% years away from 568 BC would be 
absolutely impossible. 


On page 200 of History of the Persian Empire, Olmstead cites an Astronomical Textbook of the 
Babylonians dated to 577 BC. On it the scribe stated, “Saturn comes back in 59 years.” This is not 
absolutely correct for as we can see 29.46 x 2 = 58.92. Nevertheless, in approx. cycles of 59 years, 
Saturn was again observable in the same location. Let us then consider the position that would exist 
each 59 years. 


The Earth, as the Babylonian Textbook testifies, would be in its required position, (because the cycle 
is of complete years.) Saturn of course is in a favourable position. Now, what about Jupiter? Is it 
going to fit in on its due-date? Unfortunately, No! It would have completed a total of 4 revolutions 
about the Sun in this time and would almost have almost completed its 5th. Almost but not quite, for 
on its prescribed date it would be roughly 44% months away from its required position. 


When we consider that the Society’s Chronology is approx. 20 years at variance with the Absolute 
Chronology for the period it becomes apparent that it requires Nebuchadnezzar’s 37th year to be 
about 588 BC. 


106 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


When we again refer to the cycles of the planets, we can see that it is absolutely impossible for the 
planets to have stood in the correct relationship to each other in that year. 


To determine another year when all the planets did stand in the required relationship to each other at 
the prescribed intervals, we have to calculate the Lowest Common Multiple of all the cycle periods. 
For example, if Jupiter’s Cycle took 12 years instead of 11.86, and Saturn’s was 30 years instead of 
29.46, it would take 60 years for the Planets to again stand in the same relation to each other as 
required by the Tablet. The Earth would again too be in its required location with reference to the 
Constellations. (Anyone with a basic knowledge of Mathematics knows that 60 is the Least Common 
Multiple of 12 and 30. There is not one number less than 60 that they will both divide into evenly.) 


During this time, Saturn would have made 2 revolutions around the Sun and Jupiter 5. But the 
problem is not so simple, for the observations of Mercury, Venus and Mars are also recorded and 
these too would have to be back in their recorded positions on given dates. Besides this, we do not 
want the Lowest Common Multiple of 12 and 30, we want it of 29.46 years, 11.86, years, 1.88 years, 
1 year, 224.7 days and 88 days. 


If you calculate the Lowest Common Multiple of just 1 year, 11.86 years and 29.46 years you will 
arrive at the figure 1,746,978 years. It makes one’s head swim to even think what the Lowest 
Common Multiple of all the Cycle periods would be. 


I am not suggesting that the observations of the planets by the Babylonians were absolutely accurate, 
but slight errors would not alter the situation. The eclipse and the planetary positions fix this year 
quite positively. 


Is it any wonder that Otto Neugebauer wrote to me and said that the year was absolutely certain? (See 
my page 48) 


It is no wonder either that the Seventh-day Adventist Bible Commentary states, concerning this tablet, 


Modern Astronomers who have checked this information by 
astronomical computation say that the combination of data for the 
sun, moon, and planets which all move in differing cycles, cannot be 
duplicated in any other year. 


Incidentally, in a year 59 years away from 568 BC, Mars would have been at least 7 months or 
approx. one-third of its Cycle out of position on its due date. I just mention this in case someone was 
thinking that 59 years was near enough. It is nowhere near a sufficient period. 


There is no reason to doubt the veracity of the statements of the experts who correspond the Tablet 
with the year 568 BC, and the conclusion that this year was Nebuchadnezzar's 37th is inescapable. 


If the Society wants to relocate the reign of either Nebuchadnezzar or Cyrus, it is very apparent that 
the reign of Nebuchadnezzar cannot be interfered with. But then neither can that of Cyrus, really. The 
problems for the Society are perplexing. Indeed it seems the only course it can possibly adopt is to 
just bluff their way along and rely on the hold that they have over their adherents. This is exactly what 
the Society is doing. 


As 568 BC was Nebuchadnezzar's 37th year, his accession year was 605 BC. And it will be 
appreciated that this date can be calculated without reference to “Ptolemy's Canon”. It must be 
obvious that the statement that Chronologers shorten up the stream of time because of “Ptolemy's 
Cannon” is entirely at variance with the facts. 


The Babylonian Chronicle records the fall of Jerusalem in the 7th year of Nebuchadnezzar. It is quite 
positive that it fell under Jehoiachin in 597 BC (see my page 26.) All authorities accept this date and I 
quote just as a sample, D J Wiseman, from page 81 of Documents from Old Testament Times (1958): 


16 March 597 BC, thus giving a firm date in both OT and Babylonian 
chronology. 


107 


Appendix C: Absolute Dates 


In concluding our investigation of Absolute Dates, I want to say that it is Absolute Foolishness and 
irresponsible to arbitrarily select one date from this period and just continue as though the rest do not 
exist. 


Whether we shut our eyes to them or not, the fact remains that they exist. In considering the Society's 
attitude on this matter, we must realise that the Society has not taken its stand because of faithfulness 
to the Bible. This is true despite the claims of the Society to the contrary. The Bible does not record 
any of these dates and so the Society is obliged when selecting just one of the Absolute Dates to 
justify its action. This it cannot do. 


If it is conducting itself in harmony with truth, it is obliged to justify its course, in the interests of 
God's good name, because it claims to be His Mouthpiece. 


It is also obliged to justify its action because the lives of so many people who are content to just 
follow it, are in its hands. I say to all that it is impossible for the Society to justify its actions. The 
Society stands exposed to all aware of the facts as the perpetrator of a hoax. For this offence against 
God and Man it stands condemned, there is no excuse. 


108 


APPENDIX D: A BRIEF CHRONOLOGICAL OUTLINE OF THE 70 YEARS 

621 5th year of Nabopolassar. 22nd April. Eclipse of the Moon recorded by Ptolemy. 

605 21st year of Nabopolassar, in which he dies. Sept. 6 Nebuchadnezzar becomes King. Pharaoh 
Necho defeated at Carchemish. Chronicle and Jeremiah 46:2. Nebuchadnezzar over-runs whole 
area. Chronicle. Babylon’s 70 years begin. Nebuchadnezzar comes to Jerusalem. Daniel 1:1 and 
2 Kings 24:1. Prisoners and Temple utensils taken. Daniel 1:2 and 2 Chronicles 36:6-8. also 
Berosus in Josephus; Against Apion 1:19. Upon hearing of the death of his father, 
Nebuchadnezzar returns to Babylon and claims throne. Chronicle. Jeremiah surveys the situation 
and advises that the new World Power (Daniel 2:28) would suppress for 70 years and that whole 
area would be a devastated place. In fact a devastation had already been suffered (Daniel 9:2) and 
Judah was already in a sorrowful condition, desolate to a degree. Jeremiah 25:1, 11, 18. 
Nebuchadnezzar returned to the scene of his conquests. Chronicle. 

604 The Ist Regnal Year of Nebuchadnezzar. (Babylonian Chronology 626 BC-AD75 by Parker and 
Dubberstein (hereafter referred to as P and D). Nebuchadnezzar again visits Palestine and all the 
Kings pay tribute. Chronicle. Jehoiakim remains faithful for three years. 2 Kings 24:1. 

603 Daniel interprets Nebuchadnezzar's Dream of the Giant Image. Daniel 2. 

603 Jehoiakim remains faithful to Babylon. 2 Kings 24:1 

602 _ Jehoiakim remains faithful to Babylon. 2 Kings 24:1 

601 Babylonian Army badly mauled by Egyptians. Chronicle. Jehoiakim, apparently impressed by 
show of force by Egyptians and rebels against Babylon. 2Kings 24:1 

600 Babylonian Army does not venture from Babylon. Army reorganising in progress. Chronicle. 
Jehoiakim continues rebellion. 

599 Possibly in this year the marauding Bands were sent against Judah. 2 Kings 24 and Jeremiah 12. 
Nebuchadnezzar engaged in subduing Arabs. Chronicle. 

598 Nebuchadnezzar apparently took 3,023 Jews captive in a campaign preliminary to the major 

ion of the following year Jer 52:28. Jehoiakim dies. 2 Chronicles 36:5, 9. 

597 Jerusalem falls to Babylonians 16th March 597 BC. Jehoiachin taken captive to Babylon. 
Chronicle. 2 Kings 24:8-15. Zedekiah made King by Nebuchadnezzar. Chronicle and 2 Kings 
24:17. He too began to plot against Babylon. Jeremiah 27 and 28 

588 Final siege of Jerusalem began on January 15th. 2 Kings 25:1; Jeremiah 39:1; 52:4. Late in this 
year the Egyptian forces caused the Babylonians to lift their siege temporarily. Jeremiah 37:7, 11. 
This may be when Babylonians took 832 Jews captive. Jeremiah 52:29. 

586 Jerusalem falls after 2/2 years siege. 2 Kings 25:2, 3; Jeremiah 39:2; 52:5-7. August 15, 
destruction of City begins. 2 Kings 25:8-10. Governor appointed (Gedeliah) but murdered. 
Jeremiah 41:2. Jews take Jeremiah to Egypt. Jeremiah 43:7. 

585 January 8. Word of the fall reaches Ezekiel in Babylon. Ezekiel 33:21. Ezekiel advises of further 
desolation. Ezekiel 33:22 ff. 

582. Final captivity of Jews. Jeremiah 52:30. 

568 37th Year of Nebuchadnezzar commenced 23rd April. Eclipse of the Moon July 4th. Babylonian 
Observation Tablet VAT 4956. 

561 1st Regnal Year of Evil-Merodach.(P and D) 

559 1st Regnal Year of Neriglissar. (Pand D) 

556 Labashi-Marduk reigns for few Months. (P and D) 

555 lst Regnal Year of Nabonidus. (P and D) Adda-guppi dies 547 BC. 

553 Belshazzar entrusted with Kingship. BF page 186. SI pages 139, 140. 

539 Daniel interprets handwriting on Wall. Belshazzar slain. Daniel 5:30. October 12, Babylon falls 
to Medes and Persians. The Babylonian records recognise the King of the Persian Empire, Cyrus, 
as King of Babylon, while Jews apparently recognised Darius the Mede as having 1 regnal year 
(this point is uncertain). 

Cyrus’ Year 1. If the Jews regarded it as from Tishri 538 BC, return to Judah most likely 536 BC. (Decree 
Ezra 1:1-3; 2 Chronicles 36:22, 23. If Darius the Mede allowed 1 year (538-537 BC) Cyrus Ist year would 
= 537-536 BC, and the return certainly in 536 BC. 

536 _ Return of the Jews to Judah. Possible year of Cyrus' Decree. End of the 70 year (by Inclusive 
Reckoning.) 

529 1st Regnal Year of Cambyses. (P and D) 

523. 7th Year of Cambyses commenced 7th April. Eclipse 16th July. 


109 


APPENDIX E: SELECTED PAGES FROM THE BOOK 
“ALL SCRIPTURE INSPIRED OF GOD” (1963 EDITION) 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


Bible Book 
Number Thirteen— 


I Chronicles 


Writer: Ezra 
Place Written: Jerusalem (7) 
Time of Writing: c. 460 B.C.E. 
Time Covered: 1077-1037 B.C.E. 


S FIRST Chronicles just a dry list of geneal- restored Jews from their apathy, and of in- 

ogies? Is it merely a repetition of the books fusing in them the realization that they were 
of Samuel and Kings? Far from it! Here is indeed the inheritors of Jehovah’s covenanted 
an illuminating and essential part of the divine loving-kindness. In the Chronicles, therefore, he 
record—essential in the day of its writing in set before them a full account of the nation’s 
reorganizing the nation and its worship, and history, and of the origins of mankind, going 
essential and beneficial in showing a pattern back as far as the first man Adam. Since the 
of divine worship for later days, including this kingdom of David was the focal point, he high- 
present day. First Chronicles contains some of lighted the history of Judah, omitting almost 
the most beautiful expressions of praise to entirely the absolutely umredeeming record of 
Jehovah to be found in all Scripture. It pro- the ten-tribe kingdom. He depicted Judah's 
vides wonderful foregleams of Jehovah's king- greatest kings as engaged in building or re- 
dom of righteousness, and is to be studied with storing the temple and zealously leading in the 
profit by all who hope in that kingdom. The worship of God. He pointed out the religious 
two books of Chronicles have been treasured _ sins that led to the kingdom's overthrow, while 
by Jews and Christians alike through the ages. emphasizing also God's promises of restoration. 
The Bible translator Jerome had such an He stressed the importance of pure worship by 
exalted opinion of First and Second Chronicles focusing attention on the many details pertain- 
that he considered them an “epitome of the ing to the temple, its priests, the Levites, the 
Old Testament,” and asserted that “they are masters of song, and so on. Whereas in Kings 
of such high moment and importance, that he the prophet Jeremiah had stressed the pro- 
who supposes himself to be acquainted with phetic element, the priest Ezra stressed the 
the sacred writings, and does not know them, priestly element in Chronicles. 
only deceives himself.’* *What is the evidence that Ezra wrote 

?The two books of Chronicles were origi- Chronicles? One strong reason has already 
nally one book or roll, which was later divided been suggested, in its emphasis on the Levitical 
for convenience, Why was Chronicles written? spirit. Ezra would give this emphasis, for he is 
Consider the setting. The captivity to Babylon described as a descendant “of Aaron the high 
had ended about seventy-seven years before. priest—the said Ezra himself went up from 
The Jews were resettled in their land. How- Babylon; and he was a skilled copyist in the 
ever, there was a dangerous trend away from law of Moses.” (Ezra 7:1-7) The closing two 
Jehovah's worship at the rebuilt temple in Jeru- verses of Second Chronicles are the same as 
salem. Ezra had been commissioned by the the opening two verses of Ezra, and Second 
king of Persia to appoint judges and teachers Chronicles ends in the middle of a sentence 
of the law of God and to beautify the house of that is finished in Ezra 1:3. The writer of 
Jehovah. Accurate genealogical lists were nec- Chronicles must therefore have been the writer 
essary to assure that only legitimate persons also of Ezra. This is further borne out in that 
served in the priesthood, and also to confirm the style, language, wording and spelling of 
the tribal inheritances whence the priesthood Chronicles and Ezra are the same. Some of the 
gained its support. In view of Jehovah’s proph- expressions in these two books are found in no 
ecies regarding the Kingdom, it was also vital other Bible books. Ezra, who wrote the book of 
to have a clear and dependable record of the Ezra, must also have written Chronicles. Jew- 
lineage of Judah and of David. ish tradition supports this conclusion. 

* Ezra was earnestly desirous of arousing the *No one was better qualified than Ezra to 


Tiss commmary, Vane Tees em. «Ste thle suthwte and sate, story 
1. Why Is First Chronicles an essential and beneficial consult the law of Jehovah and to do it and to 
part of the divine record? : teach in Israel regulation and justice.” (Ezra 
2. Why was Chronicles written? 7:10) Jehovah aided him by holy spirit. The 


3. (a) What was Ezra desirous of infusing in the Jews? 2 
(b) Why did he highlight the history of Judah and 4, What evidence favors Ezra as the writer? 
the priestly element? 5. What were Ezra’s spiritual and secular qualifications? 


i) 


111 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


84 “ALL SCRIPTURE IS INSPIRED OF GOD AND BENEFICIAL" 


ship again. After two years, his own servants 
put him to death. 

= Josiah’s courageous reign (34:1-35:27). 
Youthful Josiah, the son of Amon, makes a 
courageous attempt to restore true worship. He 
has the altars of the Baals and graven images 
pulled down, and repairs the house of Jehovah, 
where a copy of the law of Moses is found. 
Yet he is told that calamity will come on the 
land for the unfaithfulness that has already 
occurred, but not in righteous Josiah’s day. In 
the eighteenth year of his reign he arranges 
an outstanding passover celebration. After a 
thirty-oneyear reign Josiah meets his death 
in a vain attempt to prevent the Egyptian 
hosts from passing through the land on their 
way to the Euphrates. 

22 Jehoahaz, Jeholakim, Jehoiachin, Zedekiah 
and Jerusalem's desolation (36:1-23). The wick- 
edness of the last four Judean kings quickly 
carries the nation to its disastrous end. Josiah’s 
son Jehoahaz rules only three months, being 
removed by Pharaoh Necho of Egypt. He is 
replaced by his brother Eliakim, whose name 
is changed to Jehoiakim, and during whose 
reign Judah is subjugated by the new world 
power, Babylon. (2 Ki. 24:1) When he rebels, 
Nebuchadnezzar comes up to Jerusalem to pun- 
ish him in 618 B.C.E., but Jehoiakim dies this 
same year, after reigning cleven years. He is 
replaced by his eighteen-year-old son Jehoia- 
chin, who surrenders to Nebuchadnezzar after 
a reign of scarcely three months and is carried 
away captive to Babylon. Nebuchadnezzar now 
places a third son of Josiah, Jehoiachin’s uncle 
Zedekiah, on the throne. Zedekiah reigns badly 
for eleven years, refusing to “humble himself 
on account of Jeremiah the prophet at the 
order of Jehovah.” (2 Chron. 36:12) In large- 
scale unfaithfulness, priests and people alike 
defile the house of Jehovah. 

*” Finally, Zedekiah rebels against Babylon's 
yoke, and this time Nebuchadnezzar shows no 
mercy. Jehovah's rage is full, and there is no 
healing. Jerusalem falls, its temple is looted 
and burned, and the survivors of the eighteen- 
month siege are carried as captives to Bab- 
ylon. Judah is left desolate. Thus in this very 
year of 607 B.C.E. begins the desolation “to 
fulfill Jehovah’s word by the mouth of Jere- 


- What are the highlights of Josiah’s courageous 
reign? 

32. How do the last four kings lead Judah to Its 
disastrous end? 

33. (a) How does the seventy-year desolation begin, 
“to fulfill Jehovah's word"? (b) What historic deerce 
is recorded in the last two verses? 


miah, .. . to fulfill seventy years.” (36:21) The 
chronicler then leaps this gap of nearly seventy 
years, to record in the last two verses the his- 
toric decree of Cyrus in 537 B.C.E. The Jewish 
captives are to be set free! Jerusalem must 
rise again! 


WHY BENEFICIAL 

*4 Second Chronicles adds its powerful testi- 
mony to that of other witnesses concerning 
this eventful period, 1037-537 B.C.E. Moreover, 
it gives valuable supplementary information 
not found in other canonical histories, for 
example, at 2 Chronicles chapters 19, 20 and 
29.31. Ezra’s selection of material emphasized 
the fundamental and permanent elements in 
the history of the nation, such as the priest- 
hood and its service, the temple and the king- 
dom covenant. This was beneficial in holding 
the nation together in hope of the Messiah and 
his kingdom. 

*°The closing verses of Second Chronicles 
(36:17-23) give conclusive proof of the fulfill- 
ment of Jeremiah 25:12, and, in addition, show 
that a full seventy years must be counted from 
the complete desolation of the land to the 
restoration of Jehovah's worship at Jerusalem 
in 537 B.C.E. This desolation therefore begins 
607 B.C.E., and not 586 B.C.E., as some Bible 
chronologies assert.—Jer. 29:10; 2 Ki. 25:1-26; 
Ezra 3:1-6. 


**Second Chronicles contains powerful ad- 
monitions for those walking in Christian faith. 
So many of the kings of Judah started well 
but then lapsed into wicked ways. We should 
be warned therefore not to be “the sort that 
shrink back to destruction, but the sort that 
have faith to the preserving alive of the soul.” 
(Heb. 10:39) Even faithful King Hezekiah be- 
came haughty on recovering from his sickness, 
and it was only because he quickly humbled 
himself that he was able to avoid Jehovah's 
indignation. Second Chronicles magnifies Je- 
hovah’s wonderful qualities and extols his 
name and sovereignty. The entire history is 
presented from the standpoint of exclusive de 
votion to Jehovah. As it lays emphasis also 
upon the royal line of Judah, it strengthens 
our expectation of seeing pure worship exalted 
under the everlasting kingdom of Jesus Christ, 
the loyal “son of David."—Acts 15:16, 17. 

4. What is emphasized tn Ezra's selection of material, 
and how was this beneficial to the nation? 

35. What Important points are proved in the closing 
verses? 

36. (a) What powerful admonitions are contained in 


Second Chronicles? (b) How does it strengthen expecta- 
tion concerning the Kingdom? 


112 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


Bible Book 
Number Fifteen— 


Ezra 


HE end of the prophesied seventy years of 

Jerusalem's desolation under Babylon was 
drawing near. True, it was Babylon’s reputa- 
tion that she never released her captives, but 
Jehovah’s word would prove stronger than 
Babylonian might. Release of Jehovah's people 
was in sight. Jehovah's temple that had been 
laid low would be rebuilt and Jehovah’s altar 
would again receive sacrifices of atonement. 
Jerusalem would again know the shout and 
praise of the true worshiper of Jehovah. Jere- 
miah had prophesied the length of the desola- 
tion, and Isaiah had prophesied how the re- 
lease of captives would come about. Isaiah had 
even named Cyrus of Persia as ‘the shepherd of 
Jehovah,’ who would tumble haughty Babylon 
from her position as the third world power of 
Bible history.—Jer. 25:12; Isa. 44:28; 45:1, 2. 

* This disaster befell Babylon on the night of 
October 5-6, 539 B.C.E., as the Babylonian king 
Belshazzar and his grandees were drinking 
toasts to their demon gods. Adding to their 
pagan debauchery, they were using the holy 
vessels from Jehovah's temple as their cups of 
drunkenness! How fitting that Cyrus was there 
that night to fulfill the prophecy! “B.C. 539 
Cyrus takes Babylon,” says the Westminster 
Dictionary of the Bible. (1944 Ed., page 108) 
“In 539 B.C. Cyrus turned his attack against 
Nabonidus [father and coregent of Belshaz- 
var], and the Babylonian army was defeated,” 
says Werner Keller in The Bible as History 
(1956, page 310, N.Y. Ed.; page 297, London 
Ed.). To which The Encyclopedia Britannica, 
Eleventh Edition, Vol. 7, page 707, adds its 
testimony: “Why the war with Babylon, which 
had become inevitable, was delayed until 539, 
we do not know. Here too Cyrus in a single 
campaign destroyed a mighty state. The army 
of Nabonidus was defeated; Babylon itself at- 
tempted no resistance, but surrendered on the 
16th Tishri . . . 539, to the Persian general 
Gobryas.” 

*This date 539 B.C.E. is an absolute date, 
that is, a date fixed, proved and accepted by 


1. What prophecies gave assurance of Jerusalem's res- 
toration? ps 

2. What were the time and occasion of Babylon's fall? 
3. What proclamation by Cyrus made it possible to 
restore Jehovah's worship exactly seventy years after 
the desolation began? 


Writer: Ezra 
Place Written: Jerusalem 
Writing Completed: cc. 460 B.O.E. 
Time Covered: 537-467 B.OC.E. 


secular history. In the following year, begin- 
ning in 538, Cyrus began his first complete 
year as world ruler, and it was during this 
year, some time before the spring of 537, 
that Cyrus “caused a cry to pass through all 
his realm,” authorizing the Jews to go up to 
Jerusalem to rebuild the house of Jehovah.* 
A faithful remnant journeyed back in time to 
set up the altar and offer the first sacrifices in 
the “seventh [Jewish] month,” corresponding 
to September-October 537, seventy years to 
the month after Judah and Jerusalem's deso- 
lation by Nebuchadnezzar.—Ezra 1:1-3; 3:16. 

*Restoration! This provides the setting of 
the book of Ezra. The use of the first person, 
“J,” in the narration from chapter 7, verse 28, 
onward clearly shows that the writer was 
Ezra. As “a skilled copyist in the law of Moses” 
and a man of practical faith who “prepared 
his heart to consult the law of Jehovah and to 
do it and to teach” it, Ezra was well qualified 
to record this history, even as he had recorded 
Chronicles. (Ezra 7:6, 10) Since the book of 
Ezra is a continuation of Chronicles, it is gen- 
erally believed to have been written at the 
same time, about 460 B.C.E. It covers seventy 
years, from the time that the Jews were a 
broken, scattered nation marked as “sons of 
death,” to the completion of the second temple 
and the cleansing of the priesthood after Ezra’s 
return to Jerusalem—Ezra 1:1; 7:7; 10:17; 
Ps. 102:20, NW footnote, 1957 Edition. 

*The Hebrew name Ezra means “The Help.” 
The books of Ezra and Nehemiah were origi- 
nally one scroll. (Neh. 3:32, NW footnote, 1955 
Edition) Later the Jews divided this scroll, 
and called it First and Second Ezra. Modern 
Hebrew Bibles call the two books Ezra and 
Nehemiah, as do other modern Bibles. Part 
of the book of Ezra (4:8 to 6:18, and 7:12-26) 
was written in Aramaic, and the remainder in 
Hebrew, Ezra being skilled in both languages. 

*Ezra had been charged with carrying out 


a Babylonian Chronology, 1956, Parker and Dubber- 
stein, page 29. 


&. (a) What is the setting of the book, and who wrote 
it? ei When was it written, and what period does it 
cover 

5. What relation has the book of Ezra to the book of 
Nehemiah, and in what languages was It written? 

6, hyo} aa to Ezra’s record, what has archaeology 
con: 


113 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


86 “ALL SCRIPTURE IS INSPIRED OF GOD AND BENEFICIAL” 


the imperial decree to instruct the Jews in the 
law of Jehovah. (7:25) Archaeological evidence 
supports the record in Ezra, showing that he 
performed this task thoroughly. For example, 
papyrus finds as far south as Elephantine, in 
southern Egypt, have been found to contain 
instructions from King Darius II of Persia to 
the Jews there, on how to observe the passover 
properly.* Concerning the canonicity of Ezra, 
W. F. Albright writes in his treatise The Bible 
After Twenty Years of Archaeology: “Archaeo- 
logical data have thus demonstrated the sub- 
stantial originality of the Books of Jeremiah 
and Ezekiel, of Ezra and Nehemiah beyond 
doubt; they have confirmed the traditional pic- 
ture of events, as well as their order.” 

? Though the book of Ezra may not be quoted 
or referred to directly by the Greek Scripture 
writers, yet there is no question about its place 
in the canon of the Bible, carrying as it does 
the record of Jehovah's dealings with the Jews 
down to the time of the assembling of the He- 
brew catalogue, which work was largely accom- 
plished by Ezra, according to Jewish tradition. 
Moreover, the book of Ezra so vindicates all 
the prophecies concerning the restoration as to 
prove that it is indeed an integral part of the 
divine record, with which it also harmonizes 
completely, honoring pure worship and sancti- 
fying the great name of Jehovah God. 


CONTENTS OF EZRA 
*A remnant returns (1:1-3:6). His spirit 
roused by Jehovah, Cyrus king of Persia issues 
the decree for the Jews to return and build the 
house of Jehovah in Jerusalem. He urges those 
Jews who may remain in Babylon to contribute 
freely toward the project, and arranges for the 
returning Jews to take back the utensils of the 
original temple. A leader from the royal tribe 
of Judah, and lineal descendant of King David, 
Zerubbabel (Sheshbazzar), is assigned as gov- 
ernor to lead the released ones, and Jeshua 
(or Joshua) is the high priest. (Ezra 1:8; 5:2; 
Zech. 3:1) A remnant of nearly fifty thousand 
faithful servants of Jehovah, including priests, 
Levites and non-Israelite slaves and temple 
workers, make the journey of about a thou- 
sand miles. By the seventh month, according to 
the Jewish calendar, they are settled in their 
cities, and then they gather at Jerusalem to 
offer sacrifices at the site of the temple altar 
and to celebrate the festival of booths in the 
fall of 537 B.C.E. Thus the seventy years’ deso- 
lation ends exactly on time! 


a The Bible as History, 1956, Werner Keller, page 318 
N.Y. Ed., page 344 London Ed. 


7. How Is the book of Ezra shown truly to be a part of 
the divine record? 

8. Describe the traln of events leading to the end of 
the seventy years’ desolation. 


® Rebuilding the temple (3:7-6:22). Materials 
are assembled, and in the second year of their 
return the foundation of the temple of Jehovah 
is laid amid shouts of joy, and amid the weep- 
ing of the older men who had seen the former 
house. The neighboring peoples, adversaries, 
offer to help with the construction, saying they 
are seeking the same God, but the Jewish 
remnant flatly refuse any alliance with them. 
The adversaries continually try to weaken and 
dishearten the Jews and frustrate their work, 
from the reign of Cyrus down to that of Darius. 
Finally, in the days of “Artaxerxes” (Magian 
Gaumata, 522 B.C.E., the usurper who pre- 
ceeded Darius), they have the work forcibly 
stopped by royal command. This ban continues 
“until the second year of the reign of Darius 
the king of Persia,” which is over fifteen years 
after the laying of the foundation.—4:4-7, 24. 

10 Jehovah now sends his prophets Haggai 
and Zechariah to arouse Zerubbabel and Josh- 
ua, and the building work is taken up with 
renewed zeal. Again the adversaries complain 
to the king, but the work goes on with un- 
abated vigor. Darius I (Hystaspis), after re- 
ferring to Cyrus’ original decree, orders the 
work to continue without interference, and 
even commands the opposers to supply mate- 
rials to facilitate construction. With continued 
encouragement from Jehovah's prophets, the 
builders complete the temple in less than five 
years. This is in the month Adar of the sixth 
year of Darius or near the spring of 516 B.C.E., 
and the entire construction has taken just 
about twenty years. (6:14, 15) The house of 
God is now inaugurated with great joy and 
with appropriate sacrifices. Then the people 
celebrate the passover and go on to hold “the 
festival of unfermented cakes seven days with 
rejoicing.” (6:22) Yes, joy and rejoicing mark 
the dedication of this second temple to Je- 
hovah’s praise. 

41 Ezra returns to Jerusalem (7:1-8:36). Al- 
most fifty years elapse, bringing us down to 
468 B.C.E., the seventh year of the Persian 
king, Artaxerxes I (known as “Longimanus,” 
due to having his right hand longer than his 
left). The king grants the skilled copyist Ezra 
“all his request" with respect to a journey to 
Jerusalem to render much-needed aid there. In 
commissioning him, the king encourages the 
Jews to go with him, and grants Ezra silver 
and gold vessels for temple use, and provisions 
of wheat, wine, oil and salt. He exempts the 


9. How does the temple work begin, but what happens 
in the yenrs that follow? 

10. (a) How does encouragement from God's prophets 
combine with the king's order in getting the work 
completed? (b) What joy marks the second temple 
dedication? 

11. How does the king grant Ezra ‘“‘all his request,’’ 
and what is Ezra’s response? 


114 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


88 “ALL SCRIPTURE IS INSPIRED OF GOD AND BENEFICIAL" 


expectation that Jehovah would in due course 
produce his promised King in the line of David. 
The restored nation was now in position to 
guard the sacred pronouncements and worship 
of God until the time of Messiah's appearing. 
If this remnant had not responded in faith, in 


Bible Book 
Number Sixteen— 


Nehemiah 


N EHEMIAH, whose name means “Jah Is 
Comfort,” was a Jewish servant of the Per- 
sian king Artaxerxes L He was cupbearer to 
the king. This was a position of great trust and 
honor, and one to be desired, for it gave access 
to the king at times when he was in a happy 
frame of mind and ready to grant favors. 
However, Nehemiah was one of those faithful 
exiles who preferred Jerusalem above any 
personal “cause for rejoicing.” (Ps. 137:5, 6) It 
was not position or material wealth that was 
uppermost in Nehemiah’s thoughts, but, rather, 
the restoration of Jehovah's worship. 

2In 456 B.C.E. those “left over from the cap- 
tivity,” the Jewish remnant that had returned 
to Jerusalem, were not prospering. They were 
in a lamentable condition. The wall of the city 
was rubble, and the people were a reproach in 
the eyes of their ever-present adversaries. Ne- 
hemiah was grieved. However, it was Jehovah's 
appointed time for something to be done about 
the walls of Jerusalem, Enemies or no enemies, 
Jerusalem with its protective wall must be 
built as a time marker in connection with a 
prophecy that Jehovah had given Daniel con- 
cerning the coming of Messiah. (Dan. 9:24-27) 
Accordingly, Jehovah directed events, using the 
faithful and zealous Nehemiah to carry out the 
divine will. 

3 Nehemiah is undoubtedly the writer of the 
book that bears his name. The opening state- 
ment, “The words of Nehemiah the son of 
Hacaliah,” and the fact that he wrote mostly in 
the first person, clearly prove this. Originally 
the books of Ezra and Nehemiah were one 


1. What position of trust did Nehemiah hold, and what 
was uppermost in his mind? 

2. What sorry condition grieved Nehemiah, but what 
appointed time was drawing near? 

3. (a) What proves Nehemiah to be the writer, and how 
did the book come to be called “Nehemiah”? (b) What 
interval separates this book from the book 

and what years does the oo is Nehemish cover? 


returning to their land, to whom would Mes- 
siah have come? Truly, the events of the book 
of Ezra are an important part of the history 
leading to the appearance of the Messiah and 
King! It is all most beneficial for our study 
today. 


$ Nehemiah 
Place Written: Jerusalem 
Writing Completed: After 448 B.C.E. 
Time Covered: 456—after 443 B.C.E. 


book, called “Ezra.” Later, the Jews divided 
the book into First and Second Ezra, and later 
still Second Ezra became known as Nehemiah. 
An interval of about twelve years lies between 
the closing events of Ezra and the opening 
events of Nehemiah, whose history then covers 
the period of 456 till after 443 B.C.E.—Neh. 1:1; 
5:14; 13:6. 

*The book of Nehemiah harmonizes with 
the rest of inspired Scripture, with which it 
rightfully belongs. It names eleven of the 
twelve gates in the restored Jerusalem, the 
remaining gate being named by Ezra at 
2 Chronicles 25:23. There are also twelve gates 
in the Revelation vision of the heavenly Jeru- 
salem. (Neh. 2:13, 14; 3:3, 6, 26, 28, 31, 32; 
12:39; Rev. 21:21) Further, the book marks the 
beginning of the fulfillment of Daniel's proph- 
ecy that Jerusalem would be rebuilt, but not 
without opposition “in the straits of the times.” 
(Dan. 9:25) Yes, in just fifty-two days; and 
archaeological investigation supports this in 
revealing a hurriedly built wall, made of un- 
usually small stones cemented with clay plaster 
mixed with stone chips.* 

*What about the date of 455 B.C.E. for Ne- 
hemiah’s journey to Jerusalem to rebuild the 
city wall? Testimony by the Greek historian 
Thucydides, who lived during the reign of 
Artaxerxes I, taken with the chronology of the 
Greek historian Diodorus Siculus of the first 
century B.C.E., pinpoints the beginning of Ar- 
taxerxes’ rule as 474 B.C.E.° This would make 
a The Bible as History, 1956, Werner Keller, page 317 
N.Y. Ed., pages 303, 34 London Ed. 

b The Watchtower, 1946, page 360, footnote. 


4% (a) How does th book harmonize with the rest of 
ee (b) How e0es axchasolegy confizm the 


5S. (a) What testimony pinpoints the beginning of 
Artaxerxes’ reign as 474 B.C.E.? (b) What date marks 
his twentieth year? (c) How do the books of Nehemiah 
and Luke tic in with Daniel's prophecy in a remarkable 
fulfillment of prophecy ? 


115 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


127 


(Coniah) will be hurled out of Judah to die 
in Babylon. 

20 Hope in a “righteous sprout” (23:1-24:10). 
Jehovah promises real shepherds to replace the 
false shepherds and a “righteous sprout” out 
of the stock of David, a king who “will cer- 
tainly reign and act with discretion and execute 
justice and righteousness in the land.” His 
name? “He will be called, Jehovah Is Our 
Righteousness.” He will gather the dispersed 
remnant. (23:5, 6) If the prophets had stood 
in Jehovah's intimate group, they would have 
caused the people to hear and turn back from 
their bad way. Instead, says Jehovah, they 
“cause my people to wander about because of 
their falsehoods.” (23:22, 32) “Look! Two bas- 
kets of figs.” Jeremiah uses the good and the 
bad figs to illustrate a faithful remnant re- 
turning to their land in God's favor, and 
another class perishing in captivity.—24:1, 5, 8. 

™ Jehovah's controversy with the nations 
(25:1-38). This chapter is a summary of judg- 
ments that appear in greater detail in chapters 
45 to 49. By three parallel prophecies Jehovah 
now pronounces calamity for all the nations on 
earth. First, Nebuchadnezzar is identified as 
Jehovah's servant to devastate Judah and the 
surrounding nations, “and these nations will 
have to serve the king of Babylon seventy 
years.” Then it will be Babylon’s turn, and she 
will become “desolate wastes to time indefl- 
nite.”—25:1-14. 

32 The second prophecy is the vision of the 
‘cup of wine of Jehovah's rage.’ Jeremiah must 
take this cup to the nations, and “they must 
drink and shake back and forth and act like 
crazed men” because of Jehovah's destruction 
coming against them, First, to Jerusalem and 
Judah! Then on to Egypt, back to Philistia, 
across to Edom, up to Tyre, to lands near and 
far, “and all the other kingdoms of the earth 
that are on the surface of the ground; and the 
king of Sheshach himself will drink after 
them.” They shall drink and puke and fall. 
None will be spared.—25:15-29, 

72In the third prophecy Jeremiah rises to 
magnificent poetic heights. “From on high Je- 
hovah himself will roar .. . against all the in- 
habitants of the earth.” A noise, a calamity, a 
great tempest! “And those slain by Jehovah 
will certainly come to be in that day from one 
end of the earth clear to the other end of the 
earth.” No lamenting, no funerals. They will be 


20. What does Jeremiah prophesy concerning a “'righ- 
teous sprout,’ and what is illustrated by the two 
baskets of figs? 

21. How does Jehovah use Babylon as his servant, but 
what, In turn, will be her fate? 

22. Who must drink of the cup of Jehovah's rage? With 
what result? 

23. In what great calamity will Jehovah's burning anger 
be expressed ? 


BIBLE BOOK NUMBER TWENTY-FOUR— 


JEREMIAH 


as manure on the ground. The false shepherds 
will be slaughtered, along with the majestic 
ones of their flock. There is no escape for them. 
Listen to their howling! Jehovah himself “is 
despoiling their pasturage . .. because of his 
burning anger.” —25:30.38. 

**Jeremiah vindicated against false prophets 
(26:1-28:17). The rulers and people conspire 
to put Jeremiah to death. Jeremiah makes his 
defense. It is the word of Jehovah that he has 
spoken, If they kill him, they will kill an inno- 
cent man. The verdict: Not guilty. The older 
men introduce the precedents of the prophets 
Micah and Urijah in contrasting Jeremiah’s 
course, Jehovah next commands Jeremiah to 
make bands and yokes, put them upon his neck, 
and then send them to the nations round about 
as symbols that they must serve the king of 
Babylon for three generations of rulers. Hana- 
niah, one of the false prophets, opposes Jere- 
miah. He declares that the yoke of Babylon 
will be broken within two years and pictures 
this by breaking the wooden yoke. Jehovah 
underlines his prophecy by having Jeremiah 
put on iron yokes, and by foretelling that 
Hananiah must die that year. He does. 

25Comfort for the exiles in Babylon (29:1~ 
31:40). Jeremiah writes to the exiles taken to 
Babylon with Jehoiachin (Jeconiah): Settle 
down there, for there is coming a period of 
seventy years of exile before Jehovah brings 
you back. Jehovah commands Jeremiah to 
write of their return in a book: Jehovah will 
break their yoke and “they will certainly serve 
Jehovah their God and David their king, whom 
I [Jehovah] shall raise up for them.” (30:9) 
Rachel must hold her voice back from weeping, 
for her sons “will certainly return from the 
land of the enemy.” (31:16) And now, a reas- 
suring declaration by Jehovah! He will con- 
clude with the houses of Judah and Israel a 
new covenant. Far grander this than the cove- 
nant they have broken! Jehovah will write his 
law deep down inside, on their hearts. “And I 
will become their God, and they themselves will 
become my people.” From the least to the 
greatest all will know Jehovah, and he will for- 
give their error. (31:31-34) Their city will be 
rebuilt as something holy to Jehovah. 

2s Jehovah's kingdom covenant sure (32:1- 
34:22). During Nebuchadnezzar’s final siege 
of Jerusalem, Jeremiah is under restraint. 


24. (a) What conspiracy is formed against Jeremiah, 
what is his defense, and what precedents are referred 
to in acquitting him? (b) How does Jeremiah enact 
the coming Babylonian bondage, and what prophecy 
concerning Hananiah comes true? 

25, (a) What message does Jeremiah send to the exiles 
in Babylon? (b) With whom will Jehovah conclude a 
new covenant, and how will this prove to be grander 
than the former covenant? 

26. How Is the certainty of Israel's restoration empha- 
sized, and what news does the word of Jehovah bring? 


116 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


139 


place in history stands clearly revealed. There 
are many texts which indicate that Belshazzar 
almost equaled Nabonidus in position and 
prestige. Dual rulership during most of the last 
Neo-Babylonian reign is an established fact. 
Nabonidus exercised supreme authority from 
his court in Tema in Arabia, while Belshazzar 
acted as coregent in the homeland with Bab- 
ylon as his center of influence. It is evident that 
Belshazzar was not a feeble viceroy; he was 
entrusted with ‘the ites 

*Some have tried to discredit Daniel's ac- 
counts of the fiery furnace and the lions’ pit 
(chapters 3 and 6), saying that these are leg- 
endary inventions. However, remarkable con- 
firmations have again come from the archacol- 
ogists, digging in the ruins at Babylon. One 
discovery was thought to be a brick Kiln, until 
an inscription at the base was found to read: 
“This is the place of burning where men who 
blasphemed the gods of Chaldea died by fire.” 
In another place a deep pit was uncarthed, 
bearing the inscription: “The place of execution 
where men who angered the king died torn by 
wild animals.” Though these are not neces- 
sarily the identical places mentioned in the 
book of Daniel, they confirm that such places 
existed in Daniel's time.” 

®The Westminster Dictionary of the Bible 
nicely sums up the situation with the book of 
Daniel, in these words: “The asserted historical 
inaccuracies in Daniel are not statements which 
are disproved by history, but only statements 
which have seemed difficult to harmonize with 
the meager accounts of secular historians. The 
asserted historical inaccuracies have, moreover, 
been steadily diminishing before the increasing 
knowledge of the times of Cyrus. . .. The 
growth of our knowledge of this period shows 
how cautious one should be in doubting the 
historical accuracy of the Biblical records.” 
—1944, page 130. 

*The Jews included his book, not with the 
Prophets, but with the Writings. However, 
the English Bible follows the catalogue order 
of the Greek Septuagint and the Latin Vulgate 
by placing Daniel between the major and the 
minor prophets. There are actually two parts 
to the book. The first of these, chapters one to 
six, gives in chronological order the experiences 
of Daniel and his companions in governmental 
service from 617 to 538 B.C.E. (Dan. 1:1, 21) 
The second part, comprising chapters seven to 
twelve, is written in the first person by Daniel 


a The Yale Oriental Series - Researches, Vol. XV, 1929. 
b Dead Men Teil Tales, 1946, Harry Rimmer, pages 


5. What other inscriptions have given support to the 
record 


t 
6, What has the growth of knowledge shown concerning 
this period? 
7. What two parts make up the book? 


BIBLE BOOK NUMBER TWENTY-SEVEN— 


DANIEL 


himself as recorder and describes private vi- 
sions and angelic interviews that Daniel had 
from 553° to 536 B.C.E. (Dan. 7:2, 28; 8:2; 9:2; 
12:5, 7, 8) The two parts together make up the 
one harmonious book of Daniel. 


CONTENTS OF DANIEL 

* Preparation for State service (1:1-21). In 
617 B.C.E. Daniel comes to Babylon with the 
captive Jews. The sacred utensils from Jeru- 
salem’s temple come also, to be stored in a 
pagan treasure-house. Daniel and his three He- 
brew companions are among the royal Judean 
youths chosen for a three-year course of train- 
ing in the king's palace. Resolved in his heart 
not to pollute himself with the king’s pagan 
delicacies and wine, Daniel proposes a ten-day 
test of a vegetable diet. The test turns out in 
favor of Daniel and his companions, and God 
gives them knowledge and wisdom. Nebuchad- 
nezzar appoints the four to stand before him as 
counselors. The last verse, which may have 
been added long after the preceding portion 
was written, indicates that Daniel was still in 
royal service some eighty years after his going 
into exile, or about 538 B.C.E. 

* Dream of the dreadful image (2:1-49). In the 
second year of his kingship as world ruler, 
606-605 B.C.E., Nebuchadnezzar is agitated by 
a dream. On awakening he is unable to remem- 
ber it and calls in his magic-practicing priests 
to tell him the dream and its interpretation. He 
offers them great gifts, but they protest that 
no one but the gods can show the king the 
thing that he is asking. The king becomes fu- 
rious and orders the wise men to be put to 
death. Since the four Hebrews are included in 
this decree, Daniel asks for time to reveal the 
dream. They pray to Jehovah for guidance. Je- 
hovah reveals the dream and its meaning to 
Daniel, who then goes before the king and 
says: “There exists a God in the heavens who 
is a Revealer of secrets, and he has made 
known to King Nebuchadnezzar what Is to 
occur in the final part of the days.” (2:28) 
Daniel describes the dream. It is about an im- 
mense image. Its head is of gold, its breasts 
and arms of silver, its belly and thighs of 
copper and its legs of iron, with feet partly 
iron, partly clay. A stone strikes and crushes 
the image and becomes a large mountain to 
fill the whole earth. What does this mean? 
Daniel makes known that the king of Babylon 


ce According to The Westminster Dictionary of the 
Bivle, 1944, page 64, and Babylonian Chronology, 19536, 


to reign as coregent in the third regnal year of Nabon!- 
dus (Nabunald), which was 553 B.C_E.; Daniel 7:1. 


& What leads to Daniel and his companions’ entering 

Babylonian governmental service? 

9. What dream and interpretation does God reveal to 
does Nebuchadnezzar show his apprecia- 


117 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


280 “ALL SCRIPTURE IS INSPIRED OF GOD AND BENEFICIAL" 
THE YEAR OF THE ISRAELITES 
Secular 
Name of Month Corresponds to Year Year Citations Festivals 
Abib or Nisan March - April Ist Month 7th Month Ex. 13: 4; Neh. 2:1 Nisan 14 Possover 
Nisan 15-21 Pestival of unfer- 
mented cakes 
Nisan 16 Offering of 
May 2d Bth 1Ki. 6:1 eee 
Ziv or lyyar - be . 6: 
vik une 3 . Sth “ Esther 8: 9 Sivan 6 Feast of weeks 
cai June . 4th ee 10th bes Jor. $2: 6 , 
T. - . S28: 
Ab ph to 4 Sth “ jth “ Esra%:8 
Ellul ugust - ber 6th cr 32th hs Neh. 6: 15 
or Tishri September - October ih * ist = 1 Ki. 8:2 Ethanim 1 of the trumpet 
Ethanim 10 Day of a’ 
15-21 Festival of theres 
Ethanim 22 Solemn ossembly 
Bul or Heshvan October - November 8th * 1 KL 6: 38 
Tebeth Receckooe” wa sn * maori 
ary - February “ <3 Zech. 1:7 
reg Febres ¥ March lath = He . Feinse a: 7 
Veadar dn month) Wt “ 
18 Year. Our study of time in the Bible now 20 Lunisolar Year. Up until the time of Christ 


brings us to the year. From the beginning of 
man’s history there is mention of the year. 
(Gen. 1:14) The Hebrew word for “year” is 
shanadh, which literally means “repetition.’’* 
This was appropriate since each year the cycle 
of seasons was repeated. An earthly year is 
the time it takes for the earth to make one 
complete revolution or trip around the sun. 
The actual time that it takes for us here on 
earth to complete this trip is 365 days 5 hours 
48 minutes 46 seconds, or approximately 365 4 
days. This is called the true solar year, “sun” 
in Latin being sol. 

i9Bible Years. According to the ancient 
Biblical reckoning, the year ran from autumn 
to autumn. This was particularly suited to an 
agricultural life, the year beginning with plow- 
ing and sowing about October 1, and ending 
with the gathering in of the harvest. Noah 
counted the year as beginning in the autumn. 
He recorded the Deluge as beginning “in the 
second month,” which would correspond to the 
latter half of October and the first half of 
November. (Gen. 7:11) To this day, many 
peoples of the earth still start their new year 
in the autumn. At the time of the exodus from 
Egypt, in 1513 B.C.E., Jehovah decreed that 
Abib (Nisan) should become “the start of the 
months” for the Jews, so that they now had a 
“sacred year,” running from spring to spring. 
(Ex. 12:2) However, the Jews in this day ob- 
serve a secular or civil year beginning in the 
autumn, Tishri being the first month. 


uu Youag’s Concordance, under i es - 
b See NW footnote, 1953 Edit 


18. (a) Why fs the meaning of the Hebrew word for 
“year’’ appropriate? (b) What is the true solar year 
as regards the carth? 


19. (a) How were ancient Bible years reckoned? 
(b) What “sacred year” did Jehovah later decree? 


most nations used lunar years for counting 
time, using various ways of adjusting the year 
to coincide more or less with the solar year. 
The common lunar year of twelve lunar months 
has 354 days, with the months having twenty- 
nine or thirty days, depending on the appear- 
ance of each new moon. The lunar year is 
therefore about eleven days short of the true 
solar year of 365% days. The Hebrews fol- 
lowed the lunar year. Just how they adjusted 
this year to coincide with the solar year and 
the seasons is not explained in the Bible, but 
they must have added additional or intercalary 
months when needed. The arrangement of in- 
tercalary months was later systematized In the 
fifth century B.C.E. into what is now known as 
the Metonic cycle. This allowed for the inter- 
calary month to be added seven times every 
nineteen years, and in the Jewish calendar it 
was added after the twelfth month Adar and 
called V*Adar, or “second Adar.” As the lunar 
calendar is thus adjusted to the sun, the years, 
of twelve or thirteen months, are known as 
“bound years” or “lunisolar years.” 

2 Julian and Gregorian Calendars. A calen- 
dar is a system of fixing the beginning, length 
and divisions of the secular or civil year, and 
arranging these divisions in order. The Julian 
Calendar was introduced by Julius Caesar in 
46 B.C.E., to give the Roman people a solar- 
year time arrangement in place of the lunar 
year. The Julian Calendar consists of 365 days 
in a year, with the exception that on each 
fourth year (“leap year”) one day is added, to 
make it 366 days. However, in the course of 


20. How was the lunar year adjusted to correspond 

with the solar year, and what are “lunisolar yeurs”? 
21, 22. (a) What is the Julian Calendar? (b) Why is 
the orlan Calendar more accurate? (c) What Is 
now the time difference between the two? 


118 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


STUDY TWO—TIME AND THE HOLY SCRIPTURES 


time it was found that the Julian Calendar 
fell behind about one day in each 128 years. 
This was because the Julian Calendar is ac- 
tually 11 minutes longer than the true solar 
year. Thus, in 1582, Pope Gregory XIII intro- 
duced a slight revision, instituting what is now 
known as the Gregorian Calendar. This pro- 
vides that centuries not divisible by 400 are not 
to be considered leap years. For example, no 
day was added in 1900 to make it a leap year, 
but it is planned to add a leap-year day in the 
year 2000, as this is divisible by 400. The 
Gregorian Calendar is now the one in general 
use in Western countries. 


22 Historians usually employ the Julian Cal- 
endar for events prior to the sixteenth century 
of the Common Era, but the Gregorian Calen- 
dar in dating events after A.D. 1600. As an 
illustration, the Memorial of Jesus’ death for 
1963 was celebrated on April 8, 1963, according 
to the Gregorian Calendar, but this same day 
was March 26 according to the Julian Calendar. 
Today, there is a thirteen-day difference be- 
tween the two calendars. 

23 A Bible “Time.” A prophetic “time” in the 
Bible, whether literal or symbolic, is always 
taken as a year of twelve months, each month 
having thirty days, for a total of 360 days. 
Note what one authority says in commenting 
on Ezekiel 4:5 and Daniel 12:11: “We must 
suppose that Ezekiel knew a year of 360 days. 
This is neither a true solar year nor is it a 
lunar year. It is an ‘average’ year in which 
each month has 30 days. .. . The 1290 days in 
Daniel must be interpreted as 314 x 360 days 
+ 30 days (of an intercalary month).”* 

24 A study of Revelation 11:2, 3 and 12:6, 14 
reveals how one “time” is reckoned as 360 days. 

29 No Zero Year. Ancient peoples, including 
the learned Greeks, the Romans and the Jews 
of Jesus’ day, had no conception of a zero. To 
them, everything began from one. When you 
studied Roman numerals at school (I, I, Ill, 
IV, V, X, ete.) did you learn a figure for zero? 
No, because the Romans had none. It was for 
this reason that the Christian era began, not 
with a zero, but with A.D, 1. This also gave 
rise to the ordinal arrangement of numbers, 
such as first (1st), second (2d), third (3d), 
tenth (10th), hundredth (100th), and so forth. 
In modern mathematics, which was largely 
designed by the Arabs, man conceives of every- 
thing as starting from nothing, or zero. The 


23, 24. What Is a prophetic ‘time’? 
25. How did the various ancient peoples start their 
counting? 


281 


A.D. 150, and then introduced by the Arabs into 
Europe some centuries later.” 

2¢Thus it is that whenever ordinal numbers 
are used, we must always subtract one to get 
the full number. For example, this is called the 
twentieth century. Does this mean there have 
been a full twenty centuries? No, it means 
nineteen full centuries plus some years. To ex- 
press full numbers the Bible, as well as mod- 
ern mathematics, has the cardinal numbers, 
such as 1, 2, 3, 10, 100, and so forth. These are 
also called “whole numbers.” 

2* Now, since the Christian era did not begin 
with the year zero, but began with A.D. 1, and 
the calendar for the years before the Christian 
era did not count back from a zero year, but 
began with 1 B.C.E., the figure used for the 
year in any date is in reality an ordinal num- 
ber. That is, A.D. 1960 really represents 1959 
full years since the beginning of the Christian 
era, and the date July 1, 1960, represents 
1959 44 years since the beginning of the Chris- 
tian era. The same principle applies to B.C.E. 
dates. So to figure how many years elapsed 
between October 1, 607 B.C.E., and October 1, 
A.D. 1914, add 606 years (plus the last three 
months of the previous year) to 1913 (plus the 
first nine months of the next year), and the 
result is 2519 (plus twelve months), or 2520 
years. Or if you want to figure what date would 
be 2520 years after October 1, 607 B.C.E., re- 
member that 607 is an ordinal number; it really 
represents 606 full years, and since we are 
counting, not from December 31, 607 B.CE., 
but from October 1, 607 B.C.E., we must add 
to 606 the three months at the end of 607 B.C.E. 
Now subtract 606% from 2520 years. The re 
mainder is 1913 %. That means that 2520 years 
from October 1, 607 B.C.E., takes us 1913 % 
years into the Christian era. Nineteen hundred 
and thirteen full years brings us to the begin- 
ning of A.D. 1914; % of a year in addition 
brings us to October 1, A.D. 1914. 

28 Absolute Dates. Reliable Bible chronology 
is based on certain absolute dates. An absolute 
date is a calendar date that is proved by secu- 
lar history to be the actual date of an event 
recorded in the Bible. It can then be used as 
the starting point from which a series of Bible 
events can be located on the calendar with cer- 


are made from accurate records in the Bible 


b Mathematics fined the Million, 1940, by Lancelot Hog- 
ben, pages 51. . 23. 


26. How do ordinal numbers differ from cardinal num- 
bers? 

27. How would you figure (n) the years from October 1, 
607 B.C.E., to October 1, 1914 A.D.? (b) 2,520 yoars from 
October 1, 607 B.C.E.? 

oe What are absolute ‘dates, and why are they of great 
value? 


119 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


282 


itself, such as the stated life-spans of people, 
or the duration of the reigns of kings. Thus, 
starting from a pegged point, we can use the 
reliable internal chronology of the Bible itself 
in dating many Bible events. 

*% Absolute Date for the Hebrew 
A prominent event recorded both in the Bible 
and in pagan secular history is the overthrow 
of the city of Babylon by the Medes and Per- 
sians under Cyrus. The Bible records this event 
at Daniel 5:30. The pagan record was made 
by King Nabonidus, and it has been dated by 
him in what is known as the Nabonidus 
Chronicle, discovered in 1879 and now pre- 
served in the British Museum, London.* Mod- 
ern authorities have set this absolute date for 
the fall of Babylon as October 11-12, 539 B.C_E., 
according to the Julian Calendar, or October 5-6 
by the Gregorian Calendar. (Like the Hebrew 
day, the Babylonian day began at 6 p.m.)* 

*° Following the overthrow of Babylon, as 
the Bible record shows, “Darius the Mede him- 
self received the kingdom.” And since Daniel 
refers to “the first year of Darius,” the in- 
ference is that he was king for at least one 
full year. (Dan. 5:31; 9:1) But apparently by 
late in 538 B.C.E. Cyrus acceded to the throne, 
and during his first year, at least before spring 
of 537 B.C.E., he issued his famous edict, or 
decree, permitting the Jews to return to Jeru- 
salem to rebuild the house of Jehovah. This 
would give ample opportunity for the Jews to 
resettle in their homeland, and to come up to 
Jerusalem to restore the worship of Jehovah 
in “the seventh month,” or about October 1, 
537 B.C.E.—Ezra 1:1-3; 3:16. 

* Absolute Date for the Christian Greek 
Scriptures. An absolute date for the Christian 
Greek Scriptures is determined by Tiberius 
Caesar’s succession to Emperor Augustus. This 
was August 19, A.D. 14, according to the Julian 
Calendar. It is stated in Luke 3:1, 3 that John 
the Baptist began his ministry in the fifteenth 
year of Tiberius’ reign. From the absolute date 
we can therefore calculate the fifteenth year 
of Tiberius’ actual rule to have run from 
August 19, A.D. 28, to August 18, A.D. 29. Soon 
after this, Jesus, who was about six months 
younger than John the Baptist, came to be 
baptized, when he was “about thirty years old.” 
(Luke 3:2, 21-23; 1:34-38) This agrees with the 
fact that, according to Daniel 9:25, sixty-nine 


a See Study 9, paragraphs 17, 18. 
b Babylonian Chronology, 1956, 
stein, pages 13, 14, 29. 


29. What absolute date is provided for the Hebrew 
Scriptures? 

30. When was Cyrus’ decree issued, allowing oppor- 
tunity for what? 

SL. does an absolute date along with fulfilled 
prenieey fix the time of Jesus’ baptism, and of his 


Parker and Dubber- 


“ALL SCRIPTURE IS INSPIRED OF GOD AND BENEFICIAL” 


“weeks” (prophetic “weeks” of seven years 
each, thus totaling 483 years) would elapse 
after the decree was issued for the rebuilding 
of Jerusalem with its wall until the appearance 
of Messiah. That decree was issued by Arta- 
xerxes I in 455 B.C.E., taking effect in the 
latter part of that year. And 483 years later, 
in the latter part of A.D. 29, when Jesus was 
baptized by John he was also anointed by holy 
spirit from God, thus becoming the Messiah 
or Anointed One. That Jesus was baptized and 
began his ministry in the latter part of the 
year also agrees with the fact that he was to 
be cut off “at the half of the week” (or after 
three and a half years). (Dan. 9:27) Since he 
died in the spring, his ministry of three and a 
half years must have begun toward the fall of 
A.D. 29. Incidentally, these two lines of evi- 
dence also prove that Jesus was born in the 
autumn of 2 B.C.E., and not, as some com- 
mentators say, several years before that, since 
Luke 3:23 shows that Jesus was about thirty 
years of age when he commenced his work. 

32 How Time Moves Faster. There is an old 
saying that “a watched kettle never boils.” It 
is true that when we are watching time, when 
we are conscious of it, when we are waiting 
for something to happen, then it passes ever 
so slowly. However, if we are busy, if we are 
interested and preoccupied in what we are 
doing, then it really appears that “time files.” 
Moreover, with old people, time seems to pass 
much more quickly than with young people. 
Why is this? One year added to the life of a 
one-year-old means a 100-percent increase in 
life’s experiences. One year added to the life of 
a fifty-year-old means just 2 percent more. To 
the child, a year seems a long, long time. The 
older person, if busy and in good health, finds 
the years flying faster and faster. He comes to 
a deeper understanding of Solomon’s words: 
“There is nothing new under the sun.” On the 
other hand, young people still have the slower, 
formative years with them. Instead of “striving 
after wind” with a materialistic world, they 
may use these years profitably in piling up a 
wealth of godly experience. Timely are Solo- 
mon’s further words: “Remember, now, your 
grand Creator in the days of your young man- 
hood, before the calamitous days proceed to 
come, or the years have arrived when you will 
say: ‘I have no delight in them.’ "—Eccl. 1:9, 
14; 12:1. 

%8 Time when Living Forever. However, there 
are joyous days ahead that will be far from 
calamitous. Lovers of righteousness, whose 
‘times are in Jehovah's hand,’ may look for- 


=. (@ (a) Why Goes the speed of time appear to vary? 
> ae mer SS ee do young ona ays therefore have? 


ate more fully 
Jehovah's ioe of time time? 


120 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


STUDY THREE—MEASURING EVENTS IN THE STREAM OF TIME 


ward to everlasting life in the realm of God's 
kingdom. (Ps. 31:14-16; Matt. 25:34, 46) Under 
the Kingdom, death will be no more. (Rev. 21: 
4) Idleness, illness, boredom and vanity will 
have vanished. There will be work to do, ab- 
sorbing and intriguing, challenging man's per- 
fect abilities, and bringing intense satisfaction 
in accomplishment. The years will seem to 
flow faster and faster, and appreciative and 
retentive minds will be continually enriched 
with memories of happy events. As millen- 
niums pass, humans on this earth will no doubt 
come to appreciate more fully Jehovah’s view 


Study Three— 
Measuring Events 


N GIVING Daniel the vision of the “king of 

the north” and the “king of the south,” Je- 
hovah’s angel several times used the expression 
“the time appointed.” (Dan. 11:27, 29, 35) There 
are many other scriptures, too, that indicate 
Jehovah is an accurate timekeeper, who ac- 
complishes his purposes exactly on time. (Luke 
21:24; 1 Thess. 5:1, 2) In his Word the Bible 
he has provided a number of “guideposts” that 
help us locate important happenings in the 
stream of time. In recent years much progress 
has been made in the understanding of Bible 
chronology. Archaeological and other research 
continues to shed light on various problems, 
enabling us to determine the timing of key 
events of the Bible record.—Prov. 4:18. 

2 Ordinal and Cardinal Numbers. In the pre- 
vious study (paragraphs 25 and 26) we learned 
that there is a difference between cardinal 
numbers and ordinal numbers, Now, let us 
apply this understanding to Jeremiah 52:31. 
Here it speaks of “the thirty-seventh year of 
the exile of Jehoiachin the king of Judah.” 
Note that “thirty-seventh” is an ordinal num- 
ber. This indicates thirty-six full years plus 
some months. The exile of Jehoiachin began 
early in the year 617 B.C.E. The thirty-seventh 
year began, not after thirty-seven years had 
passed, but after thirty-six full years had 
elapsed, or early in the year 581. However, it 
is noted that the event spoken of in this verse 


1. (a) What indicates that Jehovah is an accurate time- 


ing Bible chronology? 
2. Give an example of reckoning with ordinal numbers. 


in the Stream of Time 


283 


of time: ‘For a thousand years in Jehovah's 
os are but as yesterday when it is past.'—Ps. 

34 Viewing the stream of time from our pres- 
ent human standpoint, and taking into account 
God's promise of a new world of righteousness, 
how joyous in prospect are the blessings of 
that day: “For there Jehovah commanded the 
blessing to be, even life to time indefinite”! 
—Ps. 133:3. 


34. With regard to time, what blessing has Jehovah 
commanded ? 


The counting of time in Bible days, 
and a discussion of the chronology 
of outstanding events of both the 
Hebrew and Greek Scriptures. 


occurred “in the twelfth month, on the twenty- 
fifth day of the month,” or almost a full year 
after the beginning of the thirty-seventh year. 
Since this year began early in 581, the twelfth 
month would carry us over into the early part 
of 580 B.C.E. (In contrast to the ordinal num- 
ber thirty-seventh, thirty-six is used as a car- 
dinal number. It does not end with “th,” and so 
represents a full thirty-six.) 

*Regnal and Accession Years. The Bible 
refers to state records of the governments 
of Judah and Israel, as well as to state matters 
of Babylon and Persia. In all four of these 
kingdoms, state chronology was accurately 
reckoned according to the rulerships of the 
kings, and the same system of reckoning has 
been carried over into the Bible. Very often the 
Bible gives the name of the document quoted, 
as, for example, “the book of the affairs of 
Solomon.” (1 Ki. 11:41) The reign of a king 
would cover part of an accession year, to be 
followed by a complete number of regnal years. 
In all these countries the regnal years were the 
official years in the kingship, and were gen- 
erally counted from Nisan to Nisan, or from 
spring to spring. When a king succeeded to 
the throne, the intervening months until the 
next spring month of Nisan were referred to 
as his accession year, during which he filled out 
the regnal term of rulership for his prede- 
cessor. However, his own official regnal term 
was counted as beginning on the next Nisan 1. 
3. (a) What state records assist In reckoning Bible 


dates? (b) How were regnal and accession years ob- 
served in ancient times? 


121 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


284 


*As an example, it appears that Solomon 
had an accession year starting sometime before 
Nisan of 1037 B.C.E., while David was still 
living. Shortly afterward David died. (1 Ki. 1: 
39, 40; 2:10) However, David's last regnal year 
continued down to the spring of 1037 B.C.E., 
still being counted as part of his forty years’ 
administration. Solomon had an accession year 
lasting until the spring of 1037 B.C.E., and 
this could not be counted as a regnal year, as 
he was still filling out his father’s term 
of administration. Therefore Solomon's first 
full regnal year did not begin until Nisan, 
1037 B.C.E. (1 Ki. 2:12) Eventually, forty full 
regnal years were credited to Solomon’s ad- 
ministration as king. (1 Ki. 11:42) By keeping 
the regnal years apart from accession years in 
this way, it is possible to calculate Bible chro- 
nology accurately. 


COUNTING BACK TO ADAM'S CREATION 

* Starting from the Absolute Date. The abso- 
lute date for this calculation is that of Cy- 
rus’ overthrow of the Babylonian dynasty, 
539 B.C.E.* Cyrus issued his decree of libera- 
tion for the Jews during his first year, be- 
fore spring of 537 B.C.E. Ezra 3:1 reports 
that the sons of Israel were back in Jerusalem 
by the seventh month, or the early autumn. 
So the autumn of 537 is reckoned for the date 
of the restoration of Jehovah's 
Jerusalem. 

*This restoration of Jehovah's worship in 
the autumn of 537 marked the end of a pro- 
phetic period. What period? It was the “seventy 
years” during which the Promised Land “must 
become a devastated place,” and concerning 
which Jehovah also said, “In accord with the 
fulfilling of seventy years at Babylon I shall 
turn my attention to you people, and I will 
establish toward you my good word in bringing 
you back to this place.” (Jer. 25:11, 12; 29:10) 
Daniel, who was well acquainted with this 
prophecy, acted in harmony with it as the 
“seventy years” drew to a close. (Dan. 9:1-3) 
The “seventy years” that ended in the autumn 
of the year 537 must have begun, then, in the 
autumn of 607 B.C.E. The facts bear this out. 
Jeremiah chapter 52 describes the momentous 
events of the siege of Jerusalem, the Babylo- 
nian breakthrough and the capture of King 
Zedekiah, 607 B.C.E. Then, as verse 12 states, 
“in the fifth month, on the tenth day,” that 
is, Ab 10, the Babylonians burned the temple 


a Study 2, paragraphs 29, 30. 


worship in 


4, Show how Bible chronology may be counted ac- 
cording to regnal years. 

5. How Is the date for the restoration reckoned? 

.. What foretold period ended In the autumn of 


(a) 
? (>) When must Cir period have begun, and how 
one facts support this 


“ALL SCRIPTURE IS INSPIRED OF GOD AND BENEFICIAL" 


and the city. However, this was not yet the 
starting point of the “seventy years.” Some 
vestige of Jewish sovereignty still remained 
in the person of Gedaliah, whom the king of 
Babylon had a geen as governor of the 
remaining Jewish settlements. “In the seventh 
month" Gedaliah and some others were assas- 
sinated, so that the Jews fled in fear 
to Egypt. Then only, from about October 1, 
607, was the land in the complete sense “lying 
desolated . . . to fulfill seventy years."—2 Ki. 
25:22-26; 2 Chron. 36:20, 21. 

? From 607 to 9987 B.C.E. The calculation for 
this period back from the fall of Jerusalem to 
the time of the division of the kingdom after 
Solomon's death presents many difficulties. 
However, a comparison of the reigns of the 
kings of Israel and of Judah as recorded in 
First and Second Kings indicates that this 
time period covers 390 years. A strong evi- 
dence that this is the correct figure is the 
prophecy of Ezekiel 4:1-13. As shown in this 
prophecy itself, it is pointing to the time when 
Jerusalem would be besieged and its inhab- 
itants taken captive by the nations, which oc- 
curred in 607 B.C.E. So the forty years spoken 
of in the case of Judah terminated with Jeru- 
salem’s desolation, The 390 years spoken of in 
the case of Israel did not end when Samaria 
was destroyed, because that was long past 
when Ezekiel prophesied, and the prophecy 
plainly says that it is pointing to the siege and 
destruction of Jerusalem, So it, too, terminated 
in 607 B.C.E. Counting back from this date, 
we see that the “error of the house of Israel” 
began in 997 B.C.E. It was in that year, then, 
that Jeroboam, on the death of Solomon, broke 
with the house of David and “proceeded to part 
Israel from following Jehovah, and he caused 
them to sin with a great sin.”—2 KI. 17:21. 

8 From 997 to 1513 B.C.E. Since the last of 
Solomon's forty full regnal years ended in the 
spring of 997, it follows that his first regnal 
year must have commenced in the spring of 
1037 B.C.E. (1 Ki. 11:42) The Bible record says 
that Solomon began to build the house of Je- 
hovah in Jerusalem in the second month of the 
fourth year of his reign. This means three full 
years and one complete month of his reign had 
elapsed, bringing us to April-May, 1034 B.C.E., 
for the start of the temple building. However, 
the same scripture at 1 Kings 6:1 states that 
this was also “the four hundred and eightieth 
year after the sons of Israel came out from 
the land of Egypt.” Again, 480th is an ordi- 
nal number, aR, 479 complete years. 
7. (a) How may years be calculated back to Solo- 
mon's death? (b) Wiad acs support is supplied by Exzcklel's 
prophecy? 

8. (a) How are the years then reckoned back to the 


exodus? (b) What change affects Bible chronology 
about this time? 


122 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


STUDY THREE—MEASURING EVENTS IN THE STREAM OF TIME 


Hence, 479 added to 1034 gives the date 
1513 B.C.E. as the year that Israel came out 
of Egypt.* Paragraph 19 of Study Two explains 
how from the year 1513 B.C.E. Abib (Nisan) 
was to be reckoned as “the first of the months 
of the year” for Israel (Ex. 12:2), and that 
previously a year beginning in the autumn, 
with the month Tishri, was followed. The 
New Schaff-Herzog Encyclopedia of Religious 
Knowledge, 1957, Vol. 12, page 474, comments: 
“The reckoning of the regnal years of the 
kings is based upon the year which began in 
the spring, and is parallel to the Babylonian 
method in which this prevailed.” Whenever the 
change, from commencing the year from the 
autumn to commencing the year from the 
spring, began to be applied to periods of time 
in the Bible, this would involve a loss or gain 
of six months somewhere in the counting of 
time. 

®*From 1513 to 1943 B.C.E. At Exodus 12: 
40, 41, Moses records that “the dwelling of the 
sons of Israel, who had dwelt in Egypt, was 
four hundred and years.” From the 
above wording it is apparent that not all this 
“dwelling” was in Egypt. This time period be- 
gins with Abraham's departure from Haran 
for Canaan, at which time Jehovah's covenant 
with Abraham went into effect. The first 215 
years of this “dwelling” was in Canaan, and 
then an equal period was spent in Egypt, 
until Israel became completely independent 
of all Egyptian control and dependency, in 
1513 B.C.E The New World Translation foot- 
note (1953 Edition) on Exodus 12:40 shows that 
the Samaritan Pentateuch and the Septuagint, 
both of which are based on Hebrew texts older 
than the Masoretic, add the words “and in the 
land of Canaan” to “Egypt.” Galatians 3:17, 
which also mentions the 430 years, confirms 
that this period started with the making of the 
Abrahamic covenant, at the time that Abraham 
moved into Canaan. This was therefore in 
1943 B.C.E., when Abraham was seventy-five 
years old.—Gen. 12:4. 

‘Another line of evidence supports the 
above reckoning: At Acts 7:6 mention is made 
of the seed of Abraham as being afflicted four 
hundred years. Since Jehovah removed the af- 
fliction by Egypt in 1513 B.C.E., the beginning 
n The Watchtower, 1948, pages 92-94, 

b From Abraham's leaving Haran to Isaac's birth Is 
25 years: then to Jacob's birth, 60 years; Jacob was 


130 years ag een he went Gown to Egypt.—Gon. 12:4; 
21:5: 25:26; 


9. (a) How Is the record dated back to the Abrahamic 
covenant? (b) How are the first 215 yoars of this 
egret ue ted for? (c) How old was Abraham when 
10, What other line of evidence supports the chronology 
of Abraham's time? 


285 


of affliction must have been in 1913 B.C.E. 
This was five years after the birth of Isaac, 
and corresponds with Ishmael’s “poking fun” 
at Isaac on the occasion of his weaning.—Gen. 
15:13; 21:8, 9. 

1From 1943 to 2370 B.C.E. We have seen 
that Abraham was seventy-five years old when 
he entered Canaan in 1943 B.C.E. Now it is 
possible to date the stream of time farther 
back, to the days of Noah. This is done by use 
of the time periods supplied for us in Genesis 
11:10 to 12:4. This reckoning, which gives a 
total of 427 years, is made as follows: 


From the beginning of the 
Flood to Arpachshad’s birth 2 years 
Then to the birth of Shelah 
To the birth of Eber 
To the birth of Peleg 
To the birth of Reu 
To the birth of Serug 
To the birth of Nahor 
To the birth of Terah 
To the death of Terah, when 
Abraham was 75 years old 205 “ 


Total 427 years 


BSRSESE 


Adding 427 years to 1943 B.C.E. brings us to 
2370 B.C.E. Thus the timetable of the Bible 
shows that the flood of Noah's day began in 
2370 B.CLE. 

12From 2370 to 4026 B.C.E. Going still far- 
ther back in the stream of time, we find that 
the Bible dates the period from the Flood all 
the way to Adam's creation. This is determined 
by Genesis 5:3-29; 7:11, and the time count is 
summarized below: 


From Adam's creation to 
the birth of Seth 

Then to the birth of Enosh 10 “ 

To the birth of Kenan 90 

To the birth of Mahalalel 7 = 


To the birth of Jared me = 
To the birth of Enoch 162 “ 
To the birth of Methuselah aS = 
To the birth of Lamech a by ied 
To the birth of Noah 182 “* 
To the Flood 600 “ 
Total 1,656 years 


Adding 1,656 years to our previous date of 
2370, we arrive at 4026 B.C.E. for the creation 
of Adam, perhaps in the fall, since it is in the 
fall that the year began on the most ancient 
calendars. 

11. How does the. Bible timetable carry us back to the 


date of the Floo 
12. What is the tone count back to Adain’'s creation? 


123 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


STUDY NINE—ARCHAEOLOGY 


hold out against Nebuchadnezzar, being re- 
duced to a pile of charred ruins in 609- 
607 B.C.E. The letters reflect the urgency 
of the times. They appear to be letters 
written from remaining outposts of Judean 
troops to Ya’‘osh, a military commander at 
Lachish. One of these reads in part: “May 
YHWH ([Tetragrammaton, Jehovah] let ind 
lord hear even now tidings of good. 

are watching for the signal- tations of Lachiuh, 
according to all the signs which my lord gives, 
because we do not see Azekah.” This is a 
striking confirmation of Jeremiah 34:7, 
which mentions Lachish and Azekah as 
the last two fortified cities left remain- 
ing. According to this letter, Azekah 
had now fallen. The divine name, 
in the form of the tetragramma- 
ton, appears frequently in the 
letters, showing that the Jews 
were not at that time averse 
to using the name. 

2 Another letter com- 
mences as follows: “May 
the Lord [YHWH) 
cause my lord to hear 
tidings of peace! ... 
And it hath been re- 
ported to thy servant 
saying, ‘The com- 
mander of the host, 
Coniah son of Elnathan, 
hath come down in or- 
der to go into Egypt and 
unto Hodaviah son of Ahi- 
jah and his men hath he 
sent to obtain [supplies] 
from him.’” This letter con- 
firms that Judah went down 
to Egypt for assistance, in 
violation of Jehovah's com- 
mand, and to her own de- 
struction. (Isa. 31:1; Jer. 46:25, 26) The El- 
nathan of this letter may be the one mentioned 
at Jeremiah 36:12. Hoshaiah is named as the 
writer of one of these letters, and may be the 
Hoshaiah of Jeremiah 42:1 and 43:2. Three 
other persons referred to in the letters appear 
to be mentioned in the Bible book of Jeremiah. 
They are Gemariah (36:10), Neriah (32:12) and 
Jaazaniah (35:3). Thus, in many respects, the 
Lachish Letters give striking support to Jere- 
miah’s writings in the Bible.« 

27 The Nabonidus Chronicle. In the latter half 
of the nineteenth century excavations near 
modern Baghdad produced many finds of clay 


a & seme from the Ancient Past, pages 160-162; The Bible 
and Archaeology, pages 195-197. 


17,18 What does the Nabonidus Chronicle describe, 
and why Is it of special value? 


 Nabonidus Chronic 
(Courtesy or’ tne Trustees of the British Museum) 


SUPPORTS THE INSPIRED RECORD 335 
tablets and cylinders that threw much light 
on the history of ancient Babylon. One of 
these was the very valuable document known 
as the Nabonidus Chronicle, or Nabunaid 
Chronicle, which is now in the British Museum. 
King Nabonidus of Babylon was the father 
of his coregent Belshazzar. He outlived his 
son, who was killed on the night that troops 
of Cyrus the Persian took Babylon, October 
5-6, 539 B.C.E. (Dan. 5:30, 31) Nabonidus’ re- 
markably well-dated record of the fall of Bab- 
ylon is our means of establishing on what day 
this event occurred. Following 
is a translation of a small 
part of the Nabonidus 
Chronicle: “In the month 
of Tashritu [Tishri, He 
brew 7th month], when 
Cyrus attacked the army 
of Akkad in Opis on the 
Tigris . . . the 15th 
day, Sippar was 
seized without battle. 
Nabonidus fled. The 
16th day [October 11- 
12, 539 B.C.E., Julian 
or October 5-6, Gre 
gorian] Gobryas 
(Ugbaru), the gover- 
nor of Gutium and 
the army of Cyrus 
entered Babylon 
without battle. After- 
wards Nabonidus 
was arrested in Bab- 
ylon when he re 
turned (there). ... 
In the month of 
Arahshmanu [Hesh- 
van, Hebrew 8th 
month], the 3rd day 
[October 28-29, Jul- 
jan), Cyrus entered Babylon, green twigs 
were spread in front of him—the state of 
‘Peace’ (Sulmu) was imposed upon the city. 
Cyrus sent greetings to all Babylon. Gobryas, 
his governor, installed (sub-) governors in Bab- 
ylon. . . . In the month of Arahshmanu on 
the night of the 11th day [November 5-6, 539 
B.C.E., Julian) Gobryas died.” 
8It may be noted that Darius the Mede is 
not mentioned in this chronicle, and, thus far, 
no mention has been found of this Darius in 
any historical document outside the Bible. Some 
have therefore suggested that he might be the 
Gobryas mentioned in the above account, but 
there is objection to this. In any event, secu- 
lar history definitely establishes that Cyrus 


b Ancient be to the Old 
Testament, 1955, J. B. Pritchard, es 305-307. 


124 


Appendix E: Selected pages from SI 


336 


was a key figure in the conquest of Babylon 
and that he thereafter ruled there as king. 

19The Cyrus Cylinder. Some time after he 
began ruling as king of the Persian world 
power, Cyrus recorded on a clay cylinder his 
capture of Babylon in 539 B.C.E., mentioning 
also some of the evils that he corrected there. 
This outstanding document was found at the 
ancient site of Sippar, on the Euphrates and 
about twenty miles from Baghdad, and Is also 
preserved in the British Museum. A part of 
the translated text follows: “I am Cyrus, king 
of the world, the great king, the powerful 
king, king of Babylon, king of Sumer and Ak- 
kad, king of the four quarters of the world . . 
When I made my triumphal entrance into 
Babylon, with joy and rejoicing I took up my 
lordly residence in the royal palace, Marduk, 
the great lord, moved the noble heart of the 
inhabitants of Babylon to me, while I gave 
daily care to his worship. My numerous troops 
marched peacefully into Babylon. . .. The 
needs of Babylon and all its cities I gladly 
took heed to... the gods, who dwelt in them, 
I brought them back to their places, and caused 
them to dwell in a habitation for all time. 
All their inhabitants I collected and restored 
them to their dwelling places. ... May all 
the gods, whom I brought into their cities pray 
daily for long life for me.’ 

*°The Cyrus Cylinder thus makes known 
the king's policy of restoring captive peoples 
and their gods to their former places, in har- 
mony with which he issued his decree for the 
Jews to return to Jerusalem and rebuild the 
house of Jehovah there. Once again the Bible 
stands vindicated as true, this time by the 
testimony of Cyrus, whom Jehovah had fore- 
told by name two hundred years previously 
as the one who would take Babylon and bring 
about the restoration of Jehovah's people.—Isa. 
44:28; 45:1; 2 Chron. 36:23. 


ARCHAEOLOGY AND THE CHRISTIAN GREEK 
SCRIPTURES 

*1As with the Hebrew Scriptures, so with 
the Christian Greek Scriptures, archaeology 
has brought to light many interesting artifacts 
in support of the inspired record. 

22. Denarius Coin with Tiberius’ Inscription. 
The Bible shows clearly that Jesus’ ministry 
took place during the rule of Tiberius Caesar. 
(Luke 3:1) Some of Jesus’ opposers tried to 


a Cuneiform Parallels to the Old Testament, 1912, R. W. 
Rogers, pages 380-383. 


19. Where was the Cyrus Cylinder found, where Is it 
preserved, and what is recorded on it? 
oe does this harmonize with and vindicate the 
e? 
21. What does archaeology have to tell us in connection 
age the Greek Scriptures? 
. How does archaeology support Jesus’ discussion of 
rca tax question? 


“ALL SCRIPTURE IS INSPIRED OF GOD AND BENEFICIAL" 


trap him on the matter of paying head tax 
to Caesar. The record reads: “Detecting their 
hypocrisy, he said to them: ‘Why do you put 
me to the test? Bring me a denarius to look 
at.’ They brought one. And he said to them: 
‘Whose image and inscription is this?’ They 
said to him: ‘Caesar’s.’ Jesus then said: ‘Pay 
back Caesar’s things to Caesar, but God’s 
things to God.’ And they began to marvel at 
him.” (Mark 12:15-17) Now, archaeology has 
come up with a silver denarius coin, bearing 
the head of Tiberius Caesar! It was put in 
circulation A.D. 15.° This is consistent with 
Tiberius’ ruling as emperor from August 19, 
A.D. 14, and brings added confirmation to the 
record stating that John the Baptist’s ministry 
commenced in the fifteenth year of Tiberlus, 
or the spring of A.D. 29.—Luke 3:1, 2. 

28 Pontius Pilate Inscription. It was in 1961 
that the first archaeological find was made 
with reference to Pontius Pilate. This was a 
stone slab located at Caesarea, which bore 
the Latin names Pontius Pilatus and Tiberius. 

2¢The Areopagus. Paul delivered one of his 
most famous recorded speeches in Athens, 
Greece, A.D. 50. (Acts 17:1634) This was on 
the occasion when he was brought to the Are- 
opagus before the council composed of city 
fathers. The Areopagus, or Hill of Ares (“Mars 
Hill”), is the name of a bare, rocky hill, about 
370 feet high, immediately northwest of the 
Acropolis of Athens. Steps cut in the rock 
lead to the top, where rough, rock-hewn bench- 
es, forming three sides of a square, can still 
be seen. The Areopagus still remains, to con- 
firm the Bible's recorded setting for Paul's 
historic speech. 

*5 The Arch of Titus. Jerusalem and its tem- 
ple were destroyed by the Romans under Ti- 
tus, A.D. 70. The next year, in Rome, Titus 
celebrated his triumph, together with his 
father, Emperor Vespasian. Seven hundred 
Jewish prisoners were marched in the trium- 
phal procession. Loads of the spoils of war 
were also paraded, including temple treasures. 
Titus himself became emperor, from A.D. 79 
to 81, and after his death a large monument, 
the Arch of Titus, was completed and dedi- 
cated divo Tito (“to the deified Titus”). His 
triumphant procession is represented in bas- 
relief, carved on each side of the passage 
through the Arch. On the one side there are 
depicted the Roman soldiers, without weapons 


b Harper’s Bible Dictionary, 1952, pages 456, 753, 
e The a Bible Dictionary, 1962, J. D. Douglas, 
page 


agg find has been made with reference to Pontius 
te? 

24. What still remains to confirm the setting of Acts 
AGU? 

25. To what does the Arch of Titus continue to testify. 
and how? 


125 


APPENDIX F: SELECTED PAGES FROM THE BOOK 
“BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!” (1963 EDITION) 


—. — me ee 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


A SMALL-SCALE KINGDOM OF GOD BEGINS 101 


tion, Ophel was, of course, walled in also and was 
fortified. Jehovah’s temple would therefore be on a 
lofty elevation, over 2,400 feet above the level of the 
Mediterranean Sea, and from any direction the wor- 
shipers would have to go up to it—Psalm 122:1-4; 
Isaiah 2:2. 

To prevent his ambitious fourth son Adonijah from 
taking over the throne, the aged King David had his 
beloved son Solomon suddenly anointed as king at 
Gihon, a well just outside the eastern wall of Zion, the 
City of David. (1 Kings 1:1-40) Later, after King Da- 
vid had given his final instructions concerning the 
building of God’s temple on Mount Moriah, all the 
people who were assembled at the capital city “pro- 
ceeded a second time to make Solomon the son of David 
king and to anoint him to Jehovah as leader and also 
Zadok as priest.” David’s death is reported as occurring 
shortly after this. (1 Chronicles 28:1; 29:20-28) Thus 
began the forty-year rule of Solomon as king, sitting 
on “Jehovah’s throne” in the City of David on Mount 
Zion, in 1037 B.C. 


TEMPLE REPLACES TABERNACLE 


In the spring of the fourth year of Solomon’s reign 
he began to build Jehovah’s temple, not in the City 
of David on Mount Zion, but to the north on Mount 
Moriah. This action was said to be “in the four hundred 
and eightieth year after the sons of Israel came out 
from the land of Egypt, in the fourth year, in the 
month of Ziv, that is, the second month, after Solomon 
became king over Israel.” That would be in 1034 B.C. 
(1 Kings 6:1) Because of all the advance preparation 
the temple building proceeded with noteworthy ease. 
At the end of seven and a half years of work this costly 
temple, which was built on a grander scale than the 
tabernacle built by Moses in the wilderness of Sinai, 
was completed. During all this time Jehovah’s ark of 


127 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


126 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI™ 


Jerusalem, and he pleased Pharaoh of Egypt by being 
against Babylon. (2 Chronicles 36:1-5; 2 Kings 23:30- 
37) Like his brother Jehoahaz he was a bad king. 

At the beginning of King Jehoiakim's rule the proph- 
et Jeremiah stood in the courtyard of Jehovah’s temple 
and predicted that Jehovah would make that magnif- 
icent house like the tabernacle set up in the city of 
Shiloh, forever bereft of the sacred ark of God's cove- 
nant. The priests, prophets and people considered this 
treason and laid hold of Jeremiah, saying: “You will 
positively die. Why is it that you have prophesied in 
the name of Jehovah, saying, ‘Like that in Shiloh is 
how this house will become, and this very city will be 
devastated so as to be without an inhabitant’?” Before 
the princes of Judah Jeremiah made his defense, but 
they found no basis for putting him to death. “It was 
the hand of Ahikam the son of Shaphan that proved 
to be with Jeremiah, in order not to give him into the 
hand of the people to have him put to death.” So Jere- 
ara laa free, for the time being.—Jeremiah 26:1-24; 
7:1 


THE SYMBOLIC “CUP OF THE WINE OF RAGE” 

In the fourth year of the reign of King Jehoiakim of 
Judah, or in 625 B.C., Nebuchadnezzar became king of 
Babylon, to become the greatest king of this the Third 
World Power. In that same year Nebuchadnezzar de- 
feated Pharaoh Nechoh the king of Egypt in battle 
at Carchemish by the Euphrates River. (Jeremiah 46: 
1, 2) After that he pushed Pharaoh Nechoh all the way 
into Egypt, for we read: “And never again did the king 
of Egypt come out from his land, for the king of Bab- 
ylon had taken all that happened to belong to the king 
of Egypt from the torrent valley of Egypt up to the 
river Euphrates.” (2 Kings 24:7) In the year of this 
event, also, Jeremiah gave his prophecy concerning 
the executional work that Nebuchadnezzar would do 
as the “servant” or instrument of Jehovah, whose time 


128 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


ZION CLASHES WITH BABYLON 127 


had come for executing judgment upon evildoers. 
—Jeremiah 25:8, 9. 

Jeremiah foretold a seventy-year-long desolation of 
Jerusalem and the land of Judah. He said: “Therefore 
this is what Jehovah of armies has said, ‘For the 
reason that you did not obey my words, here I am 
sending and I will take all the families of the north,” 
is the utterance of Jehovah, “even sending to Nebu- 
chadrezzar the king of Babylon, my servant, and I will 
bring them against this land and against its inhabitants 
and against all these nations round about; and I will 
devote them to destruction and make them an object 
of astonishment and something to whistle at and places 
devastated to time indefinite. And I will destroy out of 
them the sound of exultation and the sound of rejoicing, 
the voice of the bridegroom and the voice of the bride, 
the sound of the hand mill and the light of the lamp. 
And all this land must become a devastated place, an 
object of astonishment, and these nations will have to 
serve the king of Babylon seventy years.”’ ” (Jeremiah 
25:1-11) Thus, while the land of Judah lay uninhabited 
seventy years, the whole nation was to serve the kings 
of Babylon. 

Jehovah then likened King Nebuchadnezzar to a 
drinking cup. He likened his own rage against the con- 
demned nations to wine, which he would make them 
drink by means of the symbolic cup, Nebuchadnezzar. 
Jeremiah goes on to say: “This is what Jehovah the 
God of Israel said to me: ‘Take this cup of the wine 
of rage out of my hand, and you must make all the 
nations to whom I am sending you drink it. And they 
must drink and shake back and forth and act like 
crazed men because of the sword [of Nebuchadnezzar ] 
that I am sending among them.’ ”’ 

In a symbolic way, that is, by prophesying, Jeremiah 
passed the cup to the nations, making them drink the 
prophetic message before drinking its fulfillment: “T 
proceeded to take the cup out of the hand of Jehovah 


129 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


ZION CLASHES WITH BABYLON 133 


against him. And Jehovah began to send against him 
marauder bands of Chaldeans and marauder bands of 
Syrians and marauder bands of Moabites and marauder 
bands of the sons of Ammon, and he kept sending them 
against Judah to destroy it, according to Jehovah's 
word that he had spoken by means of his servants the 
prophets. It was only by the order of Jehovah that it 
took place against Judah, to remove it from his sight 
for the sins of Manasseh, according to all that he had 
done; and also for the innocent blood that he had shed, 
so that he filled Jerusalem with innocent blood, and 
Jehovah did not consent to grant forgiveness. As for 
the rest of the affairs of Jehoiakim and all that he did, 
are they not written in the book of the affairs of the 
days of the kings of Judah? Finally Jehoiakim lay 
down with his forefathers, and Jehoiachin his son 
began to reign in place of him.”—2 Kings 24:1-6. 

Those words in 2 Kings 24:1-6 must not be misread. 
They do not say that Nebuchadnezzar came up against 
King Jehoiakim at Jerusalem in the first year of Je- 
hoiakim’s reign (628 B.C.) and made him tributary to 
Babylon. They do not say that Jehoiakim continued as 
a vassal to Babylon for the first three years of his reign 
and then rebelled against the king of Babylon in the 
fourth year of his reign and kept up this rebellion for 
eight years, till the eleventh and final year of his reign. 
This could not be the case, for in the ninth month of 
the fifth year of Jehoiakim’s reign Jeremiah 36:9, 29 
speaks of Babylon's king as yet to come into the land 
of Judah to ruin it. So, if King Jehoiakim was “servant 
for three years” to the king of Babylon and then re- 
belled, these must have been the last three years of 
King Jehoiakim’s reign of eleven years. 

In view of this, it must have been toward the end of 
the eighth year of Jehoiakim’s reign at Jerusalem that 
Nebuchadnezzar came to Jerusalem for the first time 
and made King Jehoiakim his vassal. Hence the ninth 
year of Jehoiakim’s reign at Jerusalem, or 620 B.C., 


130 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


134 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!" 


was the first year of his vassalage to Babylon. In the 
third year after that, the third year of Jehoiakim’s 
vassalage, he rebelled and stopped paying tribute to 
Babylon. For this reason Nebuchadnezzar came against 
Jerusalem the second time, to punish the rebel king. 
That was in 618 B.C.—See Harper’s Bible Dictionary, 
by M. S. and J. L. Miller, edition of 1952, page 306, 
under “Jehoiakim.” 

However, Nebuchadnezzar never did take King Je- 
hoiakim alive. Jehoiakim did not make peace with 
Nebuchadnezzar or surrender to him but died inside 
Jerusalem. How, the Bible does not disclose. He was 
not given an honorable burial, to fulfill Jehovah's pre- 
diction: “With the burial of a he-ass he will be buried, 
with a dragging about and a throwing away, out 
beyond the gates of Jerusalem.” Lying unattended out 
there, his corpse became exposed to the sun’s heat by 
ean to the frost by night.—Jeremiah 22:18, 19; 

It had been the intention of Nebuchadnezzar to take 
King Jehoiakim alive and in fetters to Babylon as a 
captive. To this effect 2 Chronicles 36:5-8 reads: “For 
eleven years he reigned in Jerusalem; and he continued 
to do what was bad in the eyes of Jehovah his God. 

him Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon came 
up that he might bind him with two fetters of copper 
to carry him off to Babylon. And some of the utensils 
of the house of Jehovah Nebuchadnezzar brought to 
Babylon and then put them in his palace in Babylon. 
As for the rest of the affairs of Jehoiakim and his de- 
testable things that he did and what was to be found 
against him, there they are written in the Book of the 
Kings of Israel and Judah; and Jehoiachin his son 
began to reign in place of him.” 

Since Jehoiachin came to the throne of his father 
Jehoiakim, how does this harmonize with Jehovah’s 
declaration that Jehoiakim would have no one sitting 
on the throne of David at Jerusalem? (Jeremiah 36: 


131 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


ZION CLASHES WITH BABYLON 135 


30) It does not contradict Jehovah’s declaration, be- 
cause, in fact, Jehoiachin reigned just three months 
and ten days, and this short period is hardly to be taken 
into account. (2 Chronicles 36:9, 10) In harmony with 
what the prophet Jeremiah had been advising the peo- 
ple, Jehoiachin surrendered quickly to Nebuchadnez- 
zar. For this reason it did not go too hard with him. 
We read: 

“Eighteen years old was Jehoiachin when he began 
to reign, and for three months he reigned in Jerusalem. 
And his mother’s name was Nehushta the daughter of 
Elnathan of Jerusalem. And he continued to do what 
was bad in Jehovah's eyes, according to all that his 
father had done. During that time the servants of 
Nebuchadnezzar the king of Babylon came up to Jeru- 
salem, so that the city came under siege. And Nebu- 
chadnezzar the king of Babylon proceeded to come 
against the city, while his servants were laying siege 
against it. At length Jehoiachin the king of Judah went 
out to the king of Babylon, he with his mother and his 
servants and his princes and his court oflicials; and the 
king of Babylon got to take him in the cighth year of 
his being king.” The eighth year of Nebuchadnezzar’s 
reign was from Nisan 1, 618 B.C., to Adar 29, 617 B.C., 
or March 19, 617 B.C. 

On this occasion Nebuchadnezzar took much trea- 
sure from Jehovah's temple and from the king’s house. 
He also took back with him into exile in Babylon all 
the principal men of Jerusalem and the skilled work- 
men and the military men and builders. ‘“‘No one had 
been left behind except the lowly class of the people of 
the land. Thus he took Jehoiachin into exile to Bab- 
ylon; and the king’s mother and the king’s wives and 
his court officials and the foremost men of the land he 
led away as exiled people from Jerusalem to Babylon. 
. .- Further, the king of Babylon made Mattaniah his 
uncle king in place of him. Then he changed his name 
to Zedekiah.”"—2 Kings 24:8-17. 


132 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


136 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!" 


It was at that time that the young Daniel and three 
special companions were taken exile to Babylon. In 
Daniel 1:1 he writes about it: “In the third year of the 
kingship of Jehoiakim the king of Judah, Nebuchad- 
nezzar the king of Babylon came to Jerusalem and 

proceeded to lay siege to it.” This was after King Je- 
hofalcim had rebelled against the king of Babylon, after 
being a vassal for about three years. 

Hence the expression “in the third year of the king- 
ship of Jehoiakim the king of Judah” means in the 
third year of Jehoiakim as a vassal king paying tribute 
to Babylon. Since his vassalage began after he reigned 
eight years in Jerusalem, this third year of his reign 
as Babylon’ S$ vassal would be the eleventh year of his 
entire reign at Jerusalem and would be due to end by 
the Jewish lunar calendar on Adar 29, 617 B.C., or 
March 19, 617 B.C. Jehoiakim’s unexplained death evi- 
dently did not permit him to live to the end of this 
eleventh year at that date.* 

Plainly, then, Daniel and his three companions did 
not go into exile at Babylon in the third year of Jehoi- 


* In agreement with this, Josephus" Antiquities of the Jews, Book 
10, chapter 6, says, in part: ‘In the fourth yeor of Jeholakim, one 
whose name was Nebuchadnezzar took the government over the Bab- 
ylonians, who at the same time went up with a great army to the city 
Carchemish, which was at Euphrates; upon a resolution that he had 
taken to ks with Necho king of Egypt. under whom all Syria then 
was. when Nebuchadnezzar da already reigned four years, 
which was the elghth of Jchoinkim’s ge A over the Hebrews, 
the king of Co ge a made an expedition with mighty forces against 


to ten- 

ing, and bought his peace with a and brought the tribute he 
was ordered to bring for three y 

“But on the third year, nen ye that the ne ee of Babylon made 

an expedition against the Egyptians, he did not pay tribute; yet was 

he disappointed of his hope, for the Egyptians durst not fight at 


this time. . 

“A little time pape poe Peas of Babylon made an expedition 
against Jehoiakim; de his son Jeholachin king of the coun- 
try, and of the city: “he magi took the principal persons in dignity 
for captives, three thousend in number, and led them away to Bab- 
ylon, Among whom was the prophet Ezckiel, who was then but young. 
And this was the end of king Jeholakim, when he had Lived thirty-six 
— and reigned eleven. But he was succeeded in the kingdom by 


133 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


ZION CLASHES WITH BABYLON 137 


akim’s reign at Jerusalem independent of Babylon, 
which third year of independent rule was from Nisan 1, 
626 B.C., to Adar 29, 625 B.C. (March 17, 625 B.C.) 
It was after King Jehoiakim had died in disgrace in 
the eleventh year of his entire reign some time prior to 
March 19, 617 B.C., that Daniel was taken into exile 
to Babylon. It was evidently when Jehoiakim’s son 
Jehoiachin, after reigning at Jerusalem for three 
months and ten days, was taken into exile in 617 B.C. 
that Daniel was taken along as an exile from Jerusalem. 

So, then, as regards the captivity of Jews at Bab- 
ylon, the exile and captivity of even part of the Jews 
at Babylon did not begin in 625 B.C. at the end of the 
third independent year of rule of King Jehoiakim at 
Jerusalem. Likewise, the seventy-year period that was 
foretold by the prophet Jeremiah did not begin in that 
year of 625 B.C. Certainly the land of Judah was not 
then turned upside down like a vessel and emptied of 
all its inhabitants. Even eight years later, in 617 B.C., 
when young King Jehoiachin was taken exile to Bab- 
ylon, only a small portion of the people were taken 
along with him. The vast majority of the people re- 
mained, and Jerusalem and the other Judean cities re- 
mained populated, and the land was by no means left 
an uninhabited desolation. Not all the people of Judah 
were then doing service at Babylon to the king of 
Babylon.* 


* In Jeremiah 52:28 we read: “These are the people whom Nebu- 
chadrezzar took into exile: in the seventh year, three thousand and 
twenty-three Jews." at ae ane tone year” may mean the seventh year 
after the year of his vi over Pharaoh Nechoh at Carchemish in 
625 B.C., for after his ae wl at that place Nebuchadnezzar had all 


PE of Babylon had taken all that happened to belong to the king of 
Egypt from the torrent valley of Egypt up to the river Euphrates."* 
Hence. with a special threat to Jerusalem and Judah, the reign be 
Nebuchadnezzar as king of Babylon might be counted as starting in 
64 B.C., or the year after his victory over Pharaoh Nechoh at Car- 
From this stand ” 


s king J But, from 
tually began to reign in Babylon, 618-617 BC. | (continued on next page} 


134 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


138 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI” 


It is because of making the mistake of dating the 
beginning of the seventy-year period for the desolation 
of Jerusalem and the land of Judah after King Jehoi- 
akim reigned at Jerusalem but three years that the 
chronologers in Christendom throw their time schedule 
of history at least nineteen years out of order, short- 
ening up the stream of time by that many years. They 
do this because of trying to harmonize the Bible rec- 
ords with the astronomical Canon of Claudius Ptolemy, 
an Alexandrian or Egyptian astronomer of the second 
century after Christ, but whose system of astronomy 
has long since been exploded. In this we do not go along 
with such chronologers. 

After King Jehoiachin, his princes and young Daniel 
and the priest named Ezekiel the son of Buzi were de- 
ported to Babylon, the inning of the seventy years 
of Judah's desolation had yet eleven years to wait. 
(Ezekiel 1:1-3) They began after the last king, Zede- 
kiah the uncle of Jehoiachin, was dethroned and when 
the land of Judah was left desolate. When, in 617 B.C., 
Nebuchadnezzar placed Zedekiah on the throne of Jeru- 
salem as a vassal king, he “made him swear by God.” 
Hence Jehovah God considered Zedekiah’s oath of 
faithful submission to Nebuchadnezzar as an oath made 
to him. (2 Chronicles 36:13) On this matter Ezekiel 
17:12-14 has this to say: 

“Look! The king of Babylon came to Jerusalem and 
proceeded to take its king [Jehoiachin] and its princes 
and bring them to himself at Babylon. Furthermore, 
he took one of the royal seed [Mattaniah, or Zedekiah ] 
and concluded a covenant with him and brought him 


{continued from page 137] would be the “‘cighth year’ of his reign, (2 

Kings 24:12) So, then, it was actually In the eighth year of his reign 

the above-mentioned 3,023 Jews, 

evidently not counting in their wives and families, numbering thou- 
—2 Kings 24:14-16, 

Parallel with the above, the “‘eightcenth year’ of Nebuchadnezzar 
spoken of in Jeremiah 52:29 would be the “eighteenth year’ of his 
domination over . but the “nineteenth year’ of his entire 
reign in Babylon, as mentioned in 2 Kings 25: 8 


135 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


THE DESOLATING OF ZION 157 


Jehovah. And even against King Nebuchadnezzar he 
rebelled, who had made him swear by God; and he 
kept stiffening his neck and hardening his heart so as 
not to return to Jehovah the God of Israel. Even all 
the chiefs of the priests and the people themselves com- 
mitted unfaithfulness on a large scale, according to all 
the detestable things of the nations, so that they defiled 
the house of Jehovah which he had _ sanctified.” 
—2 Chronicles 36:11-14. 

The siege of Jerusalem had now kept up for more 
than 520 days, more than seventeen lunar months, 
from the ninth year of Zedekiah’s reign, the tenth 
month, the tenth day, and it went into the fourth 
month of the eleventh year of his reign. The famine 
in the city had become severe; there was no bread for 
the people. (2 Kings 25:1-3) Mothers were eating their 
own babies. (Lamentations 2:19, 20) How was the 
prophet Jeremiah faring as a prisoner? 

Came the ninth day of this fourth month (Tammuz). 
Ah, at last success! A breach was made in Jerusalem’s 
resistant wall! “And all the princes of the king of Bab- 
ylon proceeded to come in and sit down in the Middle 
Gate.” No self-surrender now for King Zedekiah! By 
nightfall he and his men of war got out of Jerusalem 
by the way of the king’s garden, by the gate between 
the double wall, and they fled northeastward toward 
Jericho near the Jordan River. But in vain! “A military 
force of the Chaldeans went chasing after them, and 
they got to overtake Zedekiah in the desert plains of 
Jericho. Then they took him and brought him up to 
Nebuchadrezzar the king of Babylon at Riblah in the 
land of Hamath that he might pronounce upon him 
judicial decisions. And the king of Babylon proceeded 
to slaughter the sons of Zedekiah in Riblah before his 
eyes, and all the nobles of Judah the king of Babylon 
slaughtered. And the eyes of Zedekiah he blinded, after 
which he bound him with copper fetters, in order to 
bring him to Babylon.”—Jeremiah 39: 2-7. 


136 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


160 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!" 


king, who were found in the city, and the secretary of 
the chief of the army, the one mustering the people 
of the land, and sixty men of the people of the land, 
who were found in the midst of the city. So these 
Nebuzar-adan the chief of the bodyguard took and con- 
ducted them to the king of Babylon at Riblah. And 
these the king of Babylon proceeded to strike down 
and to put them to death in Riblah in the land of Ha- 
math. Thus Judah went into exile from off its soil.” 
Judah had not done this nineteen years before this 
during King Jehoiakim’s reign.—Jeremiah 52:24-28; 
2 Kings 24:1. 

Some Jewish princes were hanged up by just their 
hand. The women were raped right in Zion itself. 
(Lamentations 4:2; 5:11, 12) How shocking this was! 
But when the king himself was captured and deported, 
even though for his sin, it was like stifling those who 
had respect for the royal line of David: “The very 
breath of our nostrils, the anointed one [LXX, chris- 
t6s] of Jehovah, has been captured in their large pit, 
the one of whom we have said: ‘In his shade we shall 
live among the nations.’” (Lamentations 4:20) This 
was especially so, since the king sat on Jehovah’s 
throne at Jerusalem. 

Providentially, although all of Zedekiah’s sons were 
slaughtered before his eyes, leaving him without a male 
heir, he had a nephew in captivity, the former king, 
Jehoiachin, through whom the royal line could be 
continued. In fact, Jehoiachin had sons at Babylon, 
Shealtiel, Malchiram, Pedaiah, Shenazzar, Jekamiah, 
Hoshama and Nedabiah. Of these sons Shealtiel was 
reckoned as the father of Zerubbabel, who became 
governor of Judah under Persia and who rebuilt the 
temple at restored Jerusalem.—1 Chronicles 3:15-19; 
Ezra 3:2, 8; Matthew 1:12; Luke 3:27. 

Similarly when Nebuchadnezzar struck down the 
Jewish high priest Seraiah in death. (2 Kings 25:18- 
21) This high priest had a son named Jehozadak, who 


137 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


164 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!” 


Egypt and left the land of Judah utterly desolate and 
without human inhabitant, a place to be shunned by 
passersby, the land must have heaved a sigh of relief, 
as it were. Now it began to enjoy an uninterrupted run 
of sabbath years in compensation for all the sabbath 
years that the disobedient Israelites had failed to keep. 
How many years of sabbath rest was the land to enjoy? 
ee tively, a perfect number of years—seventy. We 


“So he brought up against them the king of the 
Chaldeans, . . . And he proceeded to burn the house of 
the true God and pull down the wall of Jerusalem; and 
all its dwelling towers they burned with fire and also 
all its desirable articles, so as to cause ruin. Further- 
more, he carried off those remaining from the sword 
captive to Babylon, and they came to be servants to 
him and his sons until the royalty of Persia began to 
reign; to fulfill Jehovah’s word by the mouth of Jere- 
miah, until the land had paid off its sabbaths. All the 
days of lying desolated it kept sabbath, to fulfill seventy 
years. And in the first year of Cyrus the king of Persia, 
that Jehovah’s word by the mouth of Jeremiah might 
be accomplished, Jehovah roused the spirit of Cyrus 
the king of Persia, so that he caused a cry to pass 
through all his kingdom, and also in writing, saying: 
‘This is what Cyrus the king of Persia has said, “All 
the kingdoms of the earth Jehovah the God of the heav- 
ens has given me, and he himself has commissioned me 
to build him a house in Jerusalem, which is in Judah. 
Whoever there is among you of all his people, Jehovah 
his God be with him. So let him go up.” ’ ’’—2 Chron- 
icles 36:17-23; compare also Daniel 9:1, 2. 

Flavius Josephus, the Jewish historian of the first 
century of our Common Era, is in harmony with the 
Holy Bible when he writes the following about the 
length of Jerusalem’s desolation: 

He [the Chaldean historian Berosus in the third cen- 
tury B.C.] gives us a catalogue of the posterity of Noah, 


138 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


THE DESOLATING OF ZION 165 


who adds the years of their chronology, from Noah 
himself to Nabulassar king of the Babylonians and 
Chaldeans, with an account of this King’s exploits. 
He tells us that he sent his son Nabuchodonosor with 
a mighty army into Egypt and Judea where, upon his 
being informed of a revolt, he reduced the people to 
subjection, set fire to our temple at Jerusalem, and 
carried off our whole nation in captivity to Babylon. 
After this our city lay desolate during an interval of 
seventy years, till the days of Cyrus, King of Persia. 
—Book 1, section 36, of To Epaphroditus on the 
Antiquities of the Jews in Answer to Apion. 

And such was the end of the nation of the Hebrews; 
it having twice gone beyond Euphrates. For the people 
of the ten tribes were carried out of Samaria by the 
Assyrians, in the days of King Hoshea. After which the 
people of the two tribes, that remained after Jerusalem 
was taken, were carried away by Nebuchadnezzar, King 
of Babylon and Chaldea. Now as to Shalmaneser, he 
removed the Israelites out of their country, and placed 
therein the nation of Cutheans who had formerly be- 
longed to the interior of Persia and Media; but were 
then called Samaritans; by taking the name of the coun- 
try to which they were removed. But the King of Bab- 
ylon, who brought out the two tribes, placed no other 
nation in their country. By which means all Judea, and 
Jerusalem, and the temple, continued to be a desert 
for seventy years.—Book 10, chapter 9, last paragraph, 
of Antiquities of the Jews, edition by Whiston. 

Thus the seventy years that Jeremiah foretold was 
a period occupied completely by the desolation of Jeru- 
salem and the land of Judah. They did not include a 
period of captivity of part of the Jewish nation in Bab- 
ylonia. Even captivity of some Jews in Babylonia did 
not begin in the third year of King Jehoiakim, or in 
626 B.C. Jehoiakim reigned eleven years, or into the 
eighth year of King Nebuchadnezzar of Babylon, which 
year ran from Nisan 1, 618 B.C., to Adar 29, 617 B.C. 
Shortly before this eighth year of Nebuchadnezzar 
ended on Adar 29, 617 B.C., Jehoiakim’s son and suc- 
cessor, Jehoiachin, went out from Jerusalem in self- 


139 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


166 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!" 
surrender to Nebuchadnezzar who was besieging the 
city. 


Evidently Jehoiachin was not taken away as captive 
from the land of Judah immediately, but before he and 
the other Jewish captives were taken away the eighth 
year of Nebuchadnezzar’s rule ran out and the ninth 
year of his rule began on Nisan 1, 617 B.C. (2 Chron- 
icles 36:9, 10) It was on that date, Nisan 1, 617 B.C., 
that the first regnal year began for Zedekiah, Jehoi- 
achin’s uncle, whom Nebuchadnezzar made king of 
Jerusalem in place of Jehoiachin. (2 Kings 24:12-18) 
So in 617 B.C. only some thousands of the Jews went 
into Babylonian captivity, not the whole Jewish nation.* 

Certainly, when King Jehoiakim was in open revolt 
against vassalage to Nebuchadnezzar and held out 
against him in the final three years of his reign in 
Jerusalem, the Jewish nation could not be considered 
as captive to Babylon. Neither could the nation be con- 
sidered captive when its last king, Zedekiah, broke his 


out against him for parts of three years. Thus there 
could not be said to be any seventy years of unbroken 
captivity to Babylon from the reign of King Jehoiakim 
down till the captive Jews were released by Cyrus the 
Persian in 537 B.C. First when Jerusalem was de- 
stroyed and the land of Judah was completely deso- 
lated, first then the Jews as a nation went into exile at 
Babylon, without a king at Jerusalem. This exile was 
a bs uninterrupted period of seventy years.—Daniel 
The lowly people that King Nebuchadnezzar left 
behind in the land of Judah had a governor appointed 
by him over them, namely, Gedaliah. However, he was 
killed in the seventh month (Tishri), and then the re- 
Jews fled down to Egypt out of fear of Bab- 

dee ay ei app emmy ing hg 2Y ne leo dr roa Sate 
ch them down there later on. In this way the land 


e See footnote (*) on page 137 of this book. 


140 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


THE DESOLATING OF ZION 167 


was left desolate in the seventh month, without man or 
beast, as Jeremiah had foretold. 

Five years after Jerusalem was destroyed the king 
of Babylon is reported as deporting Jews to Babylonia. 
Jeremiah 52:30 says: “In the twenty-third year of 
Nebuchadrezzar, Nebuzar-adan the chief of the body- 
guard took Jews into exile, seven hundred and forty- 
five souls.” These, however, were not taken off the 
land of Judah but were captured when Nebuchadnez- 
zar, as Jehovah's symbolic cup, made nations that 
bordered on the desolated land of Judah drink the bitter 
Sing of being violently conquered.—Jeremiah 25: 
17-29. 

In 537 B.C., when King Cyrus released a Jewish rem- 
nant and they left Babylon and began to repopulate the 
land of Judah and break its desolation, the foretold 
seventy-year period ended. Since the period ended in 
that year, it must have begun in 607 B.C., when Jeru- 
salem was destroyed and the land of Judah was com- 
pletely depopulated. If, then, after the deporting of the 
Jews to Babylon, Jehovah God had let King Nebu- 
chadnezzar import people from Gentile lands and 
settle them on the land of Judah, what? In that case, 
the land would not have enjoyed its seventy years of 
keeping sabbath or resting, as Jehovah had decreed. 
The land of Judah would have become like the land of 
Samaria, which the king of Assyria settled with peoples 
imported from heathen lands. However, by a miracle, 
Almighty God kept the land of Judah a complete deso- 
lation, that it might rest seventy years.—2 Chronicles 
36:21-23. 

Jerusalem fell in the eleventh year of the prophet 
Ezekiel’s exile in Babylonia. Some months later, evi- 
dently before Nebuchadnezzar’s victorious troops got 
back from Jerusalem, Ezekiel heard about it from a 
Jewish fugitive. He says: “At length it occurred in the 
twelfth year [by a certain calculation], in the tenth 
month, on the fifth day of the month of our exile, that 


141 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


172 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI” 


wisdom and understanding that the king inquired about 
from them, he even got to find them ten times better 
than all the magic-practicing priests and the conjurers 
that were in all his royal realm. And Daniel continued 
on until the first year of Cyrus the [Persian] king.” 
—Daniel 1:1-21. 

It could not have been before the twelfth year of 
Nebuchadnezzar’s kingship that he held such examina- 
tion and found Daniel to be exceptionally bright. How, 
then, shall we understand the statement in Daniel 2:1? 
It reads: “And in the second year of the kingship of 
Nebuchadnezzar, Nebuchadnezzar dreamed dreams; 
and his spirit began to feel agitated, and his very sleep 
was made to be something beyond him.” Since the king 
forgot the dream and Daniel finally volunteered both 
to recall the dream and to interpret it, Hebrew scholars 
propose that the Hebrew text of Daniel 2:1 should be 
“twelfth year’’ instead of “second year.’’** However, the 
most reasonable and fitting suggestion is that this re- 
fers to the “second year” from a marked event, namely, 
from Nebuchadnezzar’s destruction of Jerusalem in 
607 B.C. That is when the king of Babylon came to be 
the first one to hold world domination by God’s per- 
mission. 

In view of that fact, Daniel, when interpreting to 
Nebuchadnezzar his dream of the immense image with 
a golden head, could say to him: “You, O king, the 
king of kings, you to whom the God of heaven has 
given the kingdom, the might, and the strength and the 
dignity, and into whose hand he has given, wherever 
the sons of mankind are dwelling, the beasts of the field 
and the winged creatures of the heavens, and whom 
he has made ruler over all of them, you yourself are 
the head of gold.”—Daniel 2:37, 38. 

The dynasty of kings of the Semite race that Nebu- 
chadnezzar established over Babylon was the golden 

on Daniel 2:1 in Biblia Hebraica, by Rudolf Kittel, 


* See footnote 
ninth edition of 1954. Also see the footnote In The Cross-Reference 
Bibie, Variorum Edition, by Harold E. Monser, B.A., edition of 1910. 


142 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


176 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!" 


Then a voice from heaven announced that the tree 
dream would be fulfilled upon him now. He was seized 
with madness such as marks the disease of lycanthropy. 
He did not want to sit down on his glorious throne but 
wanted to go out into the field and eat grass like a bull. 
Out there is where he was driven. Out there he stayed 
for “seven times” or seven years. At the end of that 
period his understanding came back to him. He now 
praised the Most High God rather than himself as a 
king: “His rulership is a rulership to time indefinite 
and his kingdom is for generation after generation. 
And all the inhabitants of the earth are being con- 
sidered as merely nothing, and he is doing according to 
his own will among the army of the heavens and the 
inhabitants of the earth. And there exists no one that 
can check his hand or that can say to him, ‘What have 
you been doing?’ ” 

On learning of Nebuchadnezzar’s recovery his royal 
officers and grandees came for him and reinstated him 
on his throne. Says he: “I was re-established upon my 
own kingdom, and greatness extraordinary was added 
to me.”” He confessed that the Most High God is the 
“King of the heavens, because all his works are truth 
and his ways are justice, and because those who are 
walking in pride he is able to humiliate.”—Daniel 
4:19-37. 

Both the dream and its direct fulfillment upon Nebu- 
chadnezzar were prophetic. That is why this experience 
of his is recorded in the Bible. In this greater fulfill- 
ment what does the immense tree picture? At the time 
of the dream King Nebuchadnezzar held world dom- 
ination and also had served as Jehovah's instrument 
or “cup” of judgment. Hence the tree as represented 
in this king of the Third World Power pictured world 
sovereignty or domination. In support of this explana- 
tion, Daniel 4:26 says: “Because they said to leave 
the rootstock of the tree, your kingdom will be sure 


to you.” 


143 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


WAITING IN EXILE FOR BABYLON’S FALL 177 


What was really meant was the world sovereignty 
or domination exercised by the kingdom of God. For 
years the typical kingdom of Judah had stood as a 
block or hindrance to King Nebuchadnezzar’s exer- 
cising world domination, as the leading governmental 
power on earth. Inasmuch as the king of Judah, from 
the days of King David, sat on “Jehovah's throne” in 
Zion or Jerusalem, Jehovah the Universal Sovereign 
was ruling through that typical kingdom of God on 
the earth. Jehovah was thus showing that he rules in 
the kingdom of mankind and gives it to the one to 
whom he wants to give it, to one in the line of King 
David. Thus the world domination depended upon the 
Most High God, Jehovah, “the King of the heavens.” 
World domination as regards the earth Jehovah held 
in his hands. 

In Ezekiel 21:25-27, which is addressed to King 
Zedekiah of Jerusalem, Jehovah declared that He would 
ruin the typical kingdom of God and would overturn 
matters by bringing low the high one who occupied 
“Jehovah’s throne” in Zion and putting on high what 
was low, namely, the Gentile world power. This is 
what Jehovah did in 607 B.C. by letting the king of 
Babylon take Zedekiah captive and destroy Jerusalem 
and its temple. So the world domination as symbolized 
by God’s typical kingdom, the kingdom of Judah, was 
cut down like the immense tree of Nebuchadnezzar’s 
dream. Jehovah even used King Nebuchadnezzar as His 
instrument in chopping it down. In this way world 
domination as typically symbolized in the kingdom of 
Judah was transferred from the king on “Jehovah's 
throne” in Zion to the victorious Gentile world power. 
In this way Gentile Babylon, as ruled by King Nebu- 
chadnezzar, took up the world domination and had no 
more interference from the kingdom of Judah. Thus 
Babylon’s king became a symbol of world domination 
by God's arrangement. 


144 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


178 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!” 


In the dream the tree stump was left in the ground. 
Why? To symbolize that the one who originally held 
the world domination had not forever let go of it. He 
would take it up again, but not before a certain time 
interval of self-restraint would expire. This restraining 
himself from wielding world domination by a kingdom 
of God for ruling the earth was pictured by the band- 
ing of the tree stump with iron and copper, the two 
strongest metals then known. 

How long was this self-restraint from exercising 
world power over the earth by a kingdom of God de- 
creed to last? How long would the tree stump sym- 
bolizing “kingdom” (Daniel 4:26) be banded? The 
length of time was indicated by the time from when 
Nebuchadnezzar became mad and was driven from 
Babylon’s throne until God restored Nebuchadnezzar’s 
sanity and he was reseated on Babylon’s throne to 
exercise world domination. That period of his being 
humbled to the grass of the earth was seven times. In 
Nebuchadnezzar’s case that period was a total of seven 
lunar years. At the end of that time the symbolic band- 
ing was taken off. Then the symbolic stump was al- 
lowed to grow a royal sprout, as pictured by Nebu- 
chadnezzar’s resuming the kingship with extraordinary 
greatness.—Compare Ezekiel 17:22-24; Job 14:7-9. 

When Nebuchadnezzar’s madness ended and he was 
reinstated on Babylon’s throne, Jehovah God did not 
resume his own world domination and reestablish a 
typical kingdom of God on earth at Jerusalem with a 
king sitting on “Jehovah’s throne.” At that time, all 
that Jehovah God did was to get a confession from the 
restored Nebuchadnezzar that the Most High God was 
the “King of the heavens.’’ Jehovah’s taking up his 
power to rule by establishing a kingdom of God for 
this earth came long after Nebuchadnezzar acknowl- 
edged Jehovah to be the “King of the heavens.” It is 
clear, therefore, that the “seven times” or seven literal 
years in Nebuchadnezzar’s personal experience were 


145 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


WAITING IN EXILE FOR BABYLON'S FALL 179 


symbolic. They symbolized a greater period of time in 
the fulfillment of the larger meaning of the dream. 
oe much time does the Bible show that actually 
to be? 

The years spoken of in the Bible were lunar years. 
In order for the lunar (moon) year to keep pace with 
the solar (sun) year, the lunar year has to change 
every so often from a twelve-month year of 355 days 
(with 50 or 51 sabbaths) to a thirteen-month year of 
383, 384 or 385 days. But in a symbolic or prophetic 
year, the number of days is fixed at the unchanging 
number of 360, and each day thereof stands for a whole 
year. “A day for a year, a day for a year.”—-Numbers 
14:34; Ezekiel 4:6. 

In the prophetic book of Revelation a thousand two 
hundred and sixty days are spoken of as being equal to 
a “time and times and half a time,” or three and a half 
times. (Revelation 12:6, 14) If we divide three and a 
half (3.5) into a thousand two hundred and sixty days, 
an us three hundred and sixty (360) days to a 
ae me.” 

Accordingly, a symbolic or prophetic “time” would 
Scripturally equal three hundred and sixty (360) years. 
If, now, three and a half symbolic “times” amounted 
to 1,260 symbolic days, that is to say, 1,260 years, then 
twice three and a half (or seven) symbolic “times” 
would be twice 1,260 years, that is to say, 2,520 years. 
Thus the “seven times” that are mentioned in Daniel 
4:16, 23, 25, 32 in connection with the tree dream 
would stand for two thousand five hundred and twenty 
literal years. In that period of time the lunar years, by 
means of their regular thirteen-month years, would 
balance off with the solar years and would equal 2,520 
solar years. 

When, though, would those “seven times,” or 2,520 
years begin to count? In the tree dream the “seven 
times” counted from when the tree was cut down and 
the tree stump was banded. 


146 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


180 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!" 


In Nebuchadnezzar’s case the “seven times” counted 
from when he turned mad and was driven from his 
throne. In the fulfillment of the greater prophetic 
meaning, the “seven times” of 2,520 years began to 
count when Jehovah God let go the world domination 
as represented by his typical kingdom on earth. That 
was when Jehovah used Nebuchadnezzar to destroy 
Jerusalem and its temple, chase King Zedeckiah off 
“Jehovah's throne” and take him into exile, after which 
the fear of the Chaldeans caused the lowly people left 
behind to flee down into Egypt, leaving the territory 
of Judah desolate, with no governor there. Thus deso- 
lation was accomplished in the seventh lunar month 
of the year 607 B.C. First then, Jerusalem, as repre- 
sentative of God’s kingdom, began to be trodden down 
and thus the Gentile Times, “the appointed times of 
the nations,” began. Now Gentile domination, without 
interference of God’s kingdom, swayed the earth. 
Moreover, the Gentile world powers acted beastly, like 
Nebuchadnezzar during his ‘seven times’ of madness. 

By count, then, those Gentile Times, those “ap- 
pointed times of the nations,’ would end 2,520 years 
from near the middle of the seventh lunar month 
(Tishri) of 607 B.C. So they would end about the 
middle of the month Tishri (or near October 1), 
A.D. 1914. That is an unforgettable year, for in 1914 
World War I broke out and the Gentile system of things 
has never been the same since then. 

In autumn of A.D. 1914 was therefore the time for 
Jehovah to remove the bands from the symbolic tree 
of world domination by God’s kingdom. It was the time 
for the symbolic tree stump to sprout again by Jeho- 
vah’s taking up the universal domination and setting 
up a theocratic kingdom.—Revelation 11:15-18; Luke 
21:24. 

This government was no typical kingdom set up 
again among the natural Jews. It was the real kingdom 
in the hands of the Shiloh to whom it belongs. He is 


147 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


PREVIEWS OF BABYLON’S FALL 183 


over the land of Egypt itself. This he did in the year 
588 B.C.—Ezekiel 29:17-20; Jeremiah 44:29, 30. 

As for King Nebuchadnezzar’s family affairs, his 
Median queen was named Amytis, and his oldest 
son was named Evil-merodach, who was to become 
his father’s immediate successor. Of course, Nebu- 
chadnezzar also had daughters, and it appears that 
the husbands of two of these were also to occupy 
the throne, as history worked out. One of these sons-in- 
law of Nebuchadnezzar was named Neriglissar and 
the other Nabonidus. According to the book Nabonidus 
and Belshazzar, by R. P. Dougherty (page 79), certain 
circumstances favor the view that Nabonidus married 
a daughter of Nebuchadnezzar named Nitocris, who 
was the daughter of his Egyptian wife of the same 
name. By this Nitocris Nebuchadnezzar’s favorite 

son-in-law Nabonidus had a son named Belshazzar. In 
this way Belshazzar was really a grandson of Nebu- 
chadnezzar and a pete ondinioar a of Nabopolassar, the 
founder of the last dynasty of Semite kings of Babylon. 
The table below sets out this dynasty of Neo- 
Babylonian kings corresponding to the table drawn up 
by Professor R. P. Dougherty: 


NABOPOLASSAR 
(Founder of the dynasty) 


NEBUCHADNEZZAR 
(Son of se i cael 


| 
NERIGLISSAR NABONIDUS 


AMEL-MARDUK 
(Son of Nebuchadnezzar) (Son-in-law of (Son-in-law of 
Nebuchadnezzar) Nebuchadnezzar) 


LABASHI-MARDUK BELSHAZZAR 
(Son of Neriglissar) (Son of Nabonidus) 
Amel-Marduk (Evil-merodach) as the oldest son suc- 
ceeded Nebuchadnezzar to Babylon’s throne in 581 B.C. 


This king, though reportedly wicked, receives mention 
in the Bible as doing a kindness to the exiled Jewish 


148 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


184 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!" 


king whose line of descent was to run down to Joseph 
the foster father of Jesus Christ. We read: “It came 
about in the thirty-seventh year of the exile of Jehoi- 
achin the king of Judah, in the twelfth month [Adar], 
on the twenty-seventh day of the month [in 580 B.C.}, 
Evil-merodach the king of Babylon, in the year of his 
becoming king, raised up the head of Jehoiachin the 
king of Judah out of the house of detention; and he 
began to speak good things with him, and then put 
his throne higher than the thrones of the kings that 
were with him in Babylon. And he took off his prison 
garments; and he ate bread constantly before him all 
the days of his life. As for his allowance, an allowance 
was constantly given him from the king, daily as due, 
all the days of his life.”” (2 Kings 25:27-30) Jehoiachin 
(or Jeconiah) had seven sons in Babylonia, including 
Shealtiel, whose nominal son Zerubbabel became govy- 
ernor of rebuilt Jerusalem.—1 Chronicles 3:17-19; 
Haggai 1:1; 2:23; Ezra 5:1, 2; Matthew 1:12. 

After reigning but two years King Evil-merodach 
was murdered by his brother-in-law Neriglissar. Ac- 
cording to the inscriptions that have been found, this 

of the throne spent most of his time in build- 
ing operations and reigned four years. When he died, 
his son Labashi-Marduk, though not yet of age, suc- 
ceeded him. He was a vicious boy, and within nine 
months he had his throat cut by an assassin. Naboni- 
dus, who had served as Governor of Babylon and who 
had been Nebuchadnezzar’s favorite son-in-law, now 
took the throne and had a fairly glorious reign till 
Babylon fell in 539 B.C. He was given to literature, art 
and religion. He is reported to have been the son of a 
priestess of the moon at Harran (Haran), which fact 
had endeared him to Nebuchadnezzar. Says The En- 
cyclopedia Americana, Volume 2, page 441: 

He was an enthusiastic religionist and antiquarian. 


He built and rebuilt many temples in the principal 
cities of his kingdom. Nabonidus’ enthusiasm carried 


149 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


188 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI” 


horns stands for the kings of Media and Persia. And 
the hairy he-goat stands for the king of Greece; and 
as for the great horn that was between its eyes, it 
stands for the first king [Alexander the Great].” So 
by this vision also God foretold that the Medo-Persian 
World Power, the Fourth World Power of history, was 
to fall before the Fifth World Power, the Macedonian 
or Grecian Empire.*—Daniel 8:2-22. 


BABYLON’S CONQUEROR FORETOLD BY NAME 


Early in his reign King Nabonidus of Babylon en- 
tered into a defensive and offensive alliance with the 
Lydian Empire and Egypt against the i of 
Persia. We remember that his father-in-law Nebuchad- 
nezzar as crown prince of Babylon had shared with the 
Medes and the Scythians in destroying the Assyrian 
capital, Nineveh, in 633 B.C. Two years later the 
Median king dealt the final blow to the Assyrian army 
by defeating it at Haran (Harran). He was thus able 
to take over all of northern Mesopotamia, whereas the 
king of Babylon held the lower Mesopotamian valley. 

The Median king also met the Lydians in Asia Minor 
bo set up a common border between the Median Em- 
pire and the Lydian Empire. 

The Persian kings who held territory to the east of 
the Persian Gulf were vassals to the Median Empire, 
but they held the province of Elam and its important 
city Anshan or Anzan.} The Persian King Cyrus I, 
ruler of the city Anshan, had a son named Cambyses, 
who succeeded him to the throne. Cambyses I married 
Mandane, the daughter of Astyages, who succeeded to 
the throne of the Median Empire. Another daughter 
of the Median King Astyages was Amytis, and Nebu- 
chadnezzar of Babylon married her. It was in order to 
satisfy the homesickness of Amytis for the mountains 

* See “Your Will Be Done on Earth,”’ chapter 9. 


+ Elam was also called Susiana by the classical geographers, from 
its capital city Susa, or Shushan. 


150 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


Isaich 13:17, 18 PREVIEWS OF BABYLON’S FALL 197 


The expression “the Medes” in Isaiah 13:17 must be 
understood as including the Persians.* Jehovah’s nam- 
ing of the Medes calls to mind, of course, Darius the 
Mede, who, according to Daniel 5:28, 31, “received the 
kingdom” after Babylon fell and was “divided and given 
to the Medes and the Persians.”” However, according to 
the ancient historian Herodotus (1,95), a Median was 
the mother of Cyrus the Great. She was Mandane, the 
daughter of King Astyages, the ruler of the Median 
Empire. She was given in marriage to the Persian Cam- 
byses I, the son of Cyrus I. The offspring of this mar- 
riage was named Cyrus, after his grandfather. Thus 
Cyrus II, the Persian, had Median blood in him. After 
he rebelled and conquered the kingdom of his grand- 
father Astyages, the Medes became his loyal allies and 
supporters in his military operations. Along with the 
Medes, the Elamites were also to take part in con- 
Bey Babylon, according to the words of Isaiah 
21:2-9. 

The Medes, including the Persians, were expert bow- 
men. Says The Encyclopcedia Britannica, Volume 21, 
edition of 1911, page 207: 

The chief weapon of the Persians, as of all Iranians, 
was the bow, which accordingly the king himsclf holds 
in his portraits, for example, on the Behistun rock and 
the coins (darics). In addition to the bow, the Persians 
earried short lances and short daggers. But it was not 
by these weapons, nor by hand to hand fighting, that 
the Persian victories were won. They overwhelmed their 
enemy under a hail of arrows, and never allowed him 


* In an article entitied “The Last Days of Babylon," D. J. Wiseman, 
head of the Department of Western Asiatic Antiquitics of the British 
Museum, describes the discovery of a stone monument. inscribed in 
Babylonian, which gives King Nabonidus’ own account of events dur- 
ing his reign over Babylonia. In this monument, the Harran stele, 
King Nabonidus of Babylon makes reference to the king of the Medes 
in the year 346 B.C., which was some years before Cyrus the Great 
had absorbed the Medlan Empire. Quite properly, then, the prophets 
Isaiah and Jeremiah refer to Babylon's conquerors as “‘Medes."" Though 
Daniel's eg speaks of the kingdom of Darius the Mede, it docs 
not mean an independent Median kingdom, with Its capital at Ecbat- 
ana, after Babylon fell. Wiseman’s article was published In CaAristi- 
anity Today, Volume II, No. 4, November 25, 1957. 


151 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


Daniel 5:30, 31 THE FALL OF BABYLON 239 


As for Belshazzar’s father, King Nabonidus, he sur- 
vived his son. He had taken refuge in the nearby city 
of Borsippa, and in order to besiege him, Cyrus the 
conqueror moved against him. Nabonidus, however, did 
not choose to defend himself but surrendered to Cyrus. 
He received mercy at Cyrus’ hands and was merely 
deported to the province of Carmania, of which he was 
even made governor. At his death he left behind in- 
scriptions, including the so-called Nabonidus Chronicle. 
—Am', Volume 19, page 677.* 

Although Babylon fell to Cyrus’ troops on Tishri 16 
(October 5-6), 539 B.C., he himself did not enter the 
city till seventeen days after it fell and had been occu- 
pied by his troops, namely, on the third day of the 
month Marchesvan (October 22-23). The conquered 
Babylonians gave him a good welcome. He, in turn, 
proclaimed peace to all the city. Eight days later his 
main general, Ugbaru (Gobryas), died, and a period of 
mourning followed. King Cyrus had a governor with 
him, namely, Gubaru; and when Cyrus made his entry, 
this Gubaru appointed governors in Babylon.+ 

Daniel 5:31 says that Darius the Mede “received the 
kingdom” at the age of sixty-two years. Who was this 
Darius? There is yet some difficulty in proving this in 
the uninspired pagan cuneiform inscriptions and other 
historical writings. But the argument is strong that 
he was the same as Cyrus’ governor named Gubaru.tf 
New documents that may yet be discovered by archae- 
ologists will either confirm or disprove this. In the 

~* See also Berosus, a Babylonian priest of Bel, about 250 B.C. He 


withe aheut bis pectle ‘with the aif of cenationss sources, but wrote 
in Greek. His works have disappeared, but the Jewish historian Jose 


preserved fragments 
Berosus’ wri See Contra Apionem, k I, section 20, by Jo- 
Suse ISBE, Volume 1, page 368a, says ee was imprisoned. 
+ See Babylonian Problems (page 201), by W. H. Lane, 1923 Edition. 
$ See chante. of Darius the Mede, published in 1959 in the United 
States of America, by John C. Whitcomb, Jr. 


152 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


Jeremioh 51:20-24 NO HEALING FOR BABYLON 279 
I will dash man and woman to pieces, and by 


g 


reign. So seven years remained before he would bring 
Zion and her temple to ruin, kill the main priests, 
slaughter King Zedekiah’s sons before his eyes, kill cer- 
tain prominent government functionaries and deport 
Zedekiah and hundreds of other surviving Jews to Bab- 
ylon, leaving the care of the land of Judah to the poor- 
est people prior to its complete desolation. (Jeremiah 
52:12-29) But prior to this Nebuchadnezzar had de- 
feated the Egyptian Pharaoh and taken part in destroy- 
ing Nineveh, Assyria’s capital. He reigned for forty- 
three years. So after destroying Zion he had more than 
twenty years in which to fulfill the prophecy of Jere- 
miah 25:17-26 concerning other nations and peoples 
roundabout. 

Thus, under him particularly, Babylon was used as 
Jehovah’s war club of judgment to dash to pieces na- 
tions, kingdoms, horses and riders, chariots and riders, 
men and women, old men and boys, young men and 
virgins, shepherds and their droves, farmers and their 
spans of draft animals, and governors and deputy 
rulers. After Nebuchadnezzar died, Babylon continued 
as the Third World Power for about half a century. 

Jehovah had used Babylon and the inhabitants of 
Chaldea as his war club to dash Jerusalem and its 
kingdom to pieces. But Babylon did not knowingly 
serve Jehovah in this way. She did not do it to please 


153 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


Jeremiah 51:34, 35 NO HEALING FOR BABYLON 227 


against Jerusalem and made King Jehoiakim a vassal 
king under oath to pay tribute to Babylon. Three years 
later, after Jehoiakim rebelled, Nebuchadnezzar came 
again against Jerusalem. In the eleventh year of his 
reign Jehoiakim died at Jerusalem and was su 

by his son Jehoiachin. 

After being besieged three months at Jerusalem, the 
young king Jehoiachin went out in surrender to Nebu- 
chadnezzar. Then ten thousand Jews, including the king 
and the families of the men selected, were deported to 
Babylon. It was no deportation of the whole nation. So 
by no means did the nation of Judah go into Babylonian 
captivity in 617 B.C. It was only after Nebuchadnezzar 
came back again and, after a siege of eighteen months, 
destroyed Jerusalem and her temple in 607 B.C., that 
the nation of Judah vanished from the God-given land. 
(2 Kings 24:1 to 25:26; 2 Chronicles 36:1-20; Jeremiah 
52:1-29) Without a reigning king and while exiles in 
Babylon, the Jewish people were now in their greatest 
confusion. 

Nebuchadnezzar set the land of Judah “as an empty 
vessel,” turning it upside down and leaving nothing in- 
side. He not only deported a further number of sur- 
viving Jews but also inspired such terror in the poor, 
insignificant people left behind that these fled down 
to Egypt. The whole land of Judah was left like an 
empty vessel turned upside down, emptied of all its 
inhabitants. Thus the most of the surviving Jews were 
swallowed up within Babylon's domains, as if by a big 
snake or sea monster. Nebuchadnezzar had acted like 
the dragon or sirrush, which was the symbol of the god 
Marduk (Merodach) whom he worshiped. As a sym- 
bolic big snake he had filled himself with the Jewish 
nation’s “pleasant things,” the precious utensils of Je- 
hovah’s holy temple in particular. He rinsed the nation 
off its home territory as if it were something unclean. 


For all the violence done by Nebuchadnezzar to her 
and to her royal organism or structure, the “inhab- 


154 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


296 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI” Jeremich 51:49, 50 


pressor the triumph of their God Jehovah and the just 
paying back to the oppressive imperial city what she 
deserved. She had made thousands of the sons of Israel 
fall in violent death in the land of Judah. But her sin 
was still greater, for she also bore a bloodguilt for the 
“slain ones of all the earth,” those slain because of her 
carrying on her program of world conquest. Why 
should not all righteous men rejoice over the despoil- 
ing of such a bloodguilty organization? It was her own 
fault that the children of her own organization fell 
slain at her overthrow in 539 B.C. 

The exiled Israelites took no part in Babylon's mili- 
tary campaigns or in defending her against the Medes 
and Persians. They properly escaped slaughter by the 
sword when Babylon fell. Whereas they had just cause 
for crying out joyfully over the fall of their oppressor, 
it was also the time for them to think of another capital 
city, Zion, the city where their God had placed his 
name. Measured by travel routes and travel time away 
back in those days, that city was far away, say a land 
journey of four or five months. Yet they should remem- 
ber Jehovah, though the place where he had put his 
name was far away. The remembrance of that holy 
place, the location of Zion, was to serve as an incentive 
to start them going there and to keep on going until at 
last they reached the place. 

In anticipation of the decree of release that Jehovah 
would put it into the heart of Cyrus the Persian to 
issue, Jehovah says to his protected and spared people: 
“You escapees from the sword, keep going. Do not 
stand still. From far away remember Jehovah, and 
may Jerusalem herself come up into your heart.” (Jere- 
miah 51:50) The freed Israelites were not to be like the 
wife of Lot and stop and look back. (Luke 17:32) They 
were to look ahead and return to the holy mountain of 
Jehovah's worship as quickly as they could. They should 
get as far away from Babylon as they could do so. 


155 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


Iscigh 47:15 DOWN, WORLD MISTRESS! 331 


One modern historical work* tells of the effect of this, 
in the following words: 

‘The Chaldeans made great progress in the study of 
astronomy through an effort to discover the future in 
the stars. This art we call “astrology”. Much information 
has been systematically collected by the Babylonians 
and from it we have here the beginning of astronomy. 
The groups of stars which now bear the name “Twelve 
Signs of the Zodiac” were mapped out for the first time, 
and the planets Mercury, Venus, Mars, Jupiter, and 
Saturn were known. Since these planets were thought to 
have special powers over the lives of men, they were 
named for the five leading gods and goddesses. We 
refer to these planets by thcir Roman names, but the 
Romans had adopted the Babylonian terms and simply 
translated them into their equivalents in Rome. Thus 
the planet of Ishtar, the goddess of love, became Venus, 
and that of the god Marduk was changed to Jupiter. 


How they finally reached the Italian peninsula can 
be traced by a close study of historical information by 
worldly authorities. In the work entitled “Lares and 
Penates of Cilicia,” by Barker and Ainsworth, chap- 
ter 8, page 232, we read: “The defeated Chaldeans fled 
to Asia Minor and fixed their central college at Per- 
gamos.”+ This is the Pergamum or Pergamos men- 
tioned in Revelation 2:12 as the location of a Christian 
congregation in the first century A.D. Earlier, in 
133 B.C., King Attalus III, on his deathbed, bequeathed 
Pergamum and its territory to the Romans, all of 
which later became a Roman province under the name 


* See pages 230, 232 of The Dawn of Civilieation and Life in the 
Ancient Fast (1940 edition), by R, M. Engberg and F.C. Cole. 


and '. 
mythology.--Sr*, Volume 17, page SOT: also The 
dia, Volume IT, page 666, edition of 1911, 

The celebrated and much frequented temple of Aesculapius was io- 
cated in Pergamos. Acsculapius was called the god of and 
the mythology im connection with his worship 
of Babylon. He was worshiped in the form of a living serpent, fed 
in the temple and being considered as its divinity. 


156 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


Iscioh 51:21-23 UP, ZIONI 349 


because his chosen people, of whom she was the capital 
city, had kept on contending with him instead of 
agreeing with him and lovingly, trustingly obeying him 
as their God. But there was a limit to his rage at her. 
After disciplining her he was pleased to show her pity 
and his forgiving spirit. 

This meant that his rage was to turn away from 
Jerusalem and was to be directed against the organiza- 
tion that had mercilessly brought all this affliction upon 
her, namely, Babylon and its allies. These had irritated 
Jerusalem. They had humiliated her. They had razed 
her to the ground. They had made her, as it were, lie 
face down to the ground and flatten herself to the 
ground, that they might walk heavily over her, use her 
like a city street. (Psalm 137:7; Obadiah 11-14) Thus, 
in 607 B.C., Jerusalem began to be trodden down by 
the Gentile nations. There the “seven times,” “the 
times of the Gentiles,” began, to continue until into 
A.D. 1914.—Luke 21:24, AV; Daniel 4:16, 23, 25, 32. 

For this reason the Gentiles deserved to have the 
cup of Jehovah's rage filled up and handed over to them 
to drink. Jerusalem was not to drink such a cup again 
by means of Babylon and its anti-Jewish allies. As a 
retribution, Jehovah in his own due time takes the 
cup out of Jerusalem’s hand and gives it to those who 
irritated and debased her, subjugated her. As he had 
done with Jerusalem, so he did with her persecutors. 
He forced them to drink the cup of divine rage. In 
539 B.C., at Babylon’s fall, they began drinking. To this 
end Jehovah used the Medes and Persians as his sym- 
bolic cup. Babylon was to go down, dead drunk, but 
Zion was to rise! 

It was entirely reasonable to expect that, after her 
God took the emptied cup of his rage out of her hand, 
he should call upon her to get up from her prone con- 
dition in the dust. Absolutely certain that she would, at 
his command, rise up as a beautiful city again, he in- 
spired Isaiah two hundred years in advance to cry out: 


157 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


: Getting Out 
r of the Midst 
18 of Babylon 


le OBEDIENCE to the divine com- 
mand, a remnant of faithful Jews quit their exile in 
Babylonia and made their way back to their God-given 
homeland. Their eyes were specially fixed on Zion, Jeru- 
salem. Concerning the date of this, The Graphic Histor- 
ical Atlas of Palestine* says, on page 34, that in 538 B.C. 
Cyrus the Persian issued his proclamation freeing the 
Jews to return to Jerusalem and rebuild its temple, 
and that they reached their desolate homeland in 
537 B.C. Under the heading “Babylonian Captivity,” 
The Encyclopeedia Britannica (eleventh edition), Vol- 
ume 3, page 115b, says: “After the overthrow of Bab- 
ylonia by the Persians, Cyrus gave the Jews permis- 
sion to return to their native land (537 B.C.), and 
more than forty thousand are said to have availed 
themselves of the privilege.” } 


* Published by Dr. J. Szapiro, editor, Tel-Aviv, Israel, 1941, En- 
eee” edition, 

+ Says Br’, Volume 10, page 1088, under the heading “Books of 
Evra and Nehemiah": ‘*““The period of history covered by the books 
of Ezra and Nehemiah extended from the return of the exiles under Ze- 
rubbabel in 537-536 B.C. to Nehemiah’s second visit to Jerusalem... . 

Under the heading “'Hook of Ezra’’ Am’, Volume 10, page 6892. says 
“The book of Ezra covers the history from 537 B.C, to 4558, although 
some would substitute another date for the latter one." 

The book The Monuments and the Old Testament (1958), by Price. 
Sellers and Carlson, says, on page 319, that it wus “about 535 or 537 
B.C." that Cyrus published his decree in Babylon for captive peoples 
to go back to thelr homelands. the Jews receiving special help by 
the authorities. Under the heading ““‘The Ancicnt Dates Employed” 
it says, on page 414, regarding the year B.C., “537536 Hebrew 
Exes Return.” 

364 


158 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


GETTING OUT OF THE MIDST OF BABYLON 865 


That the year of the return of the Jewish remnant 
to Judah and Jerusalem was marked in God's time 
schedule, we have the proof in Ezra 1:1-4. This reads: 
“And in the first year of Cyrus the king of Persia, that 
Jehovah's word from the mouth of Jeremiah might be 
accomplished, Jehovah roused the spirit of Cyrus the 
king of Persia so that he caused a cry to pass through 
all his realm, and also in writing, saying: “This is what 
Cyrus the king of Persia has said, “All the kingdoms 
of the earth Jehovah the God of the heavens has given 
me, and he himself has commissioned me to build him 
a house in Jerusalem, which is in Judah. Whoever there 
is among you of all his people, may his God prove to 
be with him. So let him go up to Jerusalem, which is 
in Judah, and rebuild the house of Jehovah the God of 
Israel—he is the true God—which was in Jerusalem. 
As for anyone that is left from all the places where he 
is residing as an alien, let the men of his place assist 
him with silver and with gold and with goods and with 
domestic animals along with the voluntary offering 
for the house of the true God, which was in Jeru- 
salem.” >. 

This decree by Cyrus did not apply to the fugitive 
Jews in Egypt. The land of Egypt was first added 
to the Persian Empire after Cyrus’ death by his 
son and successor, Cambyses, this bringing the entire 
Mesopotamian-Egyptian region under Persian control 
by 525 B.C. But Cyrus could make a decree affecting 
the land of Judah in Palestine, because, when he cap- 
tured Babylon in 539 B.C., he got possession not only 
of Babylonia itself but also of its foreign holdings, 
which included Syria, Palestine and the part of Assyria 
that Cyrus did not already hold. He fell in death about 
530 B.C. while in battle northeast of the Caspian Sea. 
To his son and successor Cambyses he left an empire 
that extended from the Aegean Sea on the west to the 
Indies in the east—the Fourth World Power. 


159 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


366 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI"” 


In calculating the “first year of Cyrus the king of 
Persia,” we must faithfully proceed according to the 
inspired Word of Jehovah God. We accept from secular 
historians the year 539 B.C. as a fixed date, marking 
the downfall of Babylon, the Third World Power. But 
the Bible introduces, immediately after the fall of 
Babylon in that year of 539 B.C., the reign at Babylon 
of Darius the Mede. (Daniel 5:30, 31) The prophet 
Daniel, who was there at Babylon, speaks of the “‘first 
year of Darius the son of Ahasuerus of the seed of the 
Medes, who had been made king over the kingdom of 
the Chaldeans.”” (Daniel 9:1; 11:1; 6:1, 6, 9, 25, 28) In 
harmony with the Bible we must accept at least one 
year, with possibly part of a second year, for King 
Darius the Mede. Hence, at the earliest, the first year 
of King Cyrus the Persian may not have begun till 
late in the year 538 B.C. to extend over into the follow- 
ing year of 537 B.C.* 

Cyrus’ decree was evidently not issued before the 
first year of Darius the Mede was disposed of and Cyrus 
became sole ruler of Babylon. The Bible does not say 
that it was in the first year of the reign of King Darius 
the Mede that Cyrus issued his decree, nor does the 
Bible say that Jerusalem’s desolation came to an end 
in the first year of King Darius’ reign. It was in the 
first year of his reign that the prophet Daniel studied 
Jeremiah’s prophecy concerning Jerusalem's desolation, 
and this study on Daniel’s part must have been before 


* On page 404 a Bi ga 4, The Jewish Encyctopedia says: “Cyrus 
always conformed the traditions of the thrones he aourped and, 
with his pol Canhvenn, rendered homage to the native dei- 

, 538, in conform- 


onian 

ue of Bel-Marduk, and thus became eg tea as monarch. Fro 
this ceremony dates the firat year of his reign ‘King of Babylon, 
Ki of all the — ** Cyrus thus had rep edlly procinimed as king 
or bylon and as the legitimate successor to the deposed King Nab- 
onidus. By doing this he did not have to reconqver the Baby teeta 
oe Babylon's foreign ggg pe ee ey Phoenicia sree and 

the borderiands of the desert, came be butary o Cyrus,— 
See ee ulecorteal a Atlas to ae Bible (1956), page 75, 
paragrap 


160 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


GETTING OUT OF THE MIDST OF BASYLON 367 


Cyrus issued his decree in his own name in his own 
first year of his reign aside from Darius the Mede. 
—Daniel 9:1-18. 

In view of the time that it took the homesick Jews 
to get ready and then make the trek back to Judah 
and Jerusalem, the decree of Cyrus must have been 
made toward the close of winter and the beginning of 
spring of 537 B.C. This agrees with the date fixed by 
the authorities quoted or referred to above. 

It is very important to fix this date, for by means of 
it we are able to fix the date for the beginning of the 
desolation of the land of Judah and the beginning of 
the “times of the Gentiles,’ or, “the appointed times 
of the nations.” (Luke 21:24, AV; NW)* The Bible 
leaves us in no uncertainty as to how long the deso- 
lation of the land of Judah and its capital was to be. 
That it was to be for a certain number of years and that 
it was to be ended as a result of Cyrus’ decree is plainly 
stated for us in 2 Chronicles 36:20-23, after that chap- 
ter tells of how King Nebuchadnezzar destroyed the 
city of Jerusalem. The above-cited verses read: 

“Furthermore, he carried off those remaining from 
the sword captive to Babylon, and they came to be 
servants to him and his sons until the royalty of Persia 
began to reign; to fulfill Jehovah’s word by the mouth 
of Jeremiah, until the land had paid off its sabbaths. 


ocession ete 
Babylon began on October 23 of 539 B.C., when he entered the ct 
(by day) after its capture by his troops. Hence his frst regnal year 
(a full lunar year) n+ 7 gellaaiage 1 of 333 B.C., or on March 17/18 
of 538 B.C., je 
The cunetform tablet entitled “‘Strossmalcr, Cyrus No. Li’ mentions 
’ first regnal year. eA this tablet {t ts calculated that this year 
B.C., and it ended on March 4/5 of 537 B.C., 
orian time. “gts et second ao year began the next 


161 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


GETTING OUT OF THE MIDST OF BABYLON 371 


Nebuchadnezzar had stored them after stealing them 
from Jerusalem, (Ezra 1:7-11) The Jewish high priest, 
Joshua (or Jeshua) the son of Jehozadak, was most 
interested in their safe delivery, and he accompanied 
Governor Zerubbabel back to the site of the holy city. 
All together a congregation of 42,360 faithful Jews left 
Babylon. They were accompanied by thousands of non- 
Jewish associates, namely, 7,337 men slaves and slave 
girls, and 200 male and female singers. (Ezra 2:1-67) 
For them it was a four-month-long journey to Jeru- 
salem, as early after Cyrus’ decree as possible. 


SEVENTY YEARS’ DESOLATION ENDS 

So, in the year 537 B.C., the land of Judah began to 
be once again inhabited by man and domestic beast. 
There was no one in the land to keep them out. Al- 
mighty God had preserved the land unoccupied in order 
that it might enjoy the sabbath years of complete rest 
that it deserved, with no one on it to cultivate or work 
it. Every year of its lying thus desolate was the equiv- 
alent of a sabbath year according to Jehovah's law 
through Moses. (Leviticus 25:1-12) Regarding this 
repeopling of the land of Judah we read: “And the 
priests and the Levites and some of the people, and the 
singers and the gatekeepers and the Nethinim took up 
dwelling in their cities, and all Israel in their cities. 
When the seventh month [Tishri] arrived the sons of 
Israel were in their cities.”—Ezra 2:70; 3:1. 

How remarkable this was! Why? Well, in the seventh 
Jewish month of the year of Jerusalem's destruction 
the land of Judah was left completely desolate by the 
flight of the poor Jews who had not been deported, 
taking the prophet Jeremiah with them down into 
Egypt. (2 Kings 25:22-26; Jeremiah 41:1 to 43:8) 
That was also the very month in which sabbath years 
and Jubilee years began, namely, “in the seventh 
month on the tenth of the month; on the day of atone- 
ment.” (Leviticus 25:9, 10) Since the desolation had 
begun in the seventh month, the desolation of the land 


162 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


372 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLEN!” 


ought to end officially in that same month; and Ezra 3:1 
officially declares that it ended in that month. 

Since we have determined the year and the month 
in which the desolation ended, it is simple mathematics 
to calculate when the desolation began upon the land 
of Judah. All we have to do is to measure back seventy 
years, forasmuch as the desolation was foretold to last 
seventy years and it actually lasted seventy years. 
Seventy years back from the seventh month (Tishri) 
of the year 537 B.C. brings us to the month Tishri of 
the year 607 B.C. 

In 607 B.C. the month Tishri began on Septem- 
ber 22/23, the day for the observance of the festival 
of the new moon. In that month of 607 B.C. the “‘seven 
times,”’ or, “the times of the Gentiles,”’ “the appointed 
times of the nations,” began.* (Daniel 4:16, 23, 25, 32; 
Luke 21:24, AV; NW) This was two months after 
Jerusalem had been destroyed and its temple plun- 
dered, wrecked and burned down, after which its two 
principal priests were killed.—2 Kings 25:5-21. 

Jehovah God is thus proved to be an accurate Time- 
keeper. If we follow his system of counting time, ac- 
cording to his written Word, we shall make no mistakes 
in our calculations. We cannot therefore go along with 
the chronologers of Christendom who date Jerusalem’s 
destruction as occurring in 587 B.C. and who thereby 
limit the desolation of the land of Judah without man 
or domestic animal to merely fifty years. Almighty 
God decreed that the land had to lie unworked, un- 
inhabited for seventy years in order to enjoy a rela- 
tively perfect number of sabbaths, that is to say, ten 
times seven sabbaths. Had the land enjoyed less than 
this perfect number of seventy years, it would not have 
enjoyed its full number of sabbaths. God's decree could 
not be broken or set aside, and, true to his decree, the 
land of Judah did rest uninhabited seventy years, from 


* See page 178, paragraph 2, to page 189, parngraph 3. 


163 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


386 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI" 


shall be abandoned by many, and for half of the week 
sacrifice and offering shall cease, while in their place 
there shall be a desolating abomination, till at the end 
the doom that is determined shall be poured out upon 
the desolating thing.’”—Daniel 9:24-27.—See also Dr. 
James Moffatt's translation. 


The going forth of the word or commandment to 
restore and rebuild Jerusalem took place in the twen- 
tieth year of King Artaxerxes. His Jewish butler 
named Nehemiah was the one that put this word or 
commandment into effect that same year. According 
to Nehemiah’s reckoning of the lunar year, the year 

with the month Tishri (which Jews today rec- 
ognize as the beginning of their civil year) and ended 
with the month Elul as the twelfth month. The month 
Chislev was the third month from Tishri and fell part 
in November and part in December. In the lunar month 
of Chislev of the twentieth year of King Artaxerxes 
Nehemiah heard bad news about the physical state 
of Jerusalem in the land of Judah. He tells us: 


“Now it came about in the month Chislev, in the 
twentieth year, that I myself happened to be in Shushan 
the castle. Then Hanani, one of my brothers, came in, 
he and other men from Judah, and I proceeded to ask 
about the Jews, those who had escaped, who had been 
left over neg captivity, and also about Jerusalem. 


Nehemiah pra to Jehovah about the matter, de- 
siring to be used in bringing relief to Jerusalem. His 
opportunity came in that same twentieth year of King 
Artaxerxes, in its seventh month (Nisan, according to 
Nehemiah’s reckoning), in 455 B.C.,* for he tells us: 


* On page 67 of The Time Is at Hand (1889 Edition), by C. T. Rus- 
sell, we read: “‘The date of Nehemiah’s [continued on next page) 


164 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


GETTING OUT OF THE MIDST OF BABYLON 387 


“And it came about in the month Nisan, in the twen- 
tieth year of Artaxerxes the king, that wine was before 
him, and I as usual took up the wine and gave it to 
the king. But never had I happened to be gloomy before 
him. So the king said to me: ‘Why is your face gloomy 
when you yourself are not sick? This is nothing but a 
gloominess of heart.’ At this 1 became very much afraid.” 
—Nehemiah 2:1, 2. 

Nehemiah then explained the reason for his gloomi- 
ness, and, after silent prayer to Jehovah God, he asked 
for the king to send him to rebuild Jerusalem. King 
Artaxerxes was agreeable to this and asked Nehemiah: 
“How long will your journey come to be and when will 
you return?” Nehemiah then told the king, with this 
result: 

“So it seemed good before the king that he should 
send me, when I gave him the appointed time. And I 
went on to say to the king: ‘If to the king it does seem 
good, let letters be given me to the governors beyond 
the River [Euphrates], that they may let me pass until 
I come to Judah; also a letter to Asaph the keeper of 
the park that belongs to the king, that he may give me 
trees to build with timber the gates of the Castle that 
belongs to the house, and for the wall of the city and 
for the house into which I am to enter.’ So the King gave 
them to me, according to the good hand of my God 
upon me.”—Nehemiah 2:38. 


About four months after leaving Shushan the king’s 
winter capital, Nehemiah reached Jerusalem about the 
beginning of the lunar month Ab (the eleventh month 
according to his reckoning). After three days of resting 
up and of conferences he inspected the city walls by 
night and then gave the orders to build. (Nehemiah 
2:11-18) This was about the third or fourth day of Ab 
of 455 B.C., or about July 26-27 or 27-28, 455 B.C., 


{ from page 286] commission is ordinarily to 
te B.C. 445. But Dr. Hale's work on chronology (pages 449 and 
531) and Dr. Pricstlie’s treatise on the “Harmony Evangelists’ 


165 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


388 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI’’ 


still in the twentieth year of Artaxerxes. There the 
commandment or word to restore and rebuild Jeru- 
salem took effect.* The sixty-nine weeks of years till 
the coming of Messiah the Princely Leader did not 
begin to count before then. 

According to this count the Messiah or Christ was 
to be brought forth in the year 29 of our Common Era, 
for the sixty-nine weeks of years, or 483 years, began 
to count in 455 B.C. and ended A.D. 29. History proves 
that it was in that year that John baptized Jesus from 
Nazareth in the Jordan River and the holy spirit de- 
scended from heaven upon Jesus to anoint him and 
make him the Messiah or Christ, the Anointed One. 
(Luke 3:1, 2, 21-23) It is very interesting to note that 
the year in which the sixty-nine weeks had their start 
began, not in the month Nisan, but in Tishri, which is 
the month in which Jesus was baptized and anointed. 

As Daniel 9:25 had foretold, the rebuilding work 
was to be done “in the straits of the times,” and Ne- 
hemiah and his fellow builders did experience threats 
and opposition from the non-Jewish people roundabout. 
But by faith and trust in Almighty God and by arming 
themselves against attack and refusing to be drawn 
away from the work, they built the defensive walls 
around Zion or Jerusalem within two months. Nehe- 
miah 6:15 reports: “At length the wall came to com- 
pletion on the twenty-fifth day of Elul [the twelfth 
month], in fifty-two days.” Since the month Ab, which 
preceded Elul, has thirty days, the building work must 
have begun on the fourth of Ab, 455 B.C., or July 27-28, 
and must have ended on September 16-17, 455 B.C., still 


* Volume 9 of M'Clintock and Strong's Cyclopedia of Biblical, Theo- 
logical and een TAterature deals with the “Seventy Weeks 


of Daniel's Prophecy.” and on e 602, under the heading “1. The 
Date of the Edict,” it says: “‘We have supposed this to be from the 
time of its taking effect at Jerusalem rather than from that of its 


nominal issue at Babylon. The difference. however (being only four 
months), will not seriously affect the argument.’* 


166 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


GETTING OUT OF THE MIDST OF BABYLON 395 


of the province of Judea and once made it a vassal 
state. During the reign of the Parthian king, Arta- 
banus III, from 16 to 42 (A.D.), there occurred a ter- 
rible massacre of more than fifty thousand Jewish 
colonists in Mesopotamia, as is reported by the Jewish 
historian Josephus, in his Antiquities of the Jews, 
Book 18, chapter 9, paragraphs 7-9. 

According to the report of Acts 2:5-11, on the Jew- 
ish festival day of Pentecost in the year 33 (A.D.), 
among those present at Jerusalem for the celebration 
there were Jews and proselytes from the “Parthians 
and Medes and Elamites, and the inhabitants of Meso- 
potamia,” in other words, people from the Parthian 
Empire. These were among the thousands who heard 
Peter and the other Christian apostles preach and who 
were baptized as converts to Christianity. Of course, 
when these returned to Mesopotamia and other parts 
of the Parthian Empire, they carried the Christian 
faith back with them. 

It appears that the city of Babylon in lower Meso- 
potamia kept up some sort of existence down into the 
era of Christianity. In proof of this, Josephus tells of 
the actions of Herod the Great, who reigned in Jeru- 
salem from 37 B.C. till shortly after Jesus Christ was 
born at Bethlehem. A certain Jewish priest named 
Hyrcanus had been captured by the Parthians and 
carried away to their country. Says Josephus in his 
Antiquities, Book 15, chapter 2, paragraph 2: 

But when Hyrcanus was brought into Parthia, the 
king Phraates treated him after a very gentle manner; 
as having already learned of what an illustrious family 
he was. On which account he set him free from his 
bonds; and gave him a habitation at Babylon, where 
there were Jews in great numbers. The Jews honoured 
Hyrcanus as their high-priest, and king; as did all the 
Jewish nation that dwelt as far as Euphrates. 


King Herod successfully arranged for the king of 
Parthia to restore priest Hyrcanus to Judea, Herod’s 
dominion. However, King Herod did not bestow the 


167 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


Revelation 14:8 BABYLON THE GREAT AND HEAVENLY ZION 503 


who were putting out the literature published by the 
Watch Tower Bible & Tract Society. On July 17, 1917, 
this Society published and put into their hands the book 
entitled “The Finished Mystery,” which gave an ex- 
planation of the entire book of Revelation (Apoca- 
lypse). On Sunday, December 30, 1917, there was a 
general distribution of the large, four-page tract, Bible 
Students Monthly No. 99, with the feature article ““The 
Fall of Babylon,” with quotations from The Finished 
Mystery. Within two months from then that book and 
the Bible Students Monthly were banned in Canada. 
Shortly afterward the banning of these in the United 
States followed. Then came the arrest and trial of the 
president of the Watch Tower Society and seven others 
of the office personne! of the Society. On June 21, 1918, 
they were sentenced each to eighty years’ imprison- 
ment in a Federal penitentiary. The persecution of the 
Christian Bible Students outside of the prisons became 
intense in Canada and America, egged on by the re- 
ligious clergy. 

The months wore on until November 11, 1918, when 
an armistice brought World War I to an end, with 
Christendom in particular bleeding from terrible 
wounds, suffering also from earthquakes, pestilences 
and famines, with also a shameful record of religious 
persecution. All this was tangible proof that the Gentile 
Times had ended in 1914 and that God’s kingdom had 
been born in the heavens and His Messianic King, the 
Lamb of God, Jesus Christ, had stood up in power on 
the heavenly Mount Zion, to be joined there soon by his 
144,000 faithful followers.—Matthew 24:7-13; Revela- 
tion 12:5-10. 

The outcome of World War I showed that it had not 
been fought in behalf of God’s kingdom, even though 
the nations of Christendom had been the principal 
fighters. Rather, the war had been over world domina- 
tion by one part of Christendom over the other part. 
The war left the Anglo-American World Power still 


168 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


634 “BABYLON THE GREAT HAS FALLENI" Revelation 20:1-5 


He is the starlike One who has the “key of the pit 
of the abyss” and who lets loose from it a swarm of 
pestilential creatures upon men who do not have the 
seal of God. When on earth as a man, he was entreated 
by the unclean spirit demons not to be ordered to go 
then into the abyss. At his death as a perfect man he 
himself descended into the abyss, but Almighty God 
raised him out of it on the third day and gave to him 
the “keys of death and of Hades.” Hence he is God’s 
“angel” or “messenger” to bind and hurl Satan the 
Devil and his demons into the abyss and seal them up 
there for a whole millennium.—Revelation 9:1-4; 1:18; 
Luke 8:31; Romans 10:7. 

It is not into Hades or Sheol that Satan and his 
demons are hurled, inasmuch as Hades or Sheol is the 
common grave of dead humans and is in the ground of 
our earth. Since Satan and his demons are not human 
and not earthly, they are hurled into an abyss, not into 
Hades, Sheol or “hell.” The binding and abyssing of 
Satan and his demons will be something invisible to the 
eyes of earthly survivors of the “‘war of the great day 
of God the Almighty,” just as their being cast out of 
heaven and down to this earth was invisible to us. If 
we judge from the condition of the murdered Jesus 
Christ in the abyss, the condition of the chained Satan 
and his demons in the abyss will be a deathlike one, 
likely an unconscious state, with no ability to “mislead 
the nations any more.” That will allow for a devil-free 
order of things over man, for a thousand years. 

Measuring by means of the Bible timetable from the 
first man’s creation in the garden of Eden, we are now 
close to the end of six thousand years from Adam’s 
creation, not to speak of his later fall into sin after the 
Original Serpent had misled Adam’s wife into sin and 
death. So by adding a thousand years for the approach- 
ing reign of the Messiah unopposed by the Original 
Serpent and his seed, we measure close to the end of 
seven thousand years from man’s creation in Eden. 


—— -—-—-< 


169 


Appendix F: Selected pages from BF 


CHART OF DATES FROM CREATION TO CURRENT 


DATE (A.0. 1963) OF BABYLON THE GREAT 


DATE EVENT REFERENCE 
_  ——————————————————— = 
4026 B.C. Adam's creation ‘in the autumn) Gen. 2:7 
a. 4026 B.C. covenant made, first prophecy Gen. 3:15 
b. 3396 B.C. Cain slays Abel Gen. 4:8 
3896 B.C. Birth of Soth Gen. 5:3 
3404 B.C. Birth of righteous Enoch Gen. 5:18 
3339 B.C. Birth of Methusclah Gen. 5:21 
3152 B.C, Birth of Lamech Gen. 5:25 
3096 B.C. Death of Adam Gen. 5:5 
3033 B.C. Transference of Enoch; ends his period of sae a 
2970 B.C. Birth of Noah Gen. 5:28, 29 
2490 B.C. "s t as to mankind Gen. 6:3 
2470 B.C. Birth of Japheth Sa 9:24; 
2462 B.C. Birth Gen. 7:11; 11:10 
2370 B.C. Death of Methuselah Gen. 5:27 
Floodwatere fall tin November) Gen. 7:6, 11 
2369 B.C. Making of the covenant after the Flood Gets. 8:13; 9:16 
2302 B.C. Birth of Gen. 11:10 
a. 2239 B.C. Building of the Tower of Babel in land Gen. 11:4 
of Shinar: Nimrod king of Babel 
2020 B.C. Death of Noah Gen. 9:28, 29 
2013 B.C. Birth of Abraham Gen. 11:26, 32; 
12:4 
1943 B.C. py tomers crosses Euphrates River for Gen. 12:4, 7; 
covenant made; Ex. 12:40; 
screen of the 430-year period Gal. 3:17 
law covenant 
b. 1933 B.C. Lot rescued from king of Shinar Gen. 14:16, 18; 
allies; Abraham visits Melchizedck 16:3 
1932 B.C, Ishmael Gen. 16:15, 16 
1919 B.C. Covenant of Gen. 17:1, 10, 24 
Judgment of Sodom and Gen. 1? 
1918 B.C. Birth of Isaac the true heir; beginning Gen. 21:2, 5: 
of the “about 450 Acts 13: 17-20 
1913 B.C. Weaning of Isaac; Ishmael sent away; Gen. 21:8; 15:13; 
ef the 400-year affliction Acts 7:6 
1881 B.c. Death of Sarah Gen. 17:17; 23:1 
1878 B.C. Marriage of Issac and Rebekah Gen, 23:20 
1868 B.c. Death of Gen. 11:11 
1858 B.C. Birth of Esau and Jacob Gen. 26:26 
1843 B.c. Death of Abraham Gen, 25:7 
1618 B.C, marries first two wives Gen. 26:24 
1795 B.c. Death of Ishmaect Gen. 25:17 
1781 B.C. Jacob flees to Haran; his vision at Bethel Gen. 26:2, 13, 19 
1774 B.c. Jacob marrics Leah and Rachel Gen, 29:23-30 
1767 B.C. Birth of Joseph Gen. 30:23, 24 
1761 B.c. Jacob returns to Canaan from Haran Gen. 31:18, 41 
¢, 1761 B.C. Jacob wrestles angel; is named Isracl Gen. 32:24-28 
1750 B.c. Joseph sold as a slave by his brothers Gen. 37:2, 2¢ 
738 B.C, Death of Issue Gen. 35:28, 29 


170 


APPENDIX G: CORRESPONDENCE WITH THE WATCHTOWER SOCIETY 


4 ? a 
‘) 
MAIN @-t840 cAaeue watenrewaen 
et? ADAMS @YTHEET, SROOKLYN | Ew YORK, Usa 
EQ:EI May 15, 1963 , 
~ 

Mr. Max Hatton : - 

2 Wasnock Street 
Broadmeadows f 
Victoria, Australia ® | 
Dear Brother Hatton: ae : r ay 
i 
Your letter of April 12 eerste *9 Biblical chronology \ 

. has our attention, and we are pleased acknowledge receipt 


of it at.this time. . 
AS you can undoubtedly appreciate, what you have outlined . 
would require considerable research. At the present time a 
great deal of work is being done here in preparation for the , 
Everlasting Good News" assembly. Since the Society's head- 4 
quarters staff is being used for the preparation of the 
assembly, undoubtedly you can appreciate the fact that it is 
not possible for us to undertake the extensive research that 
would be required to answer your letter at the present time. 4 
We are sure you understand that it is more important to con- i 
.tinue in our work in preparation for the assembly than to stop 
for such a research project as this one. Yet we can appreciate 


the fact that you are interested in these matters, and no doubt - 
the Society will have more to say on matters of chronology in ‘4 
future publications. At that time you will be able to benefit 34 
from the published material along with all other fellow servants 4 


of Jehovah and readers of the Society's literature. ® « 
We wish to give you the assurance of our Christian love. 
With you, keeping our friendship with God, 


Miithnow Bork 


Pi 
or naw Yor, ieee, d 


171 


Appendix G: Correspondence with the Watchtower Society 


Je ar | tow 
Su tOWER 
eter ee WATS Hi om BSOCIETY eee ee 


or NEW YORK, INC. 


37 ADAM® STREET, BROOKLYN 1, NEW YORK, U.S.A. 


AB/AG August 12, 1964 


Max Hatton 

21 Warnock Street 
Broadmeadows 
Victoria, Australia. 


Dear Brother Hatton: 


From your letter of the 3lst of July on the subject or 
chronology, especially as it relates to the books "All Scripture 
is Inspired of God and Beneficial" and "Babylon the Great Has 
Fallent™ God's Kingdom Rules!, we note that you have worked your- 
se up into a state of uncertainty and you have weakened your 
confidence in the Society. : 


We regret to observe this. We can assure you that a very 
great amount of research, including that on chronology, has 
gone into the composition of the two books above mentioned ty 
not one individual but by many. The various problems were con- 
sidered and the conclusions arrived at were those that are set 
forth in these publications. The first thing to do is put con- 
fidence in the inspired Word of God and in its chronology and 
in some respects the secular chronologies of the ancient nations 
are found to adjust themselves to the Bible chronology. From 
the Bible it is very evident that the Times of the Gentiles be- 
gan with Jerusalem's destruction in 607 B.C.E., and that accordingly 
these 2,520 years ended in 1914 C.E. This was fully corroborated 
with the outbreak of World War I and all of its concomitants as 
foretold by the Lord Jesus Christ. The Seventy-Year desolation 
was brought to an end by the reoccupation of the land by its formerly 
exiled people. This must have occurred in 537 B.C.E, The Babylon 
book shows how this can be figured out. These are the main con- /. 
siderations and there is no reason to quibble about them and to 
feel obliged personally to do a lot of private digging around 
into secular chronologies and giving them the place of first 
importance, thereby upsetting oneself mentally and spiritually, 
giving more credence to worldly, secular authorities and reducing 
one's confidence in the conscientious, carefully handled research 
done ty dedicated brothers who are trying to please the Most High 
God, the inspirer of the Holy Bible and who are trying to get ahead 
with His work before the end of this system of things comes upon 
the nations and the mandatory work of preaching the good news of 
the Kingdom in all the inhabited earth for a witness to all the 
nations ends. 


So the condition in which your letter indicates you to ke 
just moves us in a brotherly way to counsel you to sive less atten- 


a“ 


172 


Appendix G: Correspondence with the Watchtower Society 


Max Hatton 

21 Varnock Street 
Broadmeadows 
Victoria, Australia 


Aucust 12, 1964, Paye Two 


tion to this matter of chronology, althoussh it has its proper 
place in God's Word, and concern yourself more witii the facts 
of the day which are in fulfillment and in corroboration of 
Bible prophecy and with renewed confidence Join in carryiny 
forward Jehovah's prescribed work with his visicle orcanization 
to the glorious end. " 


Yours in the proclaiming of the "“everlastin,; 


food news," 


4 > 
Mi sibive BY AK, 
. ’ 


OF NEW YOAK, ING. . 


173 


Sem WATS 


Appendix G: Correspondence with the Watchtower Society 


WER 


A TRACT SOCIETY 
or NEW YORK, inc, 


WT ADAMS STREET, BROOKLYN, NEW YORK 11201, Ue. 


October 23, 1964 


M. FP. Hatton 

2 Warnock Street 
Broadmeadows 
Victoria, Australia 


Dear Brother Hatton: 


Your letter of September 3 continues in your course of 
_making Btele avehorities and =e 
their exposition of the Scriptures in favor of a complete 
desolation of the land of Judah for less than seventy years 
and page four of your letter says in favor of those outside 
authorities: "I find no conflict between secular and Bible 
chronology.” Well, the Watch Tower Bible and Tract Society 
does find conflict and it explains the conflict in the book 
entitled "Babylon the Great Has Fallen!" God's dom Rules! 
And it is because o 8 ofc c ween those 
who do not take the Bible for what it says and who follow the 
line of reasoning of their religious authorities in Christendom 
that you feel obliged to write the Society repeatedly about 
this matter of chronology, showing that you are not in agree- 
ment with the Society's latest book on Babylon the Great. That 
book was written with full knowledge of what the authorities of 
Christendom have to say upon this vital point of chronology 
and if the reader will carefully examine into what the book 
has to say upon this critical péint in chronology he will see 
that it answers these outside authorities of Christendom and 
harmonizes with all of the Scriptures. Please read again 
Isaiah chapter twenty-four in which Jehovah predicts that he 
will turn the land of Judah upside down like a bowl and empty 
out all of its inhabitants, thus bringing about a complete 
desolation. of.the land-ese-far-as humearinhabitants are concerned” 
together with their domestic beasts and making the land one of 
taboo that no superstitious pagan who believed in ghosts and 
haunted places would want to occupy and inhabit, but would 
whistle at it in order to counteract the ghosts and demons 
supposedly haunting the place, and would pass by the land, 
fearfully avoiding it. 


Trusting the above clearly sets forth our position, based 
upon what is published in detail in the Babylon book, we remain, 


Paithfully yours in speaking God's word with boldness, 


| iti Boh Soars 


174 


CASLE WATCHTOWER